00
u<
OU_1 60493
OSMANIA UNIVERSITY
Gall No.
'
P\**
USL ion No.
Author
Title
This book should be returned on or
below.
MALEIC ANHYDRIDE DERIVATIVES
Reactions of the Double
Bond
PREFACE
The chemistry of maleic acid and its Jrans-isomer, fumaric acid, has
been the subject of studies made by many chemists for more than one
hundred and thirty years.
For the last thi^y years, during which time maleic anhydride has
been freely available from the catalytic oxidation of Uenzcne, induschemists have developed a surprisingly wide range of uses for it.
importance in the production of different types of alkyd resins, of
trial
Its
maleinizcd drying
widely known are
and of various copolymers is well known. Less
valuable uses in the manufacture of organic pig-
oils,
its
oil additives, pharmaceuticals,
tanning agents, detergents, wetting agents, abrasives, adhesives, cellophane, and other important technical products.
ments, rubber, deemulsifying agents,
Only small amounts
of maleic acid,
fumaric acid, or their suits have
been employed as such. By far the greatest interest has been centered
in the use of maleic anhydride as a building block in chemical synthesis.
The many types
of reactions
which
it
undergoes are indeed intriguing
Its structure is ideally suited for synthetic
to the organic chemist.
purposes because, if suitable conditions are chosen, any atom in the
molecule can be induced to react.
Furthermore, the activity of the
unsaturated ethylene bond, enhanced by the two adjacent carbonyl
groups, is such that it can be depended upon to undergo almost any
characteristic of unsaturated organic compounds.
found these characteristic reactions of the carbon-carbon double
reaction that
We
is
bond as well as the other reactions of the maleyl group so fascinating
that it seemed desirable to gather them together in their simplest book
form so that they could be quickly reviewed, much as one might
review a series of reference cards. Our discussions with many chemists
indicated a very general interest in these reactions, most of which have
The chemistry of the double bond is
to do with the double bond.
indeed basic to the synthesis of almost all industrial organic chemiIn
cals, such as dyes, detergents, perfumes, gasolines, and flavors.
this book, selected types of reactions are graphically portrayed
on the
PREFACE
Only the reactants and the end products are shown
any attempt to portray the reaction mechanism has been avoided as
being beyond this simple presentation.
right-hand pages.
It
this
is
our intention that the reader should be able to thumb through
Because
until a reaction that interests him is uncovered.
book
know how the products are made, we describe
The render will also wish to know what the
briefly.
the reader will wish to
their preparation
products are like and what they are used for; that information
given on the facing page. Any more comprehensive information
is
is
beyond the scope of our book, but a series of references is given to
No reference citations are included in the
assist in further study.
abbreviated text.
This book
is
intended for students and research workers interested
in synthetic organic chemistry,
and
for industrial chemists confronted
with the problem of finding suitable chemicals to solve specific problems.
It is not designed as a textbook to be studied from cover to
It is
cover, nor is it in any sense an encyclopedia or a monograph.
written particularly for the busy investigator who is already overburdened by the rapidly expanding chemical literature, but who likes
to browse through chemical reactions looking for thoughts to stir his
creative imagination.
LAWRENCE H. FLETT
WILLIAM HOWLETT GARDNER
July, 1952
CONTENTS
INTRODUCTION
1.
HYDROCARBONS
Reaction of Propone
Reaction of Terpinolene
Non-conjugated Terponcs
Reaction of Toluene
Alkylaromalic Hydrocarbons
Reaction of 1,3-Butadiene
Conjugated Dienes
Reaction of 1-Vinylnaphthalene
Arylvinyls
Reaction of Anthracene
Polynuclear Aromatic Hydrocarbons
Reaction of a-Phellandrcnc
Conjugated Terpcnes
Reaction of (1-Cyclohexen-l-yl) (1-cycloDialkenylacetylene
Olefines
9
11
13
15
17
1.^
21
penten-1-yl) acetylene
Reaction of Hexaphnnylethane
Polymerization of Diethyl Fumarate with
Maleyl Compounds
Ethylenes and Vinyls
Copolymerization of Ethylenc
Free Radicals
2.
23
Itself
HALOGENS AND THEIR COMPOUNDS
Halogens I
Halogens II
Reaction of Hydrochloric Acid
Reaction of Hypochlorous Acid and Alkali
Oxyhalo Acids I
Reaction of Hypochlorous Acid
Oxyhalo Acids II
Reaction of Decyl Chloride Mixture
Alkyl Chlorides
35
37
39
41
Reaction of 2-Bromo-l,l-diphcnylethyk ne
Reaction of Phosphoryl Chloride
Oxychlorides
Reaction of Acetyl Chloride
Acid Chlorides I
Acid Chlorides II- Reaction of Phthalyl Chloride
Reaction of Phosphorus Pentachloride
Phosphorus Chlorides
Reaction of Carbon Tetrachloride
Chlorinated Solvents
Diarylvinyl Halides
4.
31
33
tion
HYDROGEN
Hydrogen
27
28
Reaction of Chlorine
Reaction of Chlorine accompanied by Dehydrochlorina-
Halo Acids
3.
25
43
45
47
49
51
53
54
Reaction of Hydrogen
METALLIC COMPOUNDS
57
58
Reaction of Mercuric Acetate
Reaction of Hcxaphenyldilead
Hexaarylleads
Reaction of Methanol in the Presence of Alkoxides
Aliphatic Alcohols
Reaction of Allyl Alcohol in the Presence of
Unsaturated Alcohols
Mercuric Salts
61
63
65
67
Alkali
vii
CONTENTS
Keto Esters
Reaction of Ethyl Acetoacetate in the Presence of
69
Alkoxides
Malonic Esters
Reaction of Diethyl Ethylmalonate in the Presence
71
of Alkoxides
Reaction of a-Tolunitrile in the Presence of Alkoxides
Reaction of Phenylzinc Chloride
Grignard Reagents I
Reaction of Isopropylcadmium Bromide
Grignard Reagents II
Reaction of Two Moles of Phenylmagnesium
Grignard Reagents III
Nitriles
Bromide
73
75
77
79
Grignard Reagents IV
Reaction of Four Moles of Phenylmagnesium
Bromide
81
Grignard Reagents V
Grignard Reagents VI
Reaction of Four Moles of Phenyllithium
Reaction of Three Moles of Ethylmagnesium
Bromide
83
85
Grignard Reagents VII
Reaction of
Two Moles
of
Ethylmagnesium
Bromide
87
Reaction of Benzene in the Presence of
Friedel-Craft Reactants I
Aluminum Chloride
89
Reaction of Benzoylacrylic Acid with Benzene in the Presence of Aluminum Chloride
Reaction of m-Dimethoxybenzene in the
Friedel-Craft Reactants III
Friedel-Craft Reactants II
Presence of
Aluminum Chloride
IV
Reaction of Fumaryl Chloride and BenPresence of Aluminum Chloride
91
93
Friedel-Craft Reactants
zene in the
5.
COMPOUNDS CONTAINING NITROGEN
Ammonia
Ammonia
of
I-
II
Reaction of
96
Ammonia
99
Reaction of Four Moles of
Ammonia
with
Two Moles
Fumarate
Ammonia
95
101
Two Moles
III
Reaction of
Ammonia
Ammonia IV
Reaction of
Ammonia under Anhydrous
with
of
Fumaric
Acid
103
Conditions
105
Reaction of Aniline in the Presence of Thionyl Chloride
107
Reaction of p-Methoxymaleanilic Acid with
Alkoxymaleanilic Acids
Arylamines
Acetyl Chloride
Reaction of
Ammonia V
109
Two Moles
of
Ammonia
at Ordinary
Tem111
peratures
Amines
Reaction of Methylamine
Ammonia VI Reaction of Excess Ammonia in Anhydrous Solvents
Amines II
Reaction of an Excess of Methylamine
I
Amines III
Amines IV
Reaction of Piperidine
Reaction of Isoquinoline (Isoquinolinium Acid Maleate)
Reaction of 2,4,6-Triaminophenol
sym-Polyaminophenols
Reaction of Three Moles of Phenylhydrazine
Hydrazines I
Reaction of One Mole of Phenylhydrazine
Hydrazines II
Reaction of Phenylhydrazine in the Presence of
Hydrazines III
Glacial Acetic Acid
113
115
117
119
121
123
125
127
129
viii
CONTENTS
Reaction of Hydrazine Hydrate
Hydrazines IV
Reaction of Two Moles of Hydrazine Hydrate
Hydrazines V
Reaction of Benzaldehyde Phenylhydrazone
Hydrozones
Azines I
Reaction of Benzaldehyde Azine
Carbamides
Reaction of Urea
Scruffs Bases
Reaction of Benzylideneaniline
Reaction of Phenylhydroxylamine
Hydroxylamines
Reaction of Benzaldehyde Oxime
Oximes
131
Reaction of 2-Ethy]-2-hexenylideneaniline
Alkenylideneanilines
Azines II
Reaction of Benzaldehyde Azine in the Presence of Water
147
Reaction of a-Methylpyrrole
Reaction of 2,3-Dimethylquinoxaline
2,3-E)imethylpyrazines
Azides I
Reaction of Carbamyl Azide
151
Pyrroles
Azides II
Reaction of Benzyl Azide
Diazo Compounds
Reaction of Diazomethanc
Diazonium Chlorides
Reaction of p-Chlorobenzcnediazonium
Chloride
6.
135
137
139
141
143
145
149
153
155
157
159
161
Reaction of Hydrocyanic Acid
Reaction of Hydrocyanic Acid in Anhydrous Solvents
Nitriles II
Amino Alcohols
Reaction of 2-Amino-2-methyl-l,3-propanediol
Nitriles I
Nitroparaffins
133
Reaction of Nitroethane
COMPOUNDS CONTAINING OXYGEN
163
165
167
169
170
Water
Reaction of Water at Elevated Temperatures
Reaction of Ethanol
Monohydric Alcohols
173
Reaction of Glycol
Polyhydric Alcohols
Peroxides
Reaction of Hydrogen Peroxide
Phenols
Reaction of Phenol in the Presence of Sulfuric Acid
177
Cresols
Reaction of p-Cresol in the Presence of Sulfuric Acid
of
Alcohols
Reaction
3-tert-Butyl-6-hydroxyo-Hydroxybenzyl
183
5-methylbenzyl Alcohol
Reaction of Furan
Conjugated Heterocyclic Dienes
Ketene Acetals
Reaction of Two Moles of Kotenc Diethylacetal
Reaction of Methyl Abietate
Polycyclic Dicnecarboxylic Acids
Reaction of Methyl Linoleate
Non-conjugated Fatty Esters
Reaction of Isosafrole
Propenylphenyl Ethers
Reaction of l-(3,4-Dimethoxyphenyl)-l
Methoxyarylethylenes
185
phenylethylene
Reaction of Methyl Coumalate
a-Pyrones
Reaction of 3a,4,7,7-TetraBimolecular Alkylanhydroacetonebenzils
hydro-2,7-dimethyl-3,3a,5,6-tetraphenyl-4 ,7-methanoindene-l ,8-dione
Reaction of Vinylthiolacetate
Heterovinyl Compounds
175
179
181
187
189
191
193
195
197
199
201
203
Arylalkenylcarbinols
Reaction of o-Allyl-1-naphthylenemethanol
Reaction of Ethyl 2-OxocycloCyclopentanonecarboxylic Esters
205
pentanecarboxylate
Reactions of Benzoyl Peroxide
Acyl Peroxide
Ozone I
Reaction of Ozone in Organic Solvents
207
ix
209
211
CONTENTS
Reaction of Ozone in Water
Ozone II
Roclen Reactants
Reaction of Carbon Monoxide and Hydrogen
the Presence of Dicohalt Octacarbonyl
7.
SULFUR COMPOUNDS
213
in
215
216
Sulfur
Reaction of Sulfur at Elevated Temperatures
Reaction of 1-Pentancthiol
Mercaptans
219
Reaction of Thiolacetic Acid
Reaction of Thioacetic Arid
Thiocarboxylic Acids
Reaction of Sodium Bisulfite
Sulfites
Sulfur Trioxide
Reaction of Sulfur Trioxide
Reaction of Benzenesulfmic Acid
Sulfmic Acids
223
Thiol Acids
221
225
227
229
231
Reaction of Sodium Thiosulfatc
Reaction of Thiourea
Reaction of o-Aminobenzenethiol
Aminothiophenols
233
Thiosemicarbazones
239
Thiosulfates
Thioamines
Reaction of Acetonethiosernicarbazone
235
237
Reaction of DiacenaphthoLl,2-6,r,2'-t/]thiophene
241
Reaction of 3-frr/-Butylmercapto-2,5-dihydro-4Heterocyclic Sulfones
243
methylthiophene 1-Dioxide
Thiophenes
8.
ENERGY AND CATALYSTS
Effect of Actinic Light
Energy
Heat
Energy
Dry Distillation
Isomerizalion of Maleic Acid
Heat or Catalyst
INDEX
244
247
249
251
253
Introduction
This book consists of a simplified presentation of 116 different types
anhydride or one of its simple un-
of chemical reactions involving maleic
The reaction is given whether it takes place with
fumaric acid, their esters, amides, or other unsaturated
In most cases the reactions can be carried out with any
saturated derivatives.
maleic acid
derivatives.
one of them; collectively, they are referred to as having the maleyl
group:
Each
O- C
II
H H
||
reaction selected has been treated as the representative of a
The reactions are grouped into chapters according
particular type.
to the elements contained in the
group.
the first
compound
reacting with the maleyl
Those containing only carbon and hydrogen are to be found in
This chapter is followed by chapters on compounds
chapter.
containing other elements arranged in alphabetical order. Reactions
with bromine, chlorine, or compounds containing these elements are
covered in the chapter on halogen compounds. Those reactions involving metallic catalysts that take a prominent part in the reaction,
such as Friedel-Craft catalysts, sodium alkoxides, and the
like, appear
on metallic compounds. Many other valid classifications
could have been chosen. A brief discussion of the various reactions
within each group introduces each chapter.
Every effort has been made to keep the format as simple as possible.
in the chapter
Each preparation is confined to a set of two open pages, with the net
equation and a brief description of the method appearing on the righthand page. Comments, a description of the reaction products, and
possible uses are given on the left-hand page.
The class of compounds reacting with maleic anhydride or its derivatives is shown in the upper right-hand corner of the right-hand
In the left-hand
pages, as illustrated in the figure on page 3.
corner of the page is a general formula for the group to which the reactant
Only one reaction is given for the group, unless the reactants
yield different products under varied experimental conditions, as, for
belongs.
In such cases, separate
is the case with the Grignard reagents.
preparations are included for each different type of reaction.
The specific reactant selected as being typical of the class is shown in
example,
the center of the page.
In most cases this
the simplest
is
member
of
Because chemical reactions are most easily understood by
the
structural formulas of the reactants and the reaction prodstudying
net
the
equation is given directly below the name of the reactant.
uct,
in a particular reaction will then wish to know how
interested
Anyone
the series.
Beneath the equation, there is a brief description of the
preparation selected directly from the literature. This is not intended
Those undertaking the preparation should
as a laboratory procedure.
it is
first
carried out.
consult the original references.
After the description of the reaction, there are a few selected references
to assist the reader who wishes to pursue the study of any reaction beof this book.
yond the scope
method.
To
The
first
been added a
this has
list
reference
is
the source of the
of selected references covering
not only the method of preparation and the properties, but also the
Most of the patent numbers cited pertain
possible uses of the product.
to uses.
The arrangement of the opposite or left-hand page is similar to that of
the right-hand one. In the right-hand corner is given the class of product formed from the class of reactants shown in the same corner of the
In the illustration on this page, for example, alkoxysuccinic anhydrides are formed from aliphatic alcohols.
The left-hand corner of the left page in a similar manner shows a
opposite page.
general formula for the products.
at a glance what has been added,
The
This formula
by the
is
designed to indicate
reaction, to the maleyl group.
following symbols have been employed in both sets of general
/Type Formula
H
^^ HOWRlOH),
AUvQ\\SLCCiisic ACIDS
Melhoxjauccinic Arid
-<
-*
Class of Product
Specific Product
Aliphatic alcohols of different chain lengths readily react with iiuilefttes in the presence of metallic Mjduim or the sodium ethoxule to
It
produce alkoxysuccmates. The procediue gnen is a general one
can be used with both branched- and stiaight-cham monohydiic alco-
hol*
To avoid the formation of a m.xture of pioducts, it is common
practice to use the maleic esters? ami alcoholatcs dt-rued from the same
alcohol
Little, if any, fumanc acid is formed dm ing these preparations.
The
acid
is
^~
DiSCUSSUm of Reaction
^
^
M*,,.* ^tf r^^A
NatUFe
obtained, us *ho\\n, through sapomficntion of the
alkoxysueemato
Mrt)io\)suormic acid
to 103" vshen punfied.
a enstallme Mibstam-c that melts at 101
The crude
aoid nulls at 9i to
100,
,~i
*WCt
U*. The
long-chain alkoxy dematncs, s-uch &> decyloxy- and
dodccyloxysuccmic acids, have been used a* intermediates in the preparation of synthetic detergents
"*
Alkoxysuccimc acids in general umlcigo many of the reactions of
sucemic acid (qv), thus offering the same possibilities lor the preparation of useful compounds.
__
Reported USCS
C=C C
H H
formulas: 9ft represents the maleyl grouping,
II
which
|1
present in maleic anhydride and each of the maleic derivatives used
as reactants in these preparations. Maleic anhydride is thus repreis
sented .by the combination 9ft >0; maleic or fumaric acid by 9ft(OH) 2
and
OR
their esters
by
9ft
</yry
or 9ft (OR)a.
Groups adding to the double
bond to produce succinic acid derivatives are shown above or to the left
Different alkyl
of the symbol 9ft, viz., HF=9ft>0, R9ft(OH) 2 etc.
Ar halogens
etc.
substituents
indicated
are
by
aryl
by
R',
R",
R,
groups
The
have
Met,
chemical
their usual
metals
and
symbols
by
by X;
,
significance
On
when
combination with these symbols.
in
the next line
the
is
name
This
of the specific
followed
selected preparation.
method of preparation, the reaction,
is
by
product formed in the
general
comments on the
and a brief description of the prodconcluded with a discussion of uses, not only of
the product but of homologous compounds that may be prepared by this
method.
Names of the chemicals are as far as possible those used in the latest
uct
The page
itself.
is
edition of Chemical Abstracts.
grade
All
temperatures refer to the Centi-
scale.
/Group Formula
^^ROMet
ALIPHATIC ALCOHOLS
METAL DERIVATIVES
"*
UM
r}
f-n
t
Of
KeacUnt
.
Specific Reactant
|j
c-c-ocjr,
HOV.
r-c-oe,iii
(ll<))
IMAM
l|
urn
^
"*
in --roil
Simple Illustrative
Reaction
HowProductLM.de
Itrffren.T.
Twd'u,
T / cK,m .w
,
S 2,37r.2.
47. 855
<i85)
39, 3i4 (i88i)
c/
~<
Selected References
CHAPTER
1
Hydrocarbons
This chapter describes the reactions of maleyl compounds with various types of hydrocarbons. The different hydrocarbons react in one
manner or another to saturate the ethylene bond of the maleyl group.
With mono-olefins, such as propenc and its higher homologs, a
methylene carbon adjacent to the unsaturated ethylene group adds to
one of the carbons of the double bond of the maleyl reactant.
This
is
accompanied by transfer of a hydrogen from the reacting methylcno
group to the other carbon of the double bond. Alicylic mono-olefins,
non-conjugated polyolefins, and non-conjugated olefins containing unreactive substituents, such as some of the fatty esters, behave similarly.
Polyolefins containing unsaturated bonds separated
by only a
single
methylene group generally undergo partial conversion to the conjugated isomers during this addition, giving rise to mixed types of produnder Maleinized Oils in Chapter 6, page 192. Such
would be expected, since conjugated hydrocarbons react in a different
ucts, as described
manner as outlined below.
The resonating aromatic ring in alkylaromatic compounds, like
toluene and its homologs, apparently serves to activate the adjacent
methyl group in much the same manner as the double bond of the
olefin activates the methylene group.
If all the hydrogens of the
methyl group are replaced by substituents, no reaction occurs, as in
the case cited, with er-butylbenzene.
Conjugated polyolefinic hydrocarbons add far more readily to maleyl
compounds than do the non-conjugated types. In most instances,
reaction easily takes place at temperatures below 100, in contrast to
most of the above reactions. In the case of conjugated dienes, for
example, addition occurs between the terminal carbons of the diene
grouping and those of the ethylene bond of the maleic reactant to yield
tetrahydrophthalic acids or similar alicyclic adducts. These reactions
are known as the Diels- Alder syntheses. The products contain a single
unsaturated group in what was the 2-position of the original diene
Various types of conjugated chain polyenes, cyclic conjugated dienes, certain arylvinyls, aromatics lacking a complete Kekul6
structure such as anthracene, highly methylated naphthalenes, and
grouping.
dienynes react in this manner.
The
reaction of arylvinyls, such as 1-vinylnaphthalene, is particuis an example of how the conjugation may be
larly interesting, since it
furnished in these reactions by one of the unsaturated groups of an
aromatic ring adjacent to an ethylene bond.
Compounds containing
the dienyne group,
react as if they
were tetraenes in these reactions to give derivatives of 1,2,3,5,6,7-hexahydronaphthalene. Several other interesting modifications where the
CH=CH C^C CH=CH
reactants contain other elements are described in the chapters which
follow.
Hexaphenylethane, in contrast, appears to react by dissociating into
triphenylmethyl free radicals that add to both carbons of the ethylene bond of the maleyl compound. Similar a,/3-bis-substituted succinic acid derivatives are produced by hexaphenyldileacl, and by carbon
its
tetrachloride in the presence of bcnzoyl peroxide.
Ethylene and compounds containing a vinyl group generally do not
react with maleyl
catalysts.
compounds except in the presence of polymerization
Under such conditions, the major products of the reactions
are copolymers that are formed by the hydrocarbon uniting to produce
bridges between the ethylene carbons of separate maleyl molecules.
Such carbon-carbon linked bridges are formed at both carbons of the
ethylene bond to give products of long chain structures. Resinous
materials of a similar nature are also produced as by-products in other
reactions described in this chapter.
Included also in this chapter is the polymerization of maleates
because of the close similarity to the reaction with ethylene. This particular reaction might have been included in Chapter 6, since maleates
are carboxy-substituted ethylenes. It seemed desirable, however, to
exception in the arrangement in this case.
make an
Products containing groups derived from both the catalyst and the
among the products of these polymerization
different side reactions may also take
that
several
reactions, indicating
solvents have been found
place during these polymerizations. It has been shown that these
reactions take place by a kinetic chain mechanism, apparently involving the formation of free radicals [Marvel, Prill,
Chem. Soc. 69, 52 (1947) ]
.
and
De
Tar,
J.
Am.
RCH=CH CH
ALKENYLSUCCINIC ANHYDRIDES
Allylsuccinic Anhydride
The procedure given on the opposite page is a general one. It may
be used also for preparing branched-chain alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, and
non-conjugated polyenyl derivatives of succinic anhydride. Use of a
solvent is convenient but not always essential, but high temperatures
are required unless a small amount of a catalyst, such as a peroxide or a
Small amounts of iodine produce satufinely divided metal, is added.
rated
products, probably cycloalkylsuccinic
of resinous polymers are also formed.
amounts
anhydrides.
Various
It is
good practice to
use freshly distilled olefins and to dissolve the anhydride completely
before raising the temperature to 250.
The
one of
addition of the olefin to the maleic
compound usually occurs
at
a-methylene carbons, as has been pointed out; but the ethylene bond may shift during this addition if other unsaturated groups
its
are present in the olefin. This is the case with allylbenzene and biallyl.
These compounds therefore yield 3-phenylallyl- and 2,5-hexadien-lylsuccinic anhydrides, respectively. These exceptions may readily be
explained
if
a free radical
Allylsuccinic anhydride
mechanism
is
a colorless
is
assumed
oil
for the reaction.
that has not been solidified.
can be distilled under 16-mm. pressure at 135 to 142. It is insoluble in water, but is slowly converted to the acid in contact with it.
The acid melts at 99 to 100. With hypobromous acid it yields a
It
bromolactone.
Uses.
Alkenylsuccinic anhydrides are valuable intermediates in the
The acids have been used
manufacture of certain synthetic detergents.
as rust-inhibiting agents in lubricants.
Ethylene esters have been
in emulsions used for oiling textiles, in the treating of leather,
employed
and in the preparation of hard-water-soluble
oils.
Alkyl esters yield
plasticizers for vinyl chloride copolymers.
When hydrogenated, alkenylsuccinic anhydrides produce the saturated alkyl derivatives, and when oxidized they yield carballylic or
other tribasic acids. Most of them can be readily lactonized with
sulfuric acid at
normal temperatures.
RCH=CH CH R'
OLEFINS
Propene
HCH
HCH
xjLvyx.
H*
,
H-
\Q
J,
->
HC-C
-C^
"4
4
+
Propene
>
Maleic anhydride
Allylsucoinic anhydride
Preparation. A solution of 50 g. of maleic anhydride and 40 g. of
propene in 50 ml. of benzene is allowed to react for 12 hours at 250
This produces a maximum overpressure of 74 atmosAfter the reacted mixture is cooled, the pressure is 13 at-
an autoclave.
in
pheres.
mospheres.
The product
is
a mixture containing a dark brittle resin, maleic
anhydride and allylsuccinic anhydride.
pressure at 16
mm.
The 44
g.
It is distilled
under reduced
of unreacted maleic anhydride distills
below 132, and the allylsuccinic anhydride is obtained at 135 to 142.
The yield of allylsuccinic anhydride is 26 g. or 35% of theory.
Homologs
of propene react
of theoretical
amounts
more
easily, giving yields of
70 to
80%
of substituted succinic anhydrides.
References
and Schmitz, A., Ber. 76B, 27 (1943). C/.:
Arnold, R. T., and Dowdall, J. F., /. Am. Chem. Soc, 70, 2590 (1948).
Farmer, E. H. Trans. Faraday Soc. 38, 340 (1942).
Alder, K., Pascher, F.,
Rodestvedt, C.
U.S.
2,055,456;
S., Jr.,
Org. Syn. 31, 85 (1951).
2,124,628;
2,381,852;
2,402,825;
2,527,081;
2,561,232;
2,133,734;
2,230,005;
2,411,215; 2,440,985;
Fr. 801,919.
2,294,259;
2,297,039;
2,380,699;
2,452,321;
2,454,862;
2,467,958;
TERPENESUCCINIC
OH,
ANHYDRIDES
3-Terpinolenesuccinic Anhydride
The reaction of terpinolene with maleic anhydride is typical of nonconjugated monocyclic hydrocarbons. All the terpenes yield mixtures
of monomers and resinous polymers.
Rearrangement to a conjugated
tcrpene takes place very readily if small amounts of maleic acid
or other acids are present in the anhydride.
When this occurs, the
reaction product also contains relatively large proportions of the crystalline Diels-Alder addition product of a-terpinene (q.v.).
3-Terpinolenesuccinic anhydride is a pale yellow oil. When crystalThat it contains two ethylene bonds, in contrast
lized it melts at 182.
to one of the Diels-Alder adduct, has been proved by ozonolysis and
hydrogenation. Terpinolenesuccinic anhydride serves as a plasticizer
for the resin formed during its preparation.
Uses. The reaction described here is utilized commercially in the
production of products sold under the trade name Petrex Acid.* This
acid is a uniform mixture of 50% monomer and 50% polymer. The
acid is used in the manufacture of Petrex Resins, which have a number
These resins are employed for various industrial
of unique properties.
purposes.
Terpenesuccinic anhydrides offer several possibilities for preparing
many new and useful compounds as, for example, agents for controlling
the vulcanization of rubber.
"
Hercules Powder Company.
NON-CONJUGATED TERPENES
HC
CII,
Terpinolene
CH
/ \CII H
HC
S
I/
HC
2
HaC
C-*
yv
C
c c
"
-CH.3
Terpinolene
-f-
Maleic anhydride
H C C CH
8
C C
3-TcrpinoIenesuccinio anhydride
mixture of 68 g. of pure terpinolenc and 49 g. of
Procedure.
acid- free maleic anhydride is heated with good agitation to 18*5.
The
reaction mixture is then allowed to reflux for 1 to 2 hours. The vigorous reaction is largely completed during the first half hour, as shown
by the disappearance of the two layers and the rise in boiling temperaThe mixture is then distilled under reduced pressure. The porture.
tion 6 14 180 to 200
is dissolved in a potassium hydroxide solution
The
of the two for a short period of time.
when
material
removed
and
the
solution
is
by filtration,
unsaponifiable
cooled is acidified with acid. The oil that separates is dissolved in
by heating the mixture
ether.
The
is washed with water, dried, and allowed
oily product so obtained is then allowed to crystala mixture of ethyl acetate and petroleum ether, and recrystal-
to evaporate.
lize
ether solution
The
from
from ethyl acetate.
The yield of pure crystalline adduct is 16%.
non-volatile portion of the products consists of resinous copolymers ranging in molecular weight from 500 to 3000 and containing
an excess of combined anhydride in a ratio of 5:4 to 4:3 moles of maleic
lized
The
anhydride to terpene.
References
Hultzsch, K., Ber 72B, 1173 (1939). C/.:
Diela, O., Koch, W., and Frost, H., Ber. 71B, 1163 (1938).
U.S. 1,992,249; 1,993,033; 2,047,004; 2,067,859; 2,070,553; 2,080,436; 2,118,925; 2,118,926; 2,268,601;
2,268,524; 2,294,651; 2,298,470; 2,321,750; 2,322,542; 2,354,993; 2,366,317; 2,371,235; 2,411,237.
Fr. 842,991
H H
ARALKYLSUCCINIC ACIDS
R C 9R>O
C HS
6
Benzylsuccinic Anhydride
Alkylaromatic hydrocarbons react with maleic anhydride at elevated
temperatures under pressure, at the carbon atom adjacent to the aromatic nucleus. In this respect they resemble the mono-olefins in their
manner
this
of addition.
manner,
besides
Compounds that have been found
toluene,
are
ethylbenzene,
to react in
isopropylbenzene,
p-xylene, cumene, cymene, tetrahydronaphthalene, 2-methylnaphthalene, diphenylmethane, dibenzyl, fluorene, indan, and acenaphthalene.
These reactions apparently involve the formation of free radicals as
part of their mechanism. 9-Phenylmethylanthracene and 1,2,3,4-
tetramethylnaphthalene react like aromatics (q.v.) to give diene-type
adducts, whereas er-butylbenzene, lacking an a-methylene group,
fails to react.
a crystalline solid that melts at 100 to
101. It dissolves gradually in hot water to produce on cooling a crystalline acid melting at 160 to 161.
Benzylsuccinic anhydride
is
Use. Compounds of similar type of structure to the aralkylsuccinic
acids are described as intermediates in the manufacture of dyes, resins,
and synthetic detergents.
10
RCH Ar
ALKYIAROMATIC HYDROCARBONS
Toluene
Benzylsuccinic anhydride
Maleip
anhydride
Procedure.
solution of 1000
g.
of toluene
and 98
g.
of maleic
placed in a pressure vessel and heated gradually over a
period of a half hour to 305 to 315 and then held at this temperature for 20 minutes. An overpressure of 32 atmospheres is developed.
anhydride
Upon
is
cooling, the mixture
becomes
lighter in color.
The
solution
is
then fractionally distilled to free it of the unreacted toluene and the
small amount of maleic anhydride.
References
Fr. patent 775,363 (1934).
Binapfl, J., Ger. patent 607,380 and 623,338 (1935).
C/.i
Alder, K., Paacher, F., and Vagt, H., tier. 75B, 1501 (1942).
Barnett, E. do B., Goodway, N. F., Higgins, A. G., and Lawrence, C. A., J, Chem. Soc.
1934, 1224.
Biokford,
W.
G., Fisher, G. S., Dollear, F. G.,
and Swift, C.
E., J.
Am.
Oil Chem. Soc.
25, 251 (1948).
Clar, E.,
Kloetzel,
Chem. Ber. Proof (U.S. Dept. Commerce O.T.S., Kept. PB 62017).
C., Daylon, R. P., and Herzog, H. L., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 273 (1950).
M.
11
DIELS-ALDER OLEFIN-ADDUCTS
(TETRAHYDROPHTHALIC ANHYDRIDES)
cis-4-Cyclohexene-l ,2-dicarboxylic Anhydride
(cis-4-Tetrahy clroph thalic Anhydride )
This reaction
is
a very general one.
It is
used as a test for ascertaining the
Care should be taken, however, in what
conclusions are drawn from this reaction alone, since certain conjugated compounds, such as the pyrroles, add maleic anhydride in an unusual manner
conjugation of unsaturated groups.
(q.v.) and others, like the thiophenes, are usually completely non-reactive.
Several non-conjugated olefins readily isomerize during reaction, to produce
adducts of the conjugated isomers. Vinylcyclopropane, which shows many of
the properties of conjugated diolefins, does not react with maleic anhydride
at the usual temperatures.
In the presence of nitrobenzene, dehydrogenation
occurs so that substitute phthalic anhydrides are obtained in place of the
partially hydrogenated derivatives.
is
cts-4-Cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic anhydride, like most Diels-Alder adducts,
a crystalline solid. It melts at 103 to 104. It is soluble in most organic
and petroleum ether. The acid may
be obtained by heating the anhydride with water. When recrystallized from
water, it melts at 160.
liquids but only partially soluble in ligroin
Uses.
The adduct with
cyclopentadiene, namely, bicyclo-[2.2.1]-5-heptene-
2,3-dicarboxylic anhydride is known commercially by the trade name, Carbic
Anhydride.* It is an important reactant in the preparation of oil-reactive
resins, which are used in overprint varnishes, ink, waterproof coatings, and
emulsion paints. Adducts with crotonaldehyde acetate have been suggested
for use in the preparation of dyes, pharmaceuticals, and softening agents;
and those from dimethyl muconate and from
When
isoprene, as plasticizers for cellu-
have surface-active properties.
These adducts are also valuable in the synthesis of several pure chemicals.
For example, cts-4-tetrahydrophthalic anhydride may be oxidized to butane-
lose acetate.
sulfonated, these adducts
tetracarboxylic acid with permanganate, and biphenyl
obtained by decarboxylation of the phenyl derivatives.
compounds may be
The reaction itself has been used as a means to remove conjugated compounds in separating fatty-acid mixtures and in separating neovitamin A from
vitamin A, and to purify benzene of dienes.
*Bakelite Division, Carbide and Carbon Chemical Corporation.
12
RCH=CH CH=CHR'
CONJUGATED DIENES
1,3-Butadiene
H
H
C->
HC
1,3-Butadiene
Procedure.
in 10 ml. of pure
/ \HC
jl
>
Maleic
anhydride
cts-4-Cyelopentene-l t
2-dicarboxylio anhydride
solution of 2.5 g. of 1 ,3-butadiene and 4 g. of maleic anhydride
is allowed to stand for 12 hours and is then heated on a
benzene
water bath at 100
cooling.
HC
jl
"v
upon
II
The
for 5 hours.
The product
is
reaction mixture crystallizes completely
recrystallized
from hot
ligroin, giving practically
a quantitative yield of cis-4-tetrahydrophthalic anhydride.
References
and Alder, K., Ann. 460, 98 (1928) Ber. 62B, 2087 (1929). Cf.\
Bergmann, E., Haskelberg, L., and Bergmann, F., J. Org. Chem. 7, 303 (1942).
Buu-HoI and Dat-Xuong, Bull. soc. chim. France 1948, 751.
Craig, D., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 1678 (1950).
Cope, A. C., and Herri ck, E. C., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 984 (1950).
Cosgrove, C., and Earhart, K. A., Ind. Eng. Chem. 41, 1492 (1949).
Diels, O. Z. angew. Chem. 42, 911 (1929).
Dufraisse, C., and Mathieu, J., Bull. soc. chim. France 1947, 307.
Farmer, E. H., and Warren, F. L., /. Chem. Soc. 1929, 903.
Frank, R. L., Emmick, R. D., and Johnson, R. S., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 2313 (1947).
Diels, 0.,
Kloetzel,
M.
C., Org. Reactions 4,
Kohler, E. P., and Kable,
J.,
/.
(1948).
Am. Chem.
Review.
2757 (1934).
Soc. 56,
Korolev, A., and Mur, V., Doklady Akad. Nauk SSSR 59, 71 (1948); Zhur. Obshchei
Khim. (J. Gen. Chem.} 18, 1977 (1948); C. A. 42, 6776i (1942).
Kuhn, R., and Wagner- Jaur egg, T. A., Ber. 63B, 2662 (1930).
J. A., Chem. Revs., 31, 319 (1942).
Review.
Paul, R., and Tchelitcheff, S., Bull soc. chim. France 1948, 108.
Robeson, C. D., and Baxter, J. G., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 136 (1947).
Norton,
Robey, R. F., Science 96, 470 (1942).
Snyder, H. R., Stewart, J. M. t and Meyers, R. L., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 71, 1055 (1949).
Tyutyunnikov, G. N., Coke & Chem. (USSR) 9, (No. 1), 31 (1939) C. A. 34, 2953* (1940).
Van Volkenburg, R., Greenlee, K. W., Derfer, J. M., and Boord, C. E., J. Am. Chem.
;
Soc. 71,
U.S.
3596 (1949).
2,314,846;
2,381,969;
2,384,855;
2,389,136;
Brit. 300,130; 552,644; 578,867.
13
2,397,240;
2,423,234;
2,432,586.
POLYCYCLIC TETRAHYDROPHTHALIC
ANHYDRIDES
l,2,3,10a-Tetrahydro-l,2-phenanthrenedicarboxylic
Anhydride
Certain
arylvinyl
compounds,
such
as
of a chain-conjugated diene, as
are
1-vinylnaphthalene,
manner
capable of adding maleic anhydride, at least in part, in the
shown on the opposite page.
Such
include, besides 1-vinylnaphthalene, certain 1-cyclopentenylnaphthalenes, several 9-vinylphenanthrenes, p-vinylveratroles,
compounds
and p-vinylisosafroles (q.v.). Most arylvinyl compounds, such as
Diarylethylenes add two
styrene, however, can form only copolymers.
moles of maleic anhydride to produce
-labile
bis-adducts.
See, for
example, the reaction of l-phcnyl-l-(3,4-dimethoxyphenyl)ethylene.
Indene also forms a similar cyclic aclduct, but addition takes
place in such a
manner
as to produce l,2,3,4-tetrahydro-l,4-methano-
naphthalene-2,3-dicarboxylic anhydride.
The reaction between 1-vinylnaphthalene
slower than the one with maleic anhydride, but
monomeric adducts.
and
it
fumaric
acid
is
gives a higher yield
of
The cis-l,2,3,10a-tetrahydro-l,2-phenanthrenedicarboxylic anhydride formed in this reaction with maleic anhydride melts at 187.3 to
190,
after softening at
186, according
to
Bachmann and
Scott.
When
under reduced pressure, or refluxed with acetic
evaporatively
or propionic acid, or treated with acetic anhydride and hydrogen
distilled
chloride,
it is
isomerized to the naphthalenic anhydride, cis-l,2,3,4-tet-
rahydro-l,2-phenanthrenedicarboxylic
melts at 170.3 to 170.8.
anhydride.
This
compound
These anhydrides may be used to prepare the corresponding
pure polycyclic hydrocarbons by dehydrogenation and decarboxylation.
Aromatic dicarboxylic acids, such as 1,2-phenanthrenedicarboxylic acid, are obtained by dehydrogenation alone, and compounds such
Use.
as 4/f-cyclopenta[a]phenanthrene-15,17-dione by allowing these anhydrides to react with ethyl acetate. Adducts with 1-vinylnaphthalene have been employed in synthesizing sex hormones.
14
ArCH=CH
ARYLVINYLS
1-Vinylnaphthalene
Maleio
anhydride
l-Vinyl-
naphthalene
Procedure.
solution of 8.5
g.
lOa-Tetrahydrophe-
of 1-vinylnaphthalene
of maleic anhydride in 17 ml. of xylene
3 hours.
,2,3,
nan throne- 1 ,2-dicarboxy Ho
anhydride
is
and
5.7 g.
heated on a steam bath for
deposit of the adduct begins to form in the yellow solution
Upon completion of the reaction, the mix-
after 10 minutes' heating.
ture
is
allowed to stand for 12 hours at
yield of crude product
is
13
g.,
or
91.5%
and then
is filtered.
of theory.
References
Kloetzel, M. C., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 60, 2204 (1938).
Alder, K., Paschor, F., and Vagt, H., Ber. 75B, 1501 (1942).
Arnold, R. T., and Coyner, E. C., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 66, 1642 (1944).
Bachmann, W. E. and
t
Bachmann, W. E., and Deno, N. C., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 71, 3062 (1949).
Bachmann, W. E., and Scott, L. B., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1462 (1948).
Bergmann, E., and Bergmann, F. J., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 59, 1443 (1937).
Bergmann, F., and Szmuszkovicz, J., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 2748 (1948).
Bergmann, F., and Weizmann, A., J. Org. Chem. 11, 592 (1946).
Cohen, A., Nature 136, 869 (1935).
Cohen, A., and Warren, F. L., /. Chem. Soc. 1937, 1318.
Szmuszkovicz, J., and Bergmann, F., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 1779 (1947).
Szmuszkovicz, J., and Modest, E. J., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 2542 (1948),
U.S. 2,430,109.
15
C/.:
The
AROMATIC ADDUCTS
9,10-Dihydro-9 9 10-ethanoanthracene-ll,12-dicarboxylic
Anhydride
(9,10-Dihydroanthracene-9,10-endo-a,#-succinic Anhydride)
Aromatic hydrocarbons, such as benzene, naphthalene, and phenan-
As a general
threne, usually do not react with maleic anhydride.
for
aromatic
which
the
it
is
a compolynuclear
compounds,
only
rule,
Kekule structure cannot be drawn, that readily condense with
Such compounds include anthracene, naphthacene,
1,2-benzanthracene, and the like, Chrysene and 1,2,3,4-tetramethylnaphthalene are the exceptions. The methyl groups in the latter complete
this dienophile.
pound probably so activate the aromatic rings that addition can take
place under proper experimental conditions. This led Norton to predict that even benzene and naphthalene might add dienophiles if they
could be made unusually reactive, provided of course that they formed
sufficiently heat-stable adducts.
zog.)
(See reference to Kloetzel and Her-
Benzathrene adds maleic anhydride but rearranges in doing
9-Methyleneanthrone and
manner
its
derivatives
add the anhydride
in
so.
similar to that of vinylnaphthalencs.
Anthracene forms a well-defined crystalline adduct that shows no
is observed with anthracene
fluorescence under an arc lamp, such as
itself.
Uses.
This adduct melts at 223.
Little study as yet has been given to possible uses for these
compounds except for methods of separating polynuclear hydrocarbons.
Treated with alcoholic potassium hydroxide, the anthracene adduct
yields the corresponding anthrone derivative.
16
POLYNUCLEAR
AROMATIC HYDROCARBONS
Anthracene
H
Anthracene
Maleic
anhydride
9,10-Dihydro-9,10ethanoanthracene11,12-dicarboxylic
anhydride
Procedure.
Forty-two
g.
of anthracene
and 25
g. of
maleic anhy-
dride are allowed to react in a boiling solution of 250 ml. of o-dichlorobenzene for one hour. Crystals of the adduct separate readily during
the cooling of the reaction mixture.
They
are recrystallized, first from
o-chlorobenzene and then from xylene.
References
Barnett, E. de B,, Goodway, N. F., Figging, A. G., and Lawrence, C. A., J. Chem. Soc.
C/.:
1934, 1224.
Allen, C. F. H., and Bell, A., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 64, 1253 (1942).
W. E., and Scott, L. B., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1458 (1948).
W. G., Fisher, G. S., Dollear, F. G., and Swift, C. E., /. Am.
Bachraann,
Bickford,
Oil Chemists'
Soc. 25 (No. 7), 251 (1948).
609 (1943); 81, 163 (1948).
J., and Sharpe, R. W., Can. J. Research 26B, 719 (1948).
Kloetzel, M. C., Dayton, R. P., Herzog, H. L., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 273 (1950).
Kloetzel, M. C., and Herzog, H. L., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 1991 (1950).
Norton, J. A., Chem. Revs. 31, 319 (1942).
Szmuszkovicz, J., and Modest, E. J., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 566 (1950).
Clar, E., Ber. 76B,
Jones, R. N., Gogek, C.
U.S. 2,511,577.
Ger. 623,338.
17
TERPENE ADDUCTS
5-Isopropyl-7-mcthylbicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octene-2,3-dicarboxylic
Anhydride
(7-Isopropyl-3,6-ethano-4-hexene-l,2-dicarboxylic Anhydride)
The formation
adduct with monocyclic terdouble
bonds
is far from quantitative in
penes containing conjugated
most cases. Although the yield here is 90% with a-phellandrene, it is
of a Diels-Alder type of
usually only 30 to
such as a-terpinene.
with other conjugated monocyclic terpenes,
The remainder of the products are chain copoly-
50%
mers that vary in their ratio of maleic anhydride to terpene. The
copolymer of a-phellandrene for instance, has a molecular weight of
1220 and a molar ratio of 6 parts of anhydride to 5 of terpene. Com;
also present in the reaction products of maleic
a
with
non-conjugated monocyclic terpene (<?.f.), if small
anhydride
amounts of acid are present to cause isomerization.
pounds of these types are
5-Isopropyl-7-methylbicyclo [2.2.2] -7-octene-2,3-dicarboxylic anhydride melts at 126 to 127. It forms a crystalline acid and ammonium
can be completely distilled under reduced pressure.
These crystalline adducts, or the reaction mixtures of them
with the copolymers formed simultaneously, may be combined with
polyhydric alcohols to produce polyesters. These polyesters are used
in coatings, inks, plasticizers, adhesives, linoleum, and food wrappers.
salt.
It
Use.
The
glycol ester has been
employed as a rubber
substitute.
De-
emulsifying agents for petroleum, sudsing and wetting agents, and
synthetic tanning agents can be prepared from them.
18
CONJUGATED TERPENES
H.
HC
3
a-Phellaiidrene
en,
>
c-c
-H
HC(CH
H
S) 2
^V
Y^n
HC(CH S) 2
Maleic
anhydride
a-Phellandrene
5-l8opropyl-7rnethyl-bicyclo
t2.2.2]-7-octene-
2,3-dicarboxylic
anhydride
To
Procedure.
a-phellandrene in 10 ml. of
benzene 7 g. of maleic anhydride is added, and the mixture is thoroughly
shaken. The shaking causes the liquid to turn yellow. The reaction
mixture is then heated at 40 to 50 for one hour, during which time the
a solution of 10
g. of
maleic anhydride dissolves completely. The solution is filtered, evaporated, and the residue recrystallized from boiling methanol. The
The yield
resulting crystals are dried at 100 under reduced pressure.
90% of theory.
may also be carried
10% polymeric by-product may be
is
approximately
The
reaction
out without solvent at
55.
The
recovered also.
References
and Alder, K., Ann. 460, 116 (1928). C/.:
Koch, W., and Frost, H., Ber. 71B, 1163 (1938).
Hopaeld, J. J., Hall, S. A. and Goldblatt, L. A., /. Am. Chem.
Diels, 0.,
Diels, O.,
Soc. 66, 115 (1944).
Hultzsch, K., Ber. 723, 1173 (1939).
Ipatieff, V. N., and Pines, H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 66, 1120 (1944).
Kienle, R. H., Ind. Eng. Chem. 22, 590 (1930).
Littmann, E. R., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 58, 1316 (1936); Ind. Eng. Chem. 28, 1150 (1936).
Norton, J. A., Chem. Revs. 31, 417 (1942).
U.S.
1,993,025;
2,347,970;
2,436,048.
2,126,944;
2,347,923;
2,348,575; 2,354,993; 2,373,413; 2,383,791; 2,403,098;
Ger. 625,903; 627,783; 633,420. Brit. 563,238.
2,407,937;
1,993,034;
1,993,035;
1,993,037;
19
2,081,753;
HEXAHYDRONAPHTHALENETETRACARBOXYLIC DIANHYDRIDES
H
v
It'
<s\
\9H>0
l,2,3,4,5,6,7,ll,12,13,16,17-Dodecahydro-15-cyclopenla[a]phenanthrene-6,7 ,11,1 2- tetracar boxy lie Dianhy dride
(Steradiene-6,7,ll,12-tetracarboxylic Dianhydride)
This reaction illustrates
certain dieneynes.
how maleic anhydride may combine with
Here the acetylene bond
is
the equivalent of two
In
olefin groups, thus giving rise to a double Diels-Alder addition.
this respect, these dieneynes are similar to conjugated tetraenes, except
that tetraenes do not produce conjugated bicyclic derivatives. 2,5-Dimethyl-l,5-hexadien-3-yne also reacts with two moles of maleic anhydride in a like manner, indicating that the reaction
for both chain
and
cyclic dienynes of this type.
is
a general one
That the products
contain a conjugated group with the unsaturated bonds in different
shown by comparing their absorption spectra with com-
rings has been
pounds known to contain such structures. The parent aromatic hydrocarbons have been prepared from these adducts by heating them with
palladium and charcoal.
These dienynes do not react with maleic anhydride at temperatures
much below 100. Side reactions also occur that would account for
the relatively low yields. It has been noted that small amounts of
impurities in the reactants markedly affect the results.
The product obtained in this preparation occurs as colorless crystals
that melt in an evacuated tube at 252 to 253 without decomposition.
Heated with ethyl alcohol, it yields the monoethyl ester. This melts at
223 to 230, with discoloration and evolution of gas. The acid can be
obtained in 94% yield from the anhydride. It melts at 231 to 232
with decomposition. The tetraethyl ester melts at 117.5 to 120.5.
Hydrogenation with an Adams catalyst gives 89% of sterene-6,7,11,12tetracarboxylic acid, which melts at 164.5 to 170.5.
Use. Some of these compounds were prepared for studying the
metabolism of steroids in animals.
20
CH
HC
DIALKENYLACETYLENE
R'
C=C C
(l-Cyclohexen-l-yl)(l-cyclopenten-l-yl)acetylene
(1-Cyclohexen-l-yl) (1-oyclopentenMaleic anhydride
1-yl) acetylene
1,2,3,4,5,6,7,11,12,13,16,-
17-Dodecahydro-15cyclopenta [a]
phenanthrene-6,7, 11,12tetracarboxylic dianhydride
Preparation. Three moles of freshly distilled maleic anhydride
one of (1-cyclohexen-l-yl) (1-cyclopenten-l-yl) acetylene are
heated at 150 for 3 hours in a sealed tube, in an atmosphere of nitroThe reaction mixture, after cooling, is extracted with ether, and
gen.
the residue from the ether extract is then recrystallized from ethyl
acetate or dioxane. This yields 15 to 17% of the above dianhydride.
and
References
Butz, L. W., and Joshel, L. M., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 63, 3344 (1941); 64, 1311 (1942). C/.:
Butz, L. W., Gaddis, A. M., Butz, E. W. J., and Davis, R. E., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 62,
995 (1940); J. Org. Chem. 5, 379 (1940).
Joshel, L. M., Butz, L. W., and Feldman, J., J.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 63,
3348 (1941).
Klebanskii, A. L., Popov, L. D., and Tsukerman, N. Ya., /. Gen. Chem.
2083 (1946); C. A. 42, 858g (1948).
U.S. 2,031,481.
21
(USSR)
16,
^-SUBSTITUTED SUCCINIC ANHYDRIDES
R29JIX)
a,/3-Bis (triphenylmethyl)succinic
Compounds capable
Anhydride
of splitting into free radicals will react with
derivatives of ethylene such as maleic anhydride, either in an inert
solvent or in the molten condition to produce the disubstituted products.
Two
reactions of this type have been carried out with maleic anhydride,
namely, the above reaction with hexaphenylethane and the reaction
with hexaphenyldilead
(q.v.).
trichloromethyl radicals
when produced by
chloride with benzoyl
peroxide.
similar addition takes place with
the reaction of carbon tetra-
(See Reaction of
Carbon Tetra-
In contrast,
chlorotriphenylmethane reacts with silver
fumarate to yield only the triphenylmethyl ester, without affecting
the unsaturation of the fumarate.
chloride.)
anhydride is a crystalline solid
that melts at 232 when crystallized from acetone. The acid is readily
soluble in ether and can be separated from the anhydride by this sola,/2-B is (triphenylmethyl) succinic
Crystallized from acetic acid,
dimethylester melts at 212 to 213.
vent.
Use.
No
it
decomposes at 148.
The
commercial use has yet been made of these reactions.
22
R R
FREE RADICALS
Hexaphenylethane
O
H
(H & C 6 ) 3 C-
Hexaphenylethane
>
Maleio anhydride
a,/9-Bis(triphenylmethyl)suocinio
anhydride
Procedure. To 200 ml. of a benzene solution of hexaphenylethane,
which has been prepared by allowing finely divided silver to react with
120
The
g.
of chlorotriphenylmethane, 40 g. of maleic anhydride
several hours.
The
is
added.
refluxed in an atmosphere of nitrogen for
reacted mixture is then extracted with a
reaction mixture
is
3%
sodium hydroxide solution. An insoluble salt forms at the interface
This salt and the aqueous solution are then
of the two solutions.
extracted with ether. Whereupon, 60 g. of
and
separated, acidified,
acid and 12 g. of the anhydride are obtained from the extract.
References
Conant,
J. B.,
and Chow, B.
Leeper, R. W., Iowa State
F., /.
Am. Chcm.
Coll. J. Sci. 18,
Soc. 55, 3475 (1933).
57 (1943).
23
C/.:
POLYMERS
(-9R(OR),-),
Ethyl Polysuccinates
Polymerization of this type occurs to varying degrees in the preparacompounds of maleic and fumaric acids, especially if
tion of several
catalysts, such as benzoyl peroxide (q.v.), are present that can induce
Such addition polymerization
self-addition of the maleic compound.
takes place very readily in the preparation of esters with polyhydric
alcohols; it occurs after two or more moles of maleic acid have reacted
to
form a polymaleate. Air may accelerate such a reaction under cerby producing peroxides.
Ethyl polysuccinate is a soft, colorless resin that is soluble in ethyl
tain conditions
alcohol, acetone, ethyl acetate, butyl acetate, benzene, toluene, xylene,
and aromatic naphthas.
It is insoluble in aliphatic hydrocarbons.
Coating compositions of good color stability and excellent
characteristics are obtained from ethyl polysuccinate.
Use is also
Uses.
made
of this type of reaction by admixing maleic anhydride in small
amounts with other anhydrides in manufacturing several important
types of mixed alkyd resins. Glycol polysuccinates give coatings that
dry in air when siccatives are added. Esters from dienols have been
suggested as drying-oil substitutes. Nitroalkyl esters produce combusUnsaturated esters from allyl
tible plastics and binders for explosives.
alcohol and its homolog yield an important group of cast plastics, rubEmulsion polymers of this type have been recombers, and fibers.
mended as plasticizers for synthetic rubber, and the diethylene glycol
polyesters as binders for low-pressure molding compounds.
24
MALEYL COMPOUNDS
9R(OR) 2
H C2 0-C-CH
5
H
C-C-OC H
2
HC
I
0=C-OC2 H
Diethyl fumarate
Ethyl polysuccinate
Diethyl Fumarate
Procedure. A solution of 4 g. of benzoyl peroxide in 200 g. of
diethyl fumarate is heated on a water bath for 7 hours. The unpolymerized ethyl fumarate is then removed by distillation, leaving 179 g.
(89%
of theory) of ethyl polysuccinate.
References
Dykstra, H.
B., U.S. 1945307 (1934).
Cf.:
Doscher, C. K. Colloid Chem. 6, 1068 (1946); J. Alexander, Editor.
Gabriel, A. E., Modern Plastics 25 (No. 8), 145 (1948).
f
Marvel, C.
U.S.
8., Prill,
2,254,382;
E.
J.,
and De Tar, D.
2,319,575;
2,319,576;
F., /.
Am. Chem.
2,370,565;
Soc. 69, 52 (1947).
2,379,247;
2,392,621;
2,410,074; 2,410,425; 2,411,136; 2,415,366; 2,425,144; 2,442,330.
Dutch 59,166. Ger. 699,445.
572,777; 589,861.
25
2,404,688;
Brit.
552,228;
\COPOLYMERS
CH
CH.2
Polyethylenesuccinic Anhydride
This copolymerization is typical of many of the catalyzed reactions
compounds with those containing vinyl or substituted ethyl-
of maleyl
ene groups.
Several arylvinyl compounds, like a-vinylnaphthalene,
indene, and propenylphenyl ethers such as isosafrole, however, undergo the typical Diels-Alder condensation in the absence of peroxides
(q.v.)
but stilbene, 9-benzylidenefluorene, 9-anisylidenefluorene, 1,4-
diphenyl-1-butene, and l,10-diphenyl-l,3,5,7,9-decapentaene form
chain compounds similar to those of cthylene even when no peroxide
is
added to the reactants.
Many
sition
of these reactions yield products that are of constant compoof initial concentrations of
and molecular weight irrespective
Some reactions require a solvent, whereas other reactants
only in the presence of themselves. The molecular proportion of succinyl groups in the product varies with the particular ethylene derivative. Some can be made to react in molecular proportions,
such as propylene, isobutylene and diisobutylene. Others contain only
an excess of one or the other of the reactants. In general, maleyl com-
reactants.
will unite
pounds show a reaction
selectivity that favors the alternating lil-type
of copolymer.
Polyethylenesuccinic anhydride is a solid that dissolves readily in
hydrolyzes slowly to give the polyacid. A 10% soluThe
tion at 25 has a pH of 5.2 and a viscosity of 11.6 centipoises.
warm water and
copolymer is also soluble in alkalies.
Use. Polyalkylenesuccinic anhydrides have been used as tanning
agents, photographic chemicals, gelatin substitutes, textile agents,
petroleum chemicals, protein hardeners, alkyd resin ingredients, and
as an intermediate in producing naphthol dyes for color photography.
Polyphenylethylenesuccinates may be used for coatings, resins, lacquer,
base-exchange resins, and plastics; mixed vinyl copolymers when sulfonated, as detergents; and methyl methacrylate copolymers, as solvents and plasticizers. Copolymers with vinyl compounds have adhesive and other properties that are not readily obtained in other ways,
whereas maleinized rubbers not only adhere better to metals but are
partially vulcanized during the copolymerization.
26
H C=CH
2
ETHYLENE AND DERIVATIVES
INCLUDING VINYLS
Ethylene
H H
C=C
H H
Ethylene
H
-
IIC=0
-j-
H H
>
O=C
-f
>
Maleic anhydride
Polyethylenesucoinio
anhydride
A solution containing 30 g. of maleic anhydride and
bcnzoyl peroxide in 200 ml. of toluene is placed in an autoHeat is
clave, and ethylene is added until the weight increases 40 g.
then applied, initiating an exothermic reaction at about 100, at which
point the temperature rises rapidly to 150. The mixture is carefully
held at the higher temperature for one hour before being cooled. The
product formed is insoluble in toluene and is thus recovered by filtraThe yield is 35 g., or 88% of theory.
tion.
Procedure.
1.5 g. of
References
W. E., U.S. 2,378,629 (1945). C/.:
Alder, K., Pascher, F., and Vagt, H., Ber. 75B, 1051 (1942).
Hanford,
Alfrey, T., and Lavin, E., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 2044 (1945).
Bartlett, P. D., and Nozaki, K., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 68, 1495 (1946).
Bachmann, W. E., and Scott, L. B., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1462 (1948).
Ebers, E. S., et al., Ind. Eng. Chem. 42, 114 (1950).
Lewis, F. M., Walling, C., Mayo, F. R., et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1519, 1529, 1533,
1543, 1544 (1948); 71, 1930 (1949); 73, 2819 (1951).
Marvel, C. S., et al., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 64, 1675 (1942); 69, 52 (1947).
Rust, J. B., Ind. Eng. Chem. 32, 64 (1940).
Starkweather, H. W., et al., Ind. Eng. Chem. 39, 210 (1947).
Tong, L. K. J., and Kenyon, W. O., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 71, 1925 (1949).
Wagner-Jauregg, T., Ber. 63B, 3213 (1930).
U.S.
2,365,717;
2,373,067;
2,392,139;
2,394,527;
2,439,953.
Brit.
2,375,960;
2,396,785;
561,800;
2,384,085;
2,384,595;
2,384,855;
2,391,621;
2,403,213;
2,436,256;
2,438,102;
2,439,227;
562,092; 563,288; 583,474; 584,622; 585,969.
437,996.
27
Can.
CHAPTER
Halogens and Their Compounds
The hydrocarbon
reactions described in the first chapter were limited
to the saturation of the carbon-carbon double
Halogens and their compounds
bond
of maleic
com-
wider variety of reactions.
Included in this chapter are reactions involving not only the
ethylene bond, but also those embracing the hydroxyl and carbonyl
groups. In fact, a halogen reaction can be carried out with every
pounds.
offer a
atom of the maleyl group.
The addition of halogens, themselves, is an interesting study of the
effect of reaction conditions upon the yield of different optical isomers.
Whereas a,/3-dichlorosuccinic acid may be obtained as either the
racemic acid or the meso-acid, a,/3-dibromosuccinic acid is produced
only as a mixture of isomers under all conditions. Dichlorosuccinic
acids, like tartaric acids, are often cited as a classical
example of
optical activity.
Addition of a dehydrohalogenating agent in the reaction with chlorine
produces chloromaleic acid, which acts in many syntheses as if it were
acetylenedicarboxylic acid as a result of the ease with which it splits
off hydrogen chloride during many of its reactions.
Considerable difficulty is encountered in effecting the addition of
Hydrogen chloride, for example, can be caused to react
only in excess in an anhydrous solution, whereas very poor yields are
reported for the reaction of hydrogen bromide by various methods.
halo acids.
Hypochlorous acid, in marked contrast, readily adds to the ethylene
bond of maleates even in an aqueous solution to give /3-chloromalic
acid.
This product readily splits off hydrogen chloride, especially in
alkaline
solution,
to
give the interesting dicarboxyethylene
oxide,
epoxysuccinic acid.
The
reaction with mixed alkyl chlorides through a splitting off of
28
hydrogen chloride gives the alkenylsuccinic acids. This affords a convenient means of adding olefinic groups to the ethylene bond of maleic
anhydride by starting with saturated hydrocarbons.
Compounds such as 2-bromo-l,l-diphenylethylene probably first
undergo a multiple Diels-Alder reaction, but the product not only loses
hydrogen bromide and some maleic anhydride but also undergoes autodehydrogenation upon sublimation during the purification.
No evidence has as yet been obtained that acid chlorides are capable
of adding to the ethylene bond of maleyl compounds.
With maleic
and fumaric acids, fumaryl chloride is the product formed. With
maleamic acid, imides and amides are produced. When maleic acid
is treated with phosphorus pentachloride and the reaction mixture is
immediately distilled under reduced pressure, a product isomeric with
unknown maleyl chloride has been reported. This compound is a
lactone having the ring structure of maleic anhydride where two chloro
groups replace an oxygen of one of the carbonyls.
the
Carbon tetrachloride
in the presence of benzoyl peroxide treated
with maleates gives a,^-bis(trichloromethyl)succinates as one of the
products of the reaction. The catalyst apparently reacts with the
carbon tetrachloride to produce trichloromethyl free radicals, which,
like triphenylmethyl, add to both carbons of the ethylene bond of the
maleate.
As
is
pointed out in the discussion of that reaction, dioxane
forms, in contrast, the dioxanylsuccinate.
29
X 9R(OH)
2
a,/3-DIHALOSUCCINIC ACIDS
mcso-a,j(3-Dichloro8uccinic Acid
a,/3-Dichlorosuccinic acids
may
be obtained either as the racemic
The product formed
acid mixture or the inseparable weso-acid.
preparation
what
is
is
known
acid has been
in this
reported to be exclusively the meso-acid produced by
as a trans-addition. The racemic a,/?-dichlorosuccinic
made in a similar manner from maleic acid.
when chlorine is added to aqueous solutions
addition occurs
cis-
of the
soluble neutral salts in the presence of an excess of chloride ions.
Commercially, molten maleic anhydride
is
treated with chlorine under
pressure to produce the a,-dichlorosuccinic anhydride.
Bromine, in contradistinction, yields mixtures of the isomers under
The meso-acid is the predominant product when this
added
to aqueous solutions of the neutral salts of either
halogen
maleic or fumaric acid. The racemic acid is usually prepared by carrying out the reaction in anhydrous ether.
all conditions.
is
weso-a,/?-Dichlorosuccinic acid occurs as bright hexagonal, bilateral
pointed prisms, which sinter at 190 and melt at 215. The acid is
soluble in water, alcohol, ether, acetone, and chloroform, but only
slightly soluble in benzene
to
167,
and
ligroin.
The racemic
acid melts at 166
as does both the d- and the J-acids.
a,/J-Dihalosuccinic acids have been extensively used in the
synthesis of a large number of chemical compounds. Propargylic acid
Use.
acetylenedicarboxylic acid; a,/?-dihalosuccinamic acids; a,/2-dichloroN-phenylsuccinimides a-bromo-N-(p-tolyl)maleimide; halomaleic and
;
halofumaric acids; a-chloro-/?-iodoacrylic acid; a,a,,/?-tetrachloro-Nphenylsuccinimide
a ,/?-diarsonosuccinic
acid
a,/2-diphenoxysuccinic
acid; 2,3,4,5-thiophenetctracarboxylic acid; hydrazinomalehydroxamic
acid; 4-oxo-l,4-benzopyrancarboxylic acid; 4-pyrone; 2,3-dihydro-5-
phenyl-2,3,4-furantricarboxylic acid; weso-a,/?-diaminosuccinic acid;
and 1,2,3-cyclopropanetricarboxylic acid are some of the types of
substances that have been prepared from these acids.
The alkyl esters of dichlorosuccinic acids are valuable fungicides.
30
HALOGENS
Chlorine
C C OH
Cl->
Cl
GOH
"""^
CH
Cl->
Cl-CH
O=COH
COH
Chlorine
Procedure.
>
Fumaric acid
mixture of 10
g.
meso-a,/3-Dichlorosuccinio
acid
of fumaric acid
and 5
g.
of ice
is
placed in a heavy-walled, heat-resistant flask. The flask is then
placed in a cooling bath of solid carbon dioxide and ether, and an
excess of chlorine is passed through the reaction mixture, being fed
stream into the flask at or below the level of the cooling
Practically all the chlorine condenses to a liquid within the
in a strong
fluid.
The reaction mixture is then exposed to bright sunlight for 4
days, while being agitated vigorously. The excess of chlorine is
blown out of the flask after the contents have been cooled in an ice-
flask.
and the mushy product
salt mixture,
sucked free of
liquid.
What
is
transferred to a filter and
remains in the
filtrate is
then extracted
with ether, and the combined recovery of dichlorosuccinic acid
recrystallized
from water.
The
total yield in this
way
is
practically
quantitative.
References
Kirchhoff, H., Ann. 280, 210 (1894).
Frankland, E. P., Proc. Chem. Soc.
Cf.i
206 (1911); /. Chem. Soc. 99, 1775 (1911).
G. Farbenindustrie, A-G. U.S. Dept. Commerce OTS Report PB 84252.
Robinson, H. V. W., and Lewis, D. T. /. Chem. Soc. 1933, 1260.
Ruhemann, S. and Stapleton, H. E., /. Chem. Soc. 77, 1179 (1900).
Terry, E. M., and Eichelberger, L., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 47, 1067 (1925).
Wenner, W., /. Org. Chem. 13, 26 (1948).
I.
27,
31
is
HALOMALEIC ANHYDRIDES
HC C
II
o
Chloromaleic Anhydride
The barium
ating agent.
chloride in this preparation serves as a dehydrochlorinhas no effect on the rate of chlorination. Benzoic
It
anhydride, phthalic anhydride, or benzoyl peroxide may be used also
for the same purpose.
Pure chloromaleic anhydride is a solid at ordinary temperatures,
melting at 33 to a liquid that boils at 196.3.
Use. The dialkyl esters of this anhydride copolymerize with 1,3-
butadiene to give valuable synthetic rubbers.
Chloromaleic anhydride is itself also a valuable reagent in
many
organic syntheses. With conjugated drying oils, it gives infusible soluble resins. With substituted propenylbenzenes, this anhydride yields
a substituted dihydronaphthalenedicarboxylic anhydride. With conjugated dienes, and cyclic hydrocarbons such as anthracene, it gives
chlorinated Diels-Alder type of adducts. In the presence of sodium
alkoxides, however, chloromaleic esters condense with keto esters,
malonates, and substituted phenols to yield derivatives of maleic acid
by splitting off sodium chloride without affecting the unsaturation.
Thus
diethyl chlorofumarate and ethyl acetoacetate form triethyl
acetoaconitate. This product reacts with concentrated ammonia to
give
1 ,2,3,4-tetrahydro-3-hydroxy-6-methyl-2-oxocinchomeric
acid.
Halomaleic esters react with ammonia to form aminomaleimides,
halomaleamic acids, and aminomaleamides. Aniline yields halomaleaa-anilino-N-phenylmaleimide, and a-anilinofumaramides.
Phenylhydrazine gives phenylhydrazonosuccinamide.
Chloromaleic acid reacts with chlorine in the presence of a small
nilic acids,
amount
of
adhesives
water to produce a,a,/?-trichlorosuccinic acid. Cements and
may be had from condensation of the acid with glycerol or
polyamines.
32
HALOGENS
A1C1 3 C1 2
II
Chlorine
HIC-C
Cl-ICl
HC-C
A
Chlorine
4*
Maleic
anhydride
>*
Chlormaleic
anhydride
Procedure. A mixture of 306 g. of maleic anhydride, 6 g. of barium
chloride, and 6 g. of anhydrous aluminum chloride is heated to 140 to
150 and then treated with chlorine at this temperature, with vigorous
The reaction mixture is then distilled under
agitation, for 8 hours.
partial vacuum, and the portion is collected that boils at 97 to 103
under 35 mm. of pressure. An excellent yield of chloromaleic anhydride is obtained in this manner.
The anhydride may
also be prepared under similar conditions with-
out the use of barium chloride. In this case, nearly 24 hours is
required instead of 8 for the gain in weight to equal that calculated
for the necessary conversion to the monochloromaleic anhydride.
The
technical product obtained in this preparation has a slightly narrower
boiling range of 6 50
111-114.
References
Wise, P., and Milone, C., U.S. 2,342,174 (1944).
<?/.:
Muiz, E., and Mark, H., /. Polymer Research 1, 37 (194G).
Claus, A., and Voeller, F., Ber. 14, 150 (1881).
Mast, W. C., and Fisher, C. H., Ind. Eng, Chem. 40, 107 (1948).
Putnam, S. T., Moss, M. L., and Hall, R. T., Ind. Eng. Chem., Anal. Ed.,
Alfrey, T.,
18,
028
(1946).
S., et al., /. Chem. Soc. 69, 530,532,1386 (1896); 71, 323 (1897); 79, 1186
(1901); 81, 1212 (1902).
Synerholm, M. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 345, 1229 (1945),
Ruhemann,
Thomas-Mamert, R., Compt. rend. 117, 167
van der Riet, S. J., Ann. 280, 216 (1894).
Am. Chem.
(1893).
J. 9, 180 (1888); Ber. 21, 2718 (1887); /. prakt. Chem. (2), 52, 289 (1896).
U.S. 2,370,055; 2,391,226; 2,391,261; 2,404,411; 2,422,470; 2,436,902.
570,263; 570,867; 572,137.
33
Brit.
570,216;
HALOSUCCINIC ACIDS
C19JI(OH) 2
Chlorosuccinic Acid
may be prepared in similar manner to that
on
the opposite page for chlorosuccinic acid. Bromosuccinic
given
acid, for example, has been prepared by using fuming hydrobromic
acid at 100. Fittig claimed to have obtained complete conversion
under these conditions, but Dunn and Fox report poor yields, not only
Other halosuccinic acids
for this but also for other methods.
When
recrystallized
from water or acetic
melts at 151.5 to 152.
acid.
It is
acid, chlorosuccinic acid
very soluble in water and hot acetic
only slightly soluble in cold acetic acid, however, and very
It is
slightly soluble in chloroform.
Use.
Halosuccinic acids are convenient starting substances for synthesizing a number of compounds. They are used, for instance, in
the preparation of mercaptosuccinic acid, which is employed for making
the medicinal, aurothiomalic acid. Ethylmercaptosuccinic acid can
be prepared in a similar manner. It can be oxidized to ethylsulfonylsuccinic acid, which in turn can be converted to /2-bromo-/3-ethylsulfonylpropionic acid. The halogen group of the halosuccinic acid can
by an xantho group or by an iodo group.
with benzophene and zinc to give ethyl
iodosuccinate
reacts
Ethyl
With
aqueous ammonia, bromosuccinic acid
y,y-diphenylparaconate.
also be readily replaced
forms /J-malamic acid.
Halosuccinic acids also readily undergo condensation in the presence
of sodium ethoxide.
Ethyl 2-oxocyclopentanecarboxylate reacts with
diethyl bromosuccinate, for example, to produce l-carboxy-2-oxo-l-
cyclopentylsuccinic acid.
34
HX
HALO ACIDS
Hydrochloric Acid
0=COH
H-
CH
HC COH
C1-*
C COH
C1C
"4
A
Hydrochloric
>
Fumaric acid
-j-
COH
acid
Chlorosuccinic
acid
Procedure. A convenient quantity of fumaric acid is placed in a
An excess of a saturated solution of hydrogen
flask and cooled to 0.
chloride in acetic acid is added and the mixture is heated on a water
bath for 12 to 14 hours, with constant agitation.
Part of the chloroformed separates when the solution is cooled.
removed, and the mother liquor is then evaporated under re-
succinic acid that
This
is
is
duced pressure to incipient crystallization
remainder of the product.
The
acid
may
also be prepared
in
from malic
order to recover the
acid.
References
Anschtitz, R., and Bennert, C., Ber. 15, 640 (1882).
C/.:
Baker, J. W., /. Chem. Soc. 1931, 1546.
Dunn, M. S., and Fox, S. W., /. BioL Chem. 101, 493 (1933).
2943 (1921).
Ber. 10, 513 (1877); 9, 1192 (1876).
Fitger, P., Ber. 54B,
Fittig, R.
Freudenberg, K., Piazolo, G. and Knoevenagel, C., Ann. 537, 197 (1939).
Grove, J. F., and Bovington, H. H. S., Ann. Applied Biol. 34, 113 (1947).
Holmberg, B., /. prakt. Chem. 88, (2) 553 (1913).
Levene, P. A., and Mikeska, L. A., J. BioL Chem. 60, 685 (1924).
f
Lutz, O., Chem. Zentr. 1900, (II), 1009.
Newberry, G., and Webster, W., J. Chem.
210 (1893).
Moffatt,
J. S.,
Walden,
P., Ber. 26,
U.S. 2,358,130; 2,380,061; 2,385,018.
35
Soc. 1946, 451.
EPOXYSUCCINIC ACID
0<9lt(OH) 2
df-trans-a,j3-Epoxysuccinic Acid
The preparation
as described here yields di-rans-a,/?-epoxysuccinic
This acid can be readily resolved into its optical isomers.
Fumaric acid when substituted for maleic acid in the reaction gives a
acid.
The
yield of a mixture of the dl-trans-&cid and the cis-acid.
of
the
mixture.
Upon hydrolysis, the
27%
acid and 63% of
mixture
of
di-tartaric
a
di-rans-acid yields
37%
72%
latter acid comprises only
weso-tartaric acid.
The di-ram-a,/3-epoxysuccinic
180.
acid melts at 209
the d- and the
mixture of equal quantities of the optically
active acids has the same melting point as the racemic acid. The
I-acids melt at
cts-acid melts at
its
149.
No
success has been
had
in resolving
it
into
active isomers.
Use.
Little study has been given to the reactions of this acid.
should be an interesting reagent, since
grouping.
36
it
It
contains the ethylene oxide
OXYHALO ACIDS
HOC1
Hypochlorous Acid
Cl
"
H
0-C-C-ONa
H
C-C-ONa
H
0-^
C-C-ONa
Hypo-
Sodium
-f"
maleate
chlorous
acid
Procedure.
of water
is
-^
Sodium
/S-chloromalate
->
a.^-Epoxvmiccinic
acid
solution containing 80 g. of maleic acid in 1 liter
neutralized with 55.2 g. of sodium hydroxide in a 20-liter
To this is added a solution of 63 g. of chlorine in 11 liters of
water. The flask then is sealed with a rubber stopper and permitted
to stand for 22 hours.
A glass stopper should be avoided. The reacflask.
is then treated with 60 g. of sodium hydroxide, and,
further
for 2 days, 170 g. of barium chloride hydrate
standing
upon
This causes 105 g. of the barium salt of dJ-rans-a,/3-expoxyis added.
tion mixture
succinic acid to precipitate.
Twenty grams of sodium hydroxide is
then added to the mother liquor, and an additional 45 g. of the barium
salt is obtained upon standing several days.
The combined product
The yield
is then decomposed with sulfuric acid in the usual manner.
of theory.
An ether extraction of the mother liquor yields
of impure cis-a,/2-epoxysuccinic acid.
amounts
small
only
is
75%
Reference
Kuhn, R. and Ebel,
f
F., Ber.
58B, 919 (1925).
37
Cl
HALOHYDROXYSUCCINIC ACIDS
H09R(OH) 2
trans-j3-Chloromalic Acid
(a-Chloro-/3-hydroxy succinic Acid )
Maleic acid when treated with hypochlorous acid
in
absence of
excess caustic yields exclusively the ran$-chloromalic acid, whereas
fumaric acid gives a mixture of 80% of the trans-acid and 20% of the
It should be possible to resolve both of these acids into
isomers,
optical
yielding a total of four optically active acids.
These acids can also be prepared in very high yields by treating the
cis-acid.
respective epoxysuccinic acids with concentrated hydrochloric acid
at 0. The yield of cis-acid, for example, is 95% by this method.
Other halomalic acids can be prepared in a similar manner.
rcws-Chloromalic acid occurs as a crystalline solid that melts at
146. The cis-acid melts at 153.5.
Use. These acids are valuable starting materials for the synthesis
of several compounds.
When treated with concentrated ammonium
hydroxide, for example, they yield the various isomers of /2-hydroxyaspartic acid.
38
OXYHALO ACIDS
HOC1
II
Hypochlorous Acid
->
CONa
CC
Cl-
HO C C OH
ONa
(HCi)
ci
A
Hypochlorous
acid
C OH
>
Sodium
in ale ate
<ran8-/S-Chloromalic
acid
Procedure. A suspension of 110 g. of maleic acid in water is neusodium hydroxide. This is then diluted to a 1% solution
with ice water, and a few milliliters of it are poured rapidly into a
tralized with
The chlorine bottle is closed
bottle filled with chlorine.
quickly with a stopper carrying a rubber tube, which is dipped into
the remainder of the maleate solution. Chlorine is rapidly absorbed
when the bottle is shaken, causing the rest of the maleate solution to
be drawn into the bottle. The reaction mixture is allowed to stand
overnight, when it is neutralized by adding one-half the amount of
sodium hydroxide originally required for neutralization of the acid.
20-liter
Two and
one-half equivalents of barium chloride are added next, and
After standing, the easily filtered
is shaken for half an hour.
the whole
It is washed with water, air-dried, and crushed.
is removed.
This material is then placed in a thick-walled bottle, covered with
ether, and shaken with small additions of concentrated hydrochloric
acid until there is a 10% excess, care being taken to cool the solution
between additions. After separating the ether layer, the aqueous one
is extracted five times with fresh portions of ether.
The combined
extracts are allowed to evaporate after washing with a few drops
Chloromalic acid is thus obtained as an oil, but it quickly
of water.
The yield is 40 to 50%. The
solidifies to a solid crystalline mass.
filtrates contain 20 to 25% of epoxysuccinic acid (q.v.)
precipitate
References
Dakin, H. D. J. Biol. Chem. 48, 279 (1921). C/.:
Kuhn, R. and Ebel, F., Ber. 58B, 919 (1925).
t
Lessen, W., Schdrk, W., and Niehrenheim, M., Ann. 348, 273 (1906).
Timmermans, J., and Jaffe, J., Bull aoc. chim. Belg. 46, 471 (1937).
Timmermans,
J.,
van Lancker,
T.,
and
Jaffe, J., Bull. soc. chim.
39
Bdg.
48, 33 (1939).
RCH=CH R
H
x
ALKENYLSUCCINIC ACIDS
9H(OH) 2
Decenylsuccinic Acid
This
an industrial type of preparation employing practical grades
manufacture of certain types of
is
of reagents such as are used in the
chemical products. The decyl chloride employed here is a mixture of
similar chlorides, since it is prepared from a petroleum distillate.
Even very narrow fractions of petroleum products consist of a mixture
The
of isomeric hydrocarbons.
when the product
is
use of such chlorides causes no
diffi-
to be used for purposes such as those
culty
suggested below. For most industrial uses, the extra cost of starting
with a pure chloride would not be warranted. For the same reason,
made
and characterize the individual isomeric
decenylsuccinic acids of which the product is undoubtedly composed.
Often such mixtures of similar compounds have characteristics superior
no attempt
is
to isolate
to those of their individual constituents for
There
is
no reason to
many
practical uses.
believe, however, that this
method could not
be employed to produce a pure decenylsuccinic acid, if the starting
chloride were an individual compound. It shows that alkyl chlorides
do not have to be converted to olefins (q.v .) to obtain alkenylsuccinic
acids from maleic anhydride.
Almost any alkyl chloride or mixture of
them may be used
in this
preparation. When the chloride has a low boiling point, it is best to
add a higher-boiling inert solvent, or 1 to 5% of a catalyst such as
aluminum chloride, zinc chloride, or the like. It is also well to use
underchlorinated hydrocarbons, even if
to remove the unchlorinated material.
it
requires steam distillation
The product obtained in this preparation is a dark gummy mass.
Neutral salt solutions of any desired concentration can be obtained
by
titrating a suspension of it with a solution of alkali.
Use.
salt solutions have wetting, emulsifying, and washing
the alkenyl groups contain five to twelve carbons.
These
properties
if
40
ALKYL CHLORIDES
RC1
Decyl Chloride Mixture
H
C-C
II CH
H,,a-C=C
186
||
H2 H
C-C-C-OH
C-C:>
11
Maleic
anhydride
Decyl chloride
Procedure*
HC-C-OH
Decenylsuccinic acid
Thirty-five and three-tenths grams of decyl chloride
prepared by chlorinating a suitable petroleum fraction is refluxed with
20 g. of malcic anhydride for 50 hours at 178. Hydrogen chloride
begins to be evolved when the temperature reaches 170, and has practically ceased
by the end
of the heating period.
A 5%
solution of
added to render the reaction mixture alkaline.
A light oily layer separates and is removed. The remaining aqueous
solution is made acid to Congo red with 10% hydrochloric acid, which
causes the decenylsuccinic acids to precipitate. These acids are removed by filtration, and both the product and the aqueous layer are
sodium hydroxide
then extracted
is
with
chloroform.
Whereupon, evaporation
chloroform solution gives a yield equivalent to
amount
85%
of
the
of the theoretical
of decenylsuccinic acids.
Reference
Kyrides, L. P., U.S. 2,360,426 (Oct. 17, 1945).
The above formula is representative of the mixture.
Note.
This single isomer is used purely to illustrate the general type of reaction.
Similar reactions occur with each of the other isomers.
41
1-PHENYLNAPHTHALENEDICARBOXYLIC
ANHYDRIDES
r'
l-Phenyl-3,4-naphthalenedicarboxylic Anhydride
number of cases have compounds containing
halogens been successfully employed in Diels-Alder syntheses. In many of the
reactions studied, the hydrogen halide is split off during the preparation, giving
Only
in a comparatively limited
adducts that are more unsaturated than those obtained with the corresponding
hydrocarbons, as
The
is
the case in this instance.
shown on the opposite page, however, undoubtedly
take place in two stages, with the hydrogen bromide being evolved and
autooxidation occurring during the sublimation of the reaction product. The
particular reaction
may
amorphous material contains bromine and probably two moles of maleic
is no reason to believe that diarylvinyl halides would react
from
differently
See, for example, the
diarylvinyl compounds in general.
initial
anhydride, as there
reaction of l-phenyl-l-(3,4-dimethoxyphenyl)ethylene with maleic anhydride.
l,l-Diaryl-2,2-dihalogenoethylenes
react with maleic anhydride.
and co-bromostyrene,
in
contrast,
do not
l-Chloro-3-methyl-l,3-butadiene and l-chloro-3-methyl-l,3-pentadiene add
maleic anhydride, with a loss of hydrogen chloride, to give products that yield
upon hydrolysis a mixture of acids. The former adds both one and two moles
In general, only acyclic dienes containing a single halogen
(>C=CC1--C=C<) add dienophiles as readily as do the
of maleic anhydride.
in the 3-position
l
.
parent hydrocarbons. The highly reactive hexachloropentadiene adds maleic
anhydride without loss of halogen. Derivatives of hexachlorocyclopentadiene,
in which the allylic chlorine atoms are replaced by alkoxy groups, react similarly.
This reactivity
is
attributed to their m-butenoid configuration. Octachloroits isomers do not react with maleic anhy-
5-ethylidenecyclopentadiene and
dride under ordinary conditions.
Chloromaleic anhydride when used as a dienophile yields derivatives of
maleic anhydride through the loss of hydrogen chloride.
l-Phenyl-3,4-naphthalenedicarboxylic anhydride occurs as clusters of needles
when
from ligroin (b.p. 130). These needles melt at 172.
These reactions are a convenient means for producing certain substituted cyclic carboxylic acids and their decarboxylated products.
crystallized
Use.
42
DIARYLVINYL HALIDES
Ar'H
ArC=CX
2-Bromo-l ,1-diphenylethylene
(Diphenylvinyl Bromide)
2-Bromo-l,l-diphenylethylene -\~
Maleio anhydride
4-
Procedure.
l-Phenyl-3,4-naphthalenedicarboxylic
anhydride
Oxygen
dark brown reaction mass
is
obtained
when a mixture
of 1 g.
and ten equivalents or 4 g. of maleic anhydride
is allowed to react, upon heating for 4 hours at 160 to 180.
This dark brown,
product is broken up by dissolving it in alcohol and precipitating with water.
The precipitate is separated, thoroughly dried, and then sublimed at 270 to
340, under 2 mm. of pressure. The sublimate is finally purified by triturating
The yield is 400 mg.
it with ethanol, followed by crystallization from ligroin.
of 2-bromo-l ,1-diphenylethylene
or
38%
of theory.
References
Bergmann, F., and Szmuszkovicz, J., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 1777 (1947). C/.:
Bergmann, F., and Szmuszkovicz, J. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 1035 (1950).
Bergmann, F., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 64, 176 (1942).
Favorskaya, T. A., et al., J. Gen. Chem. (USSR) 9, 386 (1939) 10, 446, 451, 461 (1940);
Chem. Abat. 33, 9281 (1939); 34, 7844-7845 (1940).
Favorskii, A., and Favorskaya, T., Compt. rend. 200, 839 (1935).
Fieser, L. F. and Dunn, J. T., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 59, 1016, 1024 (1937).
I. G. Farbenindustrie, Monthly Repta.; U.S. Dept. Commerce O.T.C. Rept. PB73894,
frame 5174-5194.
Klebanshif, A. L., Sorokina, R. M., and Khavin, Z. Y., J. Gen. Chem. (USSR) 17,
235 (1947); Chem. Abst. 42, 516g (1948).
Koebner, A., Robinson, R., and Cardwell, H. M. E., J. Chem. Soc. 1941, 566.
Newcomer, J. S., and McBee, E. T., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 71, 946, 952 (1949).
Norton, J. A., Chem. Revs. 31, 379 (1942).
Prill, E. A., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 62 (1947).
Synerholm, M, E. /. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 345, 1229 (1945).
f
I. G. Farbenindustrie, Monthly Repta.; U.S. Dept. Commerce
O.T.C. Rept. PB73894, frame 5174-5194.
Brit. 320,375 (1929).
43
DICHLOROPHOSPHATES OF THE
9n(NHAr) 2 HOPOCl2
DIANILIDE
Maleanilide Dichloro phosphate
This preparation
interesting in that it
is
would indicate that even at
100
dichlorophosphoric acid or phosphoryl chloride shows no evidence
of adding to the unsaturated bond of maleyl compounds.
The maleanilidiurn dichlorophosphate
when
treated with cold water
to maleanilide, phosphoric acid,
is almost quanand hydrochloric
titatively hydrolyzed
If addition had occurred at the unsaturated bond, hydrolysis
acid.
should have produced the anilide of malic acid. Instead the only
other compound found to be formed by reaction with phosphoryl
chloride is a small amount of a-chloro-N-phenylsuccimide (m.p. 118
to
90), which can be
isolated
from the original mother
liquor.
This
undoubtedly produced by the hydrogen chloride splitting off during
the reaction.
is
Maleanilidium dichlorophosphate is very unstable. Upon being
heated rapidly, it decomposes at 142, at which temperature it turns
brown. The maleanilide formed upon hydrolysis varies in melting
point, depending
is
upon the conditions under which the melting point
determined, since at the fusion temperature it
to the isomeric fumaranilide.
the third edition of Bielstein's
is
converted in part
Heated rapidly, it melts at 175. In
Organischen Chemie this compound is
listed both as maleanilide and as phenylaspartanil.
When heated with
hydrochloric acid it produces N-phenylmaleimide (m.p. 90 to 91) and
anilinium chloride.
44
OXYCHLORIDES
POC1 3
Phosphoryl Chloride
C-C-N
C6 H 6
Maleanilic acid
chloride
Procedure.
+ Phosphoryl
+ Water
Maleanilide dichloro-
phosphate
mixture of 19
g.
of maleanilic acid
and 115
g.
of
phosphoryl chloride is carefully heated at 100 in a hood, and held
at this temperature for several minutes, until all the maleanilic acid
is
dissolved in the oxychloride. The reaction mixture is then cooled
is diluted with carbon disulfide, whereupon yellow needles of the
and
product are deposited. These are separated, washed with ether, and
then dried over concentrated sulfuric acid.
References
van Dorp, W.
A., and van Haarst, P. M., Rvc. trav. chim.
AnschtUz, R., and Wirtz, Q. Ann. 239, 137 (1887).
f
45
19,
311 (1900).
Cf.:
CHLORO ACID IMIDES
a-Chloro-N-phenylsuccinimide
(a-Chlorosuccinanil )
This preparation is another example of the failure of acid chlorides
to add to the C:C unsaturated bond of maleyl compounds.
(C/. Reac-
Here a-chloro-N-phenylsuccinimide is
tion of Phosphoryl Chloride.)
the usual product of the reaction. At elevated temperatures even the
hydrogen chloride that
is
evolved during the reaction
fails to
add
to
the ethylene group.
Under
(See N-Phenylmaleimide Preparation.)
the
as
a
chloride
acts
such conditions,
acetyl
only
dehydrating agent
leading to ring closure.
a-Chloro-N-phenylsuccinimide is a colorless crystalline compound
melting at 117 to 118 or 118 to 119.
Use. Its structure suggests that it should be an interesting reactant
for chemical synthesis.
46
ACID CHLORIDES
RCOC1
Acetyl Chloride
Acetyl chloride
-f-
>
Maleanilic
acid
Procedure.
mixture of 19
g.
a-Chloro-N-phenylsuccinimide
of maleanilic acid
and an excess of
acetyl chloride are digested for 45 minutes. The reaction mixture is
then cooled and diluted with benzene or ligroin, which causes the
a-chloro-N-phenyl-succinimide to precipitate as fine needles.
are recovered and dried in the usual manner.
References
von Auwers, K., Ann.
309, 347 (1899).
Giustiniani, E., Gazz.
Mm.
ital.
28
Cf.:
(II),
191 (1898).
47
These
ACID CHLORIDES
9RC1 2
Fumaryl Chloride
Fumaryl
chloride has been prepared by a number of other different
by the reaction of thionyl chloride with fumaric
methods, for example,
acid and of phosphorus pentachloride with maleic acid or anhydride.
However, none of these methods has given as good yields as either the
one described here or the reaction of phthalyl chloride with maleic
anhydride in the presence of zinc chloride. When maleic acid is
allowed to react with phthalyl chloride, large amounts of maleic
anhydride are formed that do not react with the acid chloride except
In consequence, only very poor yields
in the presence of a catalyst.
of
fumaryl chloride are obtained.
Maleyl
chloride, the optical isomer, is
conditions maleic acid
may
unknown, but under proper
be caused to react with phosphorus penta-
chloride to give the isomeric dichloride, y,y-dichloro-y-hydroxyisocrotonic lactone (q.v.). This compound isomerizes slowly to fumaryl
chloride.
Fumaryl
16 mm.).
chloride
is
a liquid that boils at 161 to 164
(60
at
It has the following densities at different temperatures:
1-4149 and egg 1.4095.
Use. It is a valuable intermediate in the preparation of a number
of derivatives of fumaric acid, as, for example, fumaryl peroxide,
fumaryl bisaspartic acid, bis(4-phenoxybenzoyl)ethylene, and other
d\l 1.4202,
dS
substituted dibenzoylethylenes (q.v .).
48
ACID CHLORIDES
Ar(COCl) 2
II
Phthalyl Chloride
Procedure.
Phthalyl
Fumaryl
Phthalic
chloride
chloride
anhydride
mixture of 48
g.
of fumaric acid
and 184
g.
of
phthalyl chloride is heated cautiously in a hood to about 120. At
this point the fumaric acid begins to dissolve slowly in the acid chloride
with a copious evolution of fumes of hydrogen chloride. The temperature
is
then gradually raised to 160 and held at this temperature
amount of gas emitted is greatly diminished. The reaction
until the
mixture
amount
amount
amount
The
fractionally distilled at ordinary pressures.
of fumaryl chloride formed is practically equivalent to the
is
then
Only a very small
formed as the other product of fumaric
of fumaric acid in the original mixture.
of maleic
anhydride
is
acid.
References
van Dorp, W.
and van Dorp, G. C. A., Rec. trav. chim. 25, (2), 96 (1906).
Anschiitz, R., and Wirtz, Q M Ann. 239, 137 (1887).
Kyrides, L. P., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 59, 207 (1937); Org. Syn. 20, 51 (1940).
A.,
Cf.i
Am. Chem. Soc. 52, 3423 (1930).
Meyer, H., Monatsh. 22, 421 (1901).
Michael, A., J. prakt. Chem. 46, (2), 392 (1892); 52, (2), 292 (1896).
Mousseron, M., Granger, R., and Claret, J., Bull. soc. chim. France 1947, 868.
Perkin, W. H., Ber. 14, 2540 (1881).
Lutz, R. E., J.
Piutti, A., Gazz. chim. ital. 17, 126, 185 (1887);
Vanino, L. and Thiele, E., Ber. 29, 1724 (1896).
f
U.S. 2,437,867.
49
16,
278 (1886); Ber.
19,
1693 (1886).
v/
HCCO
asym-ACID CHLORIDES
>
HCC1,'
Y,Y-Dichloro- y-hydroxyisocrotonic Lactone
<
(5,5-Dichloro-2,5-dihydro-2oxofuran or Malein Chloride)
This unsymmetrical
maleyl chloride is relatively unstable. It
to
fumaryl chloride, 'even upon standing for several
readily rearranges
room
temperature. When the product is distilled at 24 mm.
days at
instead of 11 mm. pressure, it partially decomposes into maleic anhydride and fumaryl chloride. This mixture is very difficult to separate.
The lactone has not been prepared from maleic anhydride nor from
maleic acid with other acid chlorides.
The usual method for preparing chlorides of a similar structure is to
heat the symmetrical acid chlorides with aluminum chloride. This is
the method that has been used in the preparation of asym-o-phthalyl
a-bromomaleyl chloride and a /3-dibromomaleyl chloride.
fumaryl chloride, however, is treated with aluminum chloride,
only very small amounts of the asymmetric chloride are obtained.
The major products of the reaction are carbon monoxide and hydrogen
chloride,
When
chloride.
These asymmetric chlorides markedly
differ
from the symmetrical
acid chlorides in their slower rate of reaction, the type of products
formed, their effect upon hydrogen catalysts, the color of metal complexes with aluminum chloride, and their dimorphism. The last property is characteristic of lactones in general.
y,y-Dichloro-y-hydroxyisocrotonic lactone boils at 70 to 71 under
11
mm.
Lutz obtained a
pressure, according to Anschiitz and Wirtz.
2
under
mm.
the
same method.
at
65
product boiling
by
redistilled
be used for preparing y-hydroxy-y,y-diphenylcrotonic
acid by allowing it to react with benzene in the presence of aluminum
chloride.
as7/w-a,/?-Dibromomaleyl chloride under similar conditions
Use.
It
may
produces 2-bromo-l,l-diphenyl-3-indenecarboxylic acid, through loss of
hydrogen bromide, which results in the cyclization.
50
PHOSPHORUS CHLORIDES
PCU
Phosphorus Pentachloride
HO-P-C1
HC=CH
Maleic acid
HC==CH
+
>
Phosphorus
Procedure.
hydroxyisoorotonio
lac tone
mixture of 38.6
phorus pentachloride
is
-y.-y-Dichloro-T-
cliloride
g.
of maleic acid
and 69
Triohlorophosphono acid
g.
of phos-
placed in a 250-ml. Claisen distilling flask in
a hood and the flask is connected to a highly efficient pump. The
products are then distilled from the reaction mixture, not allowing
the pressure to exceed 11 mm. The product is redistilled at a pressure
of approximately 2 mm.
References
Anschiitz, R.
and Wirtz,
Q., Ber. 18, 1947 (1885).
Am. Chem.
C/.:
3436 (1930).
Ott, E,, Ber. 46, 2172 (1913); Ann. 392, 267 (1912).
Vandevelde, J., Bull. Clasae Sci., Acad. Belg. 37, (3), 680 (1900).
van Dorp, W. A., and van Dorp, G. C. A., Rec. trav. Mm. 25, (2), 98 (1906),
Lutz, R. E., J.
Soc. 52, 3405,
51
BIS (TRIHALOMETHYL) SUCCINATES
(X3 C) 2 9H(OR)2
Diethyl a,/3-Bis(trichloromethyl)succinate
Diethyl a,/^bis(trichloromethyl)succinate is one of the products
formed when diethyl maleate is allowed to react in the presence of
amounts of benzoyl peroxide in carbon tetrachloride. Chlorobenzene and hexachloroethane are also found in the volatile portion of
large
the products.
This reaction
similar in several respects to that of
and to that of maleates with benzoyl
is
hexaphenylethane (page 23)
peroxides in the absence of a solvent (page 209).
An excess of carbon tetrachloride such as used here apparently is
needed in order to obtain any appreciable yield of a,/?-bis(trichloromethyl)succinate; but it is questionable whether so large an excess
required for the formation of such polychloro compounds,
judging from analogous reactions of ethylene compounds in carbon
tetrachloride where benzoyl peroxide is used as the catalyst.
of peroxide
is
Should conditions be found for increasing the yields, this method
would offer a most convenient procedure for adding various groups
derived from solvents to the ethylene bond of maleic compounds.
Dimethyl dioxanylsuccinate,
for example,
has been identified as one
of the products of the reaction of dimethyl maleate with benzoyl
peroxide in dioxane.
Diethyl a,^-bis(trichloromethyl)succinate is obtained as colorless
needles that melt at 93.5 to 94.5. The acid melts at 183 to 184.5,
and the anhydride at 117 to 118.5.
12 hours with a
20%
The
diethyl ester,
when
refluxed
potassium hydroxide solution, presumably loses
two moles of hydrogen chloride
what is apparently a,/2This product occurs as colorless
to produce
bis(dichloromethylene)succinic acid.
cubes that melt at 219.
52
CHLORINATED SOLVENTS
CC1 4
Carbon Tetrachloride
HO
HO
C COC H
2
L/OU
(H6C.co?) 8
>
I]
C COC H
2
C1 3 C
C1 8 C
A A
Carbon
-f
Diethyl maleate
>-
tetrachloride
Procedure.
solution of 109
g.
C
C
<JOC 2 H 5
COC H
Diethyl a,0-bis(trichloromethyljsuccinate
of benzoyl peroxide
and 172
g.
of diethyl maleate in 1200 ml. of carbon tetrachloride is refluxed for
36 hours. The residue obtained upon removal of the solvent is ex-
tracted with ether.
solution, dried,
The
extract
is
washed with a sodium bicarbonate
and then fractionally
distilled
with the aid of reduced
This yields a total of 87
g. of liquid products boiling up to
pressure and 131 g. of dark non-volatile resin.
130 to 150. These
Crystals separate from fraction boiling at b
are separated, sublimed under reduced pressure, and recrystallized
pressure.
200
under
from
50%
mm.
ethanol to give pure diethyl a,-bis(trichloromethyl)suc-
cinate.
References
Marvel, C. 8., Prill, E. J., and
Kharasch, M. S., Jensen, E.
De
Tar, D. F., J.
V.,
and Urry, W. H.,
53
Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 52 (1947). Cf.:
/. Am. Chem. 69, 1102 (1947).
CHAPTER
Hydrogen
The
size of this chapter should in
no manner detract from
its
im-
portance, since the single example given is a typical one for a large
number of compounds containing the unsaturated malcyl group. This
reaction with hydrogen
many
is
different reagents
another example of the ease with which
to the carbon-carbon double bond of
add
maleyl compounds. In this instance, the reaction may be carried out
under a variety of different conditions with excellent yields. Even a
mild reducing agent, such as zinc and sulfuric acid, may be employed
as the source for the hydrogen.
In most cases, these reductions apparently involve only the simple
addition of hydrogen atoms to the carbons of the ethylenic double
bond of the maleyl compound. However, this cannot be true for all
such reactions, as indicated by the studies of Ott, and of Lutz and
co-workers. It is possible, as postulated by Conant and Lutz, that
during the reduction of maleates to succinates under certain conditions,
hydrogen
first
adds to the carbonyls of the conjugated maleyl grouping
to give a dienol that isomerizes irreversibly
the stable keto form of succinic acid, viz.,
0=C(OH)
12
345
by a
CH=CH C(OH)=0 +
6
shift of
2H^
HO C(OH)=CH CH=C(OH)OH
0=C(OH) CH CH C(OH)=0
initial
>
The
hydrogens to
addition of hydrogen to the carbonyl groups is assumed
It can take place as a 1,2-, as a 1,4-
to occur as a reversible reaction.
as shown, as a 1,6-addition similar to that of Grignard reagents
described in Chapter 4. For example, such type of addition would
or,
54
readily account for the apparent oxidation-reduction potential observed
in the hydrogenation of fumaric acid, for the varying proportions of
isomers obtained in hydrogenating sodium dimethylmaleate under different conditions, and for the dimeric and cyclic compounds obtained
from diaroylethylenes under certain conditions.
Both succinic acid and its anhydride are produced commercially in
this country by the hydrogenation of maleic anhydride.
Many important chemicals can be prepared from them, as can be seen on the
following page.
Probably the most interesting reactions of succinic acid are those
involving its methylene groups. The ease with which the hydrogens
may be replaced from these two groups may be due to their juxta-
Esters of succinic acid, for example,
position to its carbonyl groups.
are unusual in their strong tendency to undergo aldol condensation
with ketones to produce itaconic acids, methylenesucdnic acids. This
reaction is known as the Stobbe condensation. The failure of diethyl
malonate to condense in a similar manner, even though it contains a
more reactive methylene group, would indicate that this type of
reaction involves more than the reactivity of the methylene groups
alone.
Paraconic acids are possibly first formed as intermediates in
the production of itaconic acids.
reaction with aldehydes.
The
They
are the usual products of
recent preparation of several methylbenz [a] anthracenes for
physiological studies is a typical example of how reactions of succinic
acid can be employed in a series of syntheses leading to products of
a particular interest.
55
H 9)l>0
SATURATED ACIDS
Succinic Acid
Pure succinic acid consists of
colorless monoclinic crystals with a
at 189 to 190. The commercial
melts
pure,
of
The
consists
grade
practical
crystals that melt at 186 to 188.
anhydride melts at 119.6 to give a liquid that boils at 261. The
acid is soluble in water and alcohol, only slightly soluble in ether,
and practically insoluble in benzene and chloroform.
Uses. Succinic acid is the starting material for the synthesis of a
Its esters have been employed
large number of very useful substances.
When
d\* of 1.564.
it
as plasticizers for adhesives, vinyl plastics, rubber, and lacquers; as
ingredients in bitumen products; as additives in lubricating and cutting oils; as perfumes; as water-repellent agents; and as aids in the
dyeing of vinyl yarns. The succinyl peroxide and N-chlorosuccinimide
derivatives are powerful germicides.
The succinyl peroxide has been
suggested for the bleaching of food products; and the N-chlorosuccinim-
used in the purification of drinking water. N-Bromosuccinemployed as a brominating agent, particularly where it is
desired to introduce bromine into unsaturated compounds without
Several oil-soluble dyes,
(See Djerassi.)
affecting the double bond.
ide
is
imide
is
alkyd
resins, ester-type elastomers, sulfa-drugs, arsenicals, other
phar-
synthetic musks, detergents, and wetting agents also
depend upon succinic acid for their manufacture.
Succinic acid may be used as a reagent in photographic processes
maceuticals,
and
in
chemical analysis.
wide variety of other chemicals can also be prepared starting
with this acid.
They
include, for example, succinosuccinic esters;
acetonediacetic anhydride; aroylpropionic acids; substituted itaconic
acids;
acids
paraconic
acids;
fulgides;
4-(p-methoxyphenyl)-3-butenoic
3,3'-dicoumarin
pyrocinchonic anhydride; ethyl formylsuccinate; levulinic acid; 3-acetyl-2,5;
l,8-diphenyl-l,3,5,7-octatetraene
dimethylf uran 2- (alkylmercapto) thiophenes a,/2-dichloromaleimide
acid
5-hydroxy-6-methylcinchomeronic
N-p-phenetylsuccinimide
2-alkylbutadienes
8,9,1 1-trimethylbenz [a] anthracene
methyl 2,5;
dioxo-1-pyrrolidene acetate; and equilein.
56
HYDROGEN
Hydrogen
O
H->
C CONa
Ni
CONa
(H2S
H->
H C COH
H
4)
i
Hydrogen
CCOH
>
Sodium
Succinio
acid
maleate
Procedure. A solution containing 25 g. of sodium hydroxide in
100 ml. of water is placed in a 325-ml. autoclave. To this is added
58
when
dissolved, 5 to 8 g. of Raney nickel
then
carried out with proper precautions
catalyst.
Hydrogenation
at 2500 Ib. per sq. in. and at 100. Upon completion, the catalyst is
removed by filtration, the filtrate acidified and evaporated to dryness
under reduced pressure. The product is purified by extraction with
g.
of maleic acid and,
is
absolute alcohol and recrystallization from water.
The
yield
is
98%
of theory.
The above
reaction
if
a palladium catalyst
is
also practical.
may
is
be carried out at ordinary temperatures,
Reduction with zinc and sulfuric acid
used.
References
Wyatt, B. W., and Henze, H. R., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 61, 843 (1939). <?/.:
J., and van der Zanden, J. M., Rec. trav. chim. 50, 645 (1931).
Ann. chim. 17, 38 (1921).
Ciamician, G. L., and Silber, P., Gazz. chim. ital. 13, 403 (1883).
Cook, J. W., and Robinson, A. M., J. Chem. Soc. 1938, 505.
Curtius, T., and Raschig, K M J. prakt. Chem. 125, 466 (1930).
Djerassi, C., Chem. Revs. 43, 271 (1948) (Rev. of bromosuccinimide, 125 ref.).
Fittig, R., et al., Ber. 30, 2148 (1897); Ann. 250, 166 (1888); 255, 1, 18, 257, 275 (1898); 267, 204
Allen, B. B.,
Backer, H.
Carrie're,
EM
(1892); 331, 160, 191 (1904)
Hughes, E. D., and Watson, H. B., J. Chem. Soc. 1930, 1733.
Johnson, W. S., et al., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 430, 1360, 1366 (1945) 69, 74, 2942 (1947) 70,418 (1948)
71, 1384 (1949); 72, 501, 505, 511, 514, 2398 (1950).
Kharasch, M.S., and Fuchs, C. F., J. Org. Chem. 9, 359 (1944).
Kuhn, R., and Winterstein, A., Helv. Chim. Acta 11, 109 (1928).
Linstead, R. P., and Mann, J. T. W., J. Chem. Soc. 1930, 2064.
Lutz, R. E., et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 57, 1947, 1953, 1957 (1935).
Magnanini, G., and Bentivoglio, T., Gazz. chim. ital. 24(1), 435 (1894).
Marvel, C. S., Meyers, R. L., and Saunders, J. H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1694 (1948).
McQuillin, F. J., and Robinson, R., J. Chem. Soc. 1941, 586.
Morgan, G. T., and Walton, E., J. Chem. Soc. 1931, 615.
Neuberg, C., Z. physiol Chem. 31, 574 (1901).
Piutti, A., Gazz. chim. ital. 20. 167 (1890).
Reddish, G. F., and Pauley, A. W., Bull. Natl. Formulary Comrn. 13, 11 (1945).
Robinson, R., and Seijo, E., J. Chem. Soc. 1941, 582.
Shaefer, W. E., Ind. Eng. Chem., Anal. Ed., 2, 115 (1930).
Steinkopf, W., and Leonhardt, P., Ann. 495, 166 (1932).
Stobbe H., et al., Ann. 315, 219 (1901); 314, 111 (1901); 380, 1 (1911).
Werbin, H., and Spoerri, P. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 1681 (1947).
Wojcik, B., and Adkins, H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 56, 2424 (1934).
;
U.S. 1,621,757; 1,939,217; 2,368,765; 2,371,102; 2,384,068; 2,407,726; 2,445,006; 2,447,325.
274,095. Indian 31,437.
57
Brit
CHAPTER
Metallic
The
Compounds
reactions between organometal
compounds and maleic deriva-
tives, as described in this chapter, comprise three general classes of
preparations, namely:
(1)
Reactions that give
final
products that contain the metal bound
to one or both of the carbons of the maleyl group.
(2)
Reactions involving the use of a metal compound or salt that
for practical purposes serves as a catalyst, although it may form an
essential complex or metal derivative with the substance reacting with
the maleic derivative.
(3) Grignard reactions where the metal
by hydrolysis during the preparation.
is
removed from the product
The first group of reactions includes those of maleic anhydride with
mercuric acetate and with hexaphenyldilead. Both these reactants
yield a,/?-disubstituted succinic acids. Mercuric acetate in aqueous
solution, for example, yields the mercuric salt of /2-acetoxymercurimalie
acid,
whereas hexaphenyldilead produces the bis (tripheny Head) sucThe latter reactant, like hexaphenylethane, appar-
cinic anhydride.
ently dissociates into free radicals during the reaction.
The second, by far the most important of the three groups of reac-
such auxiliary substances as sodium alkoxides
and anhydrous aluminum chloride, which are known in some cases
to form definite metallo complexes with one of the reactants. Hence
they have been included in this chapter rather than treated separately
elsewhere. The reactions with sodium alkoxides are a very convenient
means of causing a variety of substances to add to the ethylene bond
tions, involves the use of
of maleic derivatives.
Examples given include the addition
58
of alcohols,
j8-keto esters, malonates,
known
and
nitriles.
Such reactions with keto
esters
Claisen syntheses, while those with malonates and
nitriles are known as Michael syntheses.
Some of these reactions can
are
as
also be carried out in the presence of strongly alkaline catalysts other
than sodium alkoxides, but the usual procedure is to add either metallic
sodium to the reactant in the presence of an alcohol or a sodium
alkoxide, before incorporating the maleyl compound in the reaction
mixture as shown in the preparations selected. Reactions with nitroparaffins and with potassium cyanide are included under nitrogen
may
compounds, since they
be carried out under somewhat different
conditions from those generally employed here.
The third group is limited to the Grignard reactions.
Seven examples
illustrating the different end products that may be obtained from the
Grignard synthesis are given. A variety of products may be formed
by these reagents, depending upon the conditions, upon the proportions
and upon whether the reagent adds to the maleyl group at the
used,
1,2-
(,#-) or 1,4- (SJ6-) positions, namely:
(1,2-Addition)
OH
I
CH^CH C==0
(DK2)
OH
CH
ClZnOC
IZnO
(1)
(1,4-Addition)
G=CH CH C=0
UC H OH
1
OH
HjO
(4
11
> 0=C C CH=CH C=0 + ClZnOH
C Hfi
OH
111
> 0=C CH
OH
CH C=0 + IZnOH
C H OH
2
For example, phenylzinc chloride undergoes a 1,2-addition with maleic
anhydride to produce /3-benzoylacrylic acid, but isopropylcadmium
bromide adds to the 1,4-positions of maleates to yield the isopropylIn a like manner, two moles of a Grignard reagent may
succinates.
produce either y-hydroxycrotonic acid as a result of a 1,2-1,2-addition,
a y-ketopropionic acid from a 1,2-1,4-addition, or a diketoalkene from
a 1,2-5,6-addition.
retically possible
An
when
even greater number of compounds are theo-
also
amounts of Grignard reactant are emThere is
some
larger
ployed, as illustrated in
of the other examples given.
some evidence that a 1,6-addition may occur
under certain conditions.
59
to a limited extent
MERCURIMALIC ACID SALTS
AcHg9H0 2 Hg
Mercuric /3-Acetoxymercurimalate
Maleic acid is the only maleyl compound that has been reported to
react with mercuric acetate to form this type of product. Fumaric
acid under identical conditions reacts by metathesis to yield only mercuric fumarate.
Apparently, the carboxyl group of the drafts-configu-
ration leads to a steric hindrance that prevents the large mercuric ion
from reacting with the olefin bond of this acid.
in
Mercuric /2-acetoxymercurimalate is a colorless solid that is insoluble
both water and alcohol. It dissolves in most of the acids but not
in dilute acetic acid.
It also dissolves in alkaline solutions
but with
the complete destruction of the addition compound, whereas a sodium
chloride solution yields a mixture of disodium /3-chloromercurimalate,
sodium acetate, and mercuric chloride. The latter solution is strongly
acidic.
Potassium iodide solutions, like those of alkalies, destroy the
complex malate.
60
MERCURIC SALTS
Hg(OAc) 2
Mercuric Acetate
II
II
c-co
HOC- CO
c-co
H
H C~COHg-C-CO
H
Hg-
H C-C-0
3
Mercuric acetate
+ Water
-}-
II
Mercuric /9-acetoxymer-
Maleic acid
curimalate
Procedure.
is added
water
solution containing 5
g.
of maleic acid in 40 ml. of
to one containing 20 g. of mercuric acetate in 60 ml. of
A small amount of a yellow precipitate is formed, which is
removed after adding acetic acid. The filtrate is diluted with water
and heated upon a water bath. To this is added 4 g. of maleic acid
water.
Further heating produces a white, microcrystalline
precipitate that increases in amount when the reaction mixture is
allowed to cool. This precipitate is collected and thoroughly washed
in
40 ml. of water.
with very dilute acetic acid, then with pure water, followed by alcohol,
and then ether. It is then air-dried. The initial washing must be
carried out with acidulated water, since pure water causes a material
from the mother liquor that contaminates the product.
to precipitate
The
yield
is
7.5 g.
Reference
Biilmann, E., Ber. 35, 2576 (1902).
61
a,0-BIS(TRIARYLLEAD)SUCCINIC
ACIDS
(Ar3 Pb) 2 9ll(OH) 2
a,j8-Bis (triphenyllead)succinic
This reaction apparently
is
Anhydride
very similar to that of hexaphenylethane
Leeper reports that it also occurs when a chloroform solution
(q.v.).
of the two reactants is allowed to stand for 5 months.
The product does not melt below 330 but only darkens at 265 to
270. It is insoluble in acetone, dioxane, benzene, chloroform, carbon
and petroleum ether. It is only slightly soluble in boilWhen refluxed with a
dissolves in glacial acetic acid.
water
but
ing
it
a sodium salt that
of
sodium
forms
solution
hydroxide,
slowly
10%
tetrachloride,
is
also insoluble in water.
In contrast, the
salt,
triphenyllead acid maleate, melts at
207.
This salt can be obtained from triphenyllead hydroxide and maleic
anhydride. The neutral salt sinters at 189 to 199.
62
HEXAARYLLEADS
(Ar 3 Pb) 2
Hexaphenyldilead
HO
HO
CC
(H 6 C6) 3 Pb->
->
Hexaphenyldilead
-f
->
Maleic
anhydride
a,/3-Bis(triphenyllead)succinio anhydride
An equivalent amount of hexaphenyldilead is slowly
molten maleic anhydride, and the product obtained is progressively extracted with benzene, alcohol, water, and an aqueous
Procedure.
added
to
solution of
ammonium
acetate to effect purification.
Reference
Leeper, R.
W. Iowa
f
State Coll. J. Sci. 18, 57 (1943).
63
ALKOXYSUCCINIC ACIDS
R09R(OH)
Methoxysuccinic Acid
Aliphatic alcohols of different chain lengths readily react with malesodium or the sodium ethoxide to
ates in the presence of metallic
produce alkoxysuccinates. The procedure given is a general one. It
can be used with both branched- and straight-chain monohydric alco-
To avoid
the formation of a mixture of products, it is common
use
the
maleic esters and alcoholates derived from the same
practice to
alcohol.
Little, if any, fumaric acid is formed during these preparahols.
tions.
The
acid
obtained, as shown, through saponification of the
is
alkoxysuccinate.
Methoxysuccinic acid
when
Use. The
to 103
purified.
is
a crystalline substance that melts at 101
acid melts at 95 to 100.
The crude
long- chain alkoxy derivatives, such as decyloxy- and
dodecyloxysuccinic acids, have been used as intermediates in the prep-
aration of synthetic detergents.
Alkoxysuccinic acids in general undergo many of the reactions of
succinic acid (q.v.) thus offering the same possibilities for the preparation of useful compounds.
,
64
ALIPHATIC ALCOHOLS
METAL DERIVATIVES
ROMet
Methanol
CH,
O->
H->
II
C C OCaH
C C OC H
H,CONa
HC COH
H
(H!O)
i
Methanol
if
H,COCCOH
I
>
Diethyl maleate
Methoxysuocinio acid
Procedure. To a methoxide solution, prepared by dissolving 3 g.
sodium in 30 g. of methanol, is carefully added 10 g. of diethyl
maleate. Some heat is evolved. The solution becomes colored, and
of
part of the product precipitates.
whereupon more precipitate
The
reaction mixture
is
then refluxed,
formed as a result of some saponification
of the methoxysuccinic ester.
After refluxing, the solvent is removed
and
residue
the
heated with a slight excess of a potasby distillation,
sium hydroxide solution. The alkaline solution is then neutralized
is
with hydrochloric acid, calcium chloride is added, and the solution is
boiled.
Crystalline calcium methoxysuccinate is precipitated. This
is
carefully
decomposed with a
and the mixture
of sulfuric acid,
little less
is
than the calculated amount
extracted with alcohol.
The
extract
The sirup changes to a crystalline
yields a sirup upon evaporation.
mass of crude acid upon standing in an evacuated desiccator, over
sulfuric acid.
References
Purdie, T., /. Chem. Soc. 47, 855 (1885); 39, 344 (1881).
U.
S. 2,377,246.
65
C/.:
ALKENYLOXYSUCCINATES
RHC=CHCH 09H (OCH CH=CHR)
2
Diallyl Allyloxysuccinate
Maleic esters undergo both addition and ester exchange with unsaturated alcohols in the presence of alkaline catalysts to yield the dialkenyl
alkenyloxysuccinic esters. Containing three olefin groups, these products readily polymerize in the presence of siccatives, such as cobalt
and manganese linoleates. In this respect, they resemble the vegetable
drying
oils.
The procedure appears
to be a general one.
Dimethallyl methallyloxysuccinates have also been prepared by it. If desired, the time of
reaction can be shortened by using a high-boiling inert solvent to
increase the reaction temperature.
boiling alcohol that
is
Continuous removal of the lower
formed assures complete conversion to the
dialkenyl ester.
Both diallyl allyloxysuccinate and dimethallyl methallyloxysuccinate
are high-boiling liquids that cannot be distilled without change at
ordinary pressures. The former boils under 4 mm. pressure at 124
The latter has a boiling point of 6 3 150-155.
These unsaturated esters have been used as synthetic vehicles
Products of
for paint and varnish and as plasticizers for lacquer.
similar structure have been valuable in the preparation of resins and
to
136.
Use.
of copolymers of various types.
66
RHC=CH
UNSATURATED ALCOHOLS
METAL DERIVATIVES
CHjOMet
Allyl Alcohol
H C=C-CH
2
H H
H H H
H H
H 2 C=C-COC-COCK>=CHj
OC-C=CH 2
||
KOH W
OC-C=CH 2
H2 H
HC-COC-C=CH2
Dimethyl maleate
Procedure.
58
g.
and refluxed
is
The methanol
is distilled off
and
column
is
formed
is
removed
of the reaction,
and the product purified by fractionation
Reference
S.,
that
Upon completion
under reduced pressure.
Rothrock, H.
of dimethyl maleate
for 6 to 10 hours in the presence of a strongly alkaline
distillation during the refluxing,
the solvent
g.
placed in a flask carrying a fractionating
catalyst, such as potash.
by
H2 H
Diallyl allyloxysuccinate
toluene solution of 144
of allyl alcohol
U.S. 2,346,612 (1944).
67
R'CO
CR C0 R"
2
KETOTRICARBOXYLIC ESTERS
H9ft(OR'") 2
Triethyl a-Acetotricarballylate
Keto
esters,
such as acetoacetic ester and benzoylacetic ester and
combine with maleic esters in the presence
their homologs, readily
of sodium alkoxides as
shown by this preparation. Reaction takes
carbon
the
adjacent to the carbonyl groups adding to the
place by
of
maleate.
The free acids can readily be obtained
the
double bond
through saponification of the resulting esters. When maleic acid is
employed in place of the maleates, a very poor yield is obtained.
Chlorosuccinic esters, however, can be readily substituted for the
maleic esters.
Triethyl a-acetotricarballylate
position at 187 to 189, under 11
is
a liquid that boils without decom-
mm.
pressure.
These products should form some interesting resins with polyhydric alcohols and other resinifying substances, since they contain
a keto and three carboxyl groups, which should impart a high degree
Use.
of functionality to the reactants.
68
R
R'C
KETO ESTERS
METAL DERIVATIVES
C C02 R"
Met
Ethyl Acetoacetate
A
H
C COC
2
/I
II
(H 2 0)
CH
HC C OC 1I
2
O-COC H
2
HCH
0=COC H,
2
Ethyl acetoacetate
Procedure.
Diethyl fumarate
>
Triethyl
a-acetotricarballylate
Sixty-eight grams of dry sodium ethoxide is suspended
been freed of all traces of water and alcohol. To
in ether that has
this solution
is first
added 118
g.
of ethyl acetoacetate
and then 172
g.
diethyl fumarate. Considerable heat is evolved during the addition.
The reaction mixture is allowed to stand for 12 to 14 hours and is
This produces two layers.
separated and shaken with a sodium carbonate
The oily
solution, again separated, dried, and allowed to evaporate.
residue obtained is then fractionated under reduced pressure to obtain
then acidified with dilute sulfuric acid.
The
ether layer
is
a relatively pure product.
obtained in this manner is
The
75%
yield of triethyl acetotricarballylate
of theory.
References
and Browning, K.
C., J. Chem. Soc. 73, 727 (1898).
C/.:
3757 (1890).
Trephiliev, H., J. Ruaa. Phya. Chem. Soc. 39, 1618 (1908), Ber., 39, 1859, 2129
Ruhemann,
S.,
Emery, W.
O., Ber. 23,
Brit. 594,182.
[1906].
R H
(R'0 2 C) 2 C
TETRACARBOXYLIC ESTERS
9H(OR")2
Tetraethyl 1,2,3,3-Pentanetetracarboxylate
Malonic
esters
and
boxylic acids.
homologs readily condense with maleic'
sodium ethoxide to yield the a,/?,y,y-tetracar-
their
esters in the presence of
The procedure
is
a general one for preparing both the
Dialkyl dibromosuccinates
aliphatic and the aromatic homologs.
may be substituted for the maleic ester in these preparations. In like
manner, the molecular compound obtained by treating dipropyl acetal
with potassium hydroxide
(Brit.
594,182)
may
be substituted for
sodium ethoxide.
Tetraethyl 1,2,3,3-pentanetetracarboxylate is a liquid that boils at
197 under 13.5 mm. pressure. The 1,2,3-pentanetricarboxylic acid
obtained upon saponifying it melts at 153 when pure.
Use. Compounds of this general type have produced some interesting resins
and
plasticizers.
70
MALONIC ESTERS
METAL DERIVATIVES
Met
Diethyl Ethylmalonate
GO
H C OC
6
COC H
2
HC C
3
H C OC
\/
C -
C COC H
2
CH
H-+
6H
2
0=COC H
2
Diethyl
Procedure.
sodium
2.1 g. of
C COC H 6
a
HCH
0=COC H
sodium ethoxide solution
25
g. of
absolute alcohol.
50,
17.5
is
prepared by dissolving
To
this solution is care-
g. of diethyl ethylmalonate
The
Tetraethyl 1,2,3,3-pentanetetracarboxylate
in
g. of diethyl fumarate.
>
fully added, at 20 to
16
Diethyl
fumarate
ethyltnalonate
\/
C
>
COC H
CaHsONa
[I
reaction mixture
is
and then
allowed to stand
After this, most of the solvent is distilled off under
reduced pressure, and the residue is treated with water in the usual
for 12 hours.
The aqueous mixture is shaken three times with fresh ether,
and the combined extracts are washed first with dilute alkali and
then with water. They are then dried and allowed to evaporate.
manner.
The
residue obtained
The major
sure.
collected.
is
separated by distilling under reduced presunder 14 mm., is
portion, boiling at 196 to 198
It is redistilled at the
of the tetraethyl
same pressure
to yield 20.6 g. or
ester of
1,2,3,3-pentanetetracarboxylic acid.
is obtained when this ester is
acid
1,2,3-pentanetricarboxylic
of concentrated hydroamount
theoretical
with
the
twice
hydrolyzed
62%
The
chloric acid.
It can be obtained pure
by
crystallizing thrice
from hot
acetic acid.
References
Michael, A., Ber. 33, 3769 (1900). Cf.:
Duff, D. A., and Ingold, C. K, J. Chem. Soc. 1934, 87.
Gardner, J. A., and Rydon, H. N., J. Chem. Soc. 1938, 42.
Ingold, C. K., J. Chem. Soc. 119, 329 (1921).
Koelsch, C. F., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 65, 437 (1943).
and Biliriski-Tarasowicz, M., Ber., 69B, 1295 (1936)
Am, Chem. Soc. 52, 4598 (1930).
Ruhemann, S., and Cunnington, A. V., /. Chem. Soc. 73, 1010 (1898).
Rydon, H. N., /. Chem. Soc. 1935, 420.
Malachowski, R.,
Bilbel, E.,
J., /.
Michael, A., and Ross,
Brit. 694,182.
71
CYANOMETHYLSUCCINATE
Ar
I
NC
CH9tt(OR) 2
Methyl (a-Cyanobenzyl)succinate
Phenylacetonitriles, like the malonates, contain an active a-methylene group. Hence they also undergo the Michael reaction in the presence of alkoxides. In this particular preparation a solvent is not
needed. Superior yields are generally obtained by omitting it, as is
in the procedure selected.
With diethyl maleate, for example,
only a 46% yield was obtained in ethanol, compared to 52 to 58% yields
without the use of solvent. By omitting the solvent, the formation of
done
complex compounds such as that obtained by Henze
may
be largely
avoided, as well as the excessive formation of alkoxysuccinates (q.v.),
which are readily produced in the presence of larger amounts of alcohol containing a basic catalyst.
Compounds with a carboxyl group in place of the phenyl substituent, such as the alkyl cyanoacetates, are much less reactive than
a-tolunitrile.
In this case
sodium derivative
it is
necessary to add a suspension of the
cyano compound to an alcoholic solution of
the maleate, heating the whole on a water bath for 36 hours. Yields
equivalent to that obtained with a-tolunitrile can be had in this way.
The products
of the
in this case are esters of the tricarboxylic acid,
a-cyano-
tricarballylic acid.
Dimethyl (a-cyanobenzyl)succinate
mm.
pressure.
boils at 198 to
203
The diethyl ester has a boiling point of 187
under 10
at 1
mm.
pressure.
Use.
Compounds
insecticidal
give
ammo
of
similar
structures
and fungicidal properties.
acids, which can be used
and synthetic detergents.
72
When
generally have valuable
reduced, such compounds
in the preparation of
polymers
NITRILES
Met
METAL DERIVATIVES
NO CH
Ar
a-Tolunitrile
(Benzyl Cyanide)
C H6
C-
C6 H
/ \H->
CCOCHa
+1C
=+
(H0)
COCHs
-Tolunitrile
rH ,ON a
HC-
CCOCH,
1
C HC COCHs
1
A
Dimethyl
Dimethyl cr-oyanobenzyl-
maleate
succinato
A mixture of 58 g. of a-tolunitrile and 72 g. of
maleate
is kept agitated while a solution of 1 g. of sodium
dimethyl
in 20 ml. of methanol is added, two to three drops at a time.
The
temperature is carefully kept below 50 by external cooling during
When all the sodium methoxide solution has been
this operation.
Procedure.
added and the temperature continues to drop even upon further addia sign that the reaction is complete. The reaction
then acidified with acetic acid and worked up in the usual
tion of catalyst,
mixture
is
manner.
it is
This yields
50%
of the cyanobenzylsuccinic ester.
References
Am. Chem. Soc. 65, 437 (1943).
Ber. 33, 966 (1900).
Ingold, C. K, J. Chem. Soc. 119, 329 (1921).
Koelsch, C. F., J.
Henze,
M.
73
C/.:
KETOOLEFINIC ACIDS
Ar
OH
0-Benzoylacrylic Acid
The Grignard synthesis is generally considered to be superior to the
Friedel-Craft method for preparing certain aroylacrylic acids. This
is not true, however, for reactions involving maleic anhydride or its
Except for the less reactive reagents, like phenylzinc
no
chloride,
aroylacrylic acids have been isolated from the mixture
of products resulting from the reactions with such maleyl compounds.
derivatives.
Even under the most favorable
tion only
26%
of
conditions as outlined in this preparabenzoylacrylic acid is obtained. More reactive
phenylmagnesium bromide, when allowed to react in
equal molecular proportions, yield only saturated compounds such as
/?-benzoyl-a-phenylpropionic acid and l,2,4-triphcnyl-l,4-butanedione.
Ethylzinc iodide, when allowed to react with diethyl fumarate, has been reported to add only in the 1,4-positions to the
reagents, such as
123456
0=C C=C C=0
grouping, to
give
upon hydrolysis the
ester
described as behaving similarly
but full experimental details are lacking. The same is true with ethylzinc iodide. Further study should be given, therefore, to reactions
of ethylsuccinic acid.
Diethylzinc
is
employing equal molecular proportions
The
of these reactants.
properties of ^-benzoylacrylic acid
Friedel-Craft reaction (q.v.).
74
arc described under the
GRIGNARD REAGENTS
ArMgX
1,2-ADDITION
Phenylzinc Chloride
OH
->
Maleic
anhydride
chloride
Preparation.
H.C-C-C
^C
Phenylzinc
Phenylzinc chloride
->
|ClZn
1
CCH
- CH
is
HO-C-C
H
/S-Benzoylacrylic acid
prepared by adding 16.4
g.
of freshly fused zinc chloride in 40 ml. of dry ether to phenylmagnesium bromide from 15.7 g. of bromobenzene and 2.4 g. of magnesium.
solution of 8.8
g.
of maleic anhydride in 90 ml. of dry ether
is
then
mixcarefully added dropwise to the gray solid mass, while the reaction
The reaction
ture is allowed to reflux and is kept thoroughly agitated.
for
usually complete within an hour, half of which time is required
mixthe
half
last
the
hour,
During
The products are then
ture turns yellow and becomes slightly sticky.
is
the addition of the anhydride.
treated in the usual
manner by separating them
This yields 0.9 g.
then purified by dissolving
with a sodium carbonate solution.
10.2 g. of a red
oil.
The red
two fractions
of diphenyl and
into
oil is
it
in
ligroin, and crystallizing the oily yellow
from ligroin, and then from a benzene-petroleum
benzene, precipitating with
solid so obtained, first
/2-benzoylacrylic acid. An additional
2.3 g. of impure product can be obtained from the mother liquor of
the original benzene solution, giving a maximum yield of crude acid
ether solution, yielding 1.9
of
26%
g. of
of theory.
References
Tarbell, D. S., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 60, 215 (1938).
Michael, A., Ber. 29, 1791 (1896).
Petrieff, B., Bull. soc. chim.
Tarbell, D. S.,
and Weaver,
France 41,
C., J.
(2),
309 (1884).
Am. Chem.
75
C/.:
Soc. 62, 2747 (1940).
ALKYLSUCCINIC ACIDS
/
R9R(OR )
Diethyl Isopropylsuccinate
This product results from a 1,4-addition of an alkylating reagent to
the maleyl group,
C=0, in contrast to the 1,2-addition
0=C C=C
12
3456
described for phenylzinc chloride (q.v.) in the preparation of /3-benzoylThe
acrylic acid, where equal molecular amounts are also employed.
reaction
is
similar in this respect to the one with ethylzinc iodide.
Practically the same yield is obtained when isopropylmagnesium
bromide is substituted for the cadmium reagent in this preparation, or
Use of a 50% mole excess of the
diethyl fumarate for the maleate.
diethyl fumarate with isopropylmagnesium bromide does not increase
A longer time for reaction between the isopropyl bromide
the yield.
and magnesium, or the isopropylmagnesium bromide and cadmium
chloride also has
Diethyl
no
effect in this preparation.
isopropylsuccinate
may
be
prepared
also,
by reducing
diethyl isopropylidenesuccinate with hydrogen in the presence of Raney
nickel.
Although it is a two-step procedure, starting with succinic
acid, it
has several advantages over this Grignard method for prepa-
rational use.
20
Diethyl isopropylsuccinate obtained here boils at 118 to 126 under
mm. pressure. Redistilled, it gives a pure product boiling at 123 to
125
(20
mm.) with n$
1.4284 and
df
0.9925.
Adkins and Wojcik
prepared the product from diethyl isopropylidenesuccinate and report
6 8 110-112; and Neklutin obtained it in a similar manner, 6 0>8 71-78
r^
1.4288.
The
when recrystallized from acetone and water melts
Roser reports 114, and Henry and Paget 117, as
acid
at 115.5 to 116.5.
the melting point for the same acid.
Use.
Alkylsuccinic acids have been studied for their effect on the
tumors in mice. Although they
of dibenzanthracene-induced
growth
do not cause complete repression of any of the tumors, definite inhibitory
effects were observed in the case of methylsuccinic acid and cyclohexylsuccinic acid.
76
RCdX
GRIGNARD REAGENTS
II
1,4-ADDITION
Isopropylcadmium Bromide
HS
/CHs
ifc
H Q
TTP
H
3\H H
if
>
v_/~~L/C)C_/ 2
OH
|BrCd
Isopropyl-
cadmium
H5
C-COC2 H
H
+
Diothyl
maleate
II
*C/C
HC-COC H
H
Water
,O
>-
Diethyl isopropylsucoinate
bromide
Procedure.
ing 143
ether.
Isopropylmagnesium bromide
is first
prepared by add-
isopropyl bromide to 28.6 g. of magnesium and 1 liter of dry
This is converted to the cadmium reagent by adding 212 g. of
g. of
anhydrous cadmium chloride in the customary manner. A solution of
200 g. of diethyl maleate in 500 ml. of ether is then added drop wise to
the reagent. This addition requires approximately 3^ hours. The
then continued for 5 hours to complete the reaction.
The products are treated in the usual manner, and the resulting
agitation
is
separated by distillation.
48
g.,
or
29.3%
The
oil is
yield of diethyl isopropylsuccinate
is
of theory.
References
Marvel, C. S., Meyers, R. L., and Saundcrs, J. H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1695 (1948). Cf.:
Henry, T. A., and Pagent, H., /. Chem. Soc. 1928, 70.
Neklutin (see Marvel, Meyers, and Saunders, above).
Roser, W., Ann. 220, 271 (1883).
Wojcik, B., and Adkins, H., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 55, 4939 (1933); 56, 2424 (1934).
Woodhouse, D. L., Cancer Research 7, 398 (1947).
77
H
Ar9R
KETO ACIDS
<OH
0-Benzoyl-a-phenylpropionic Acid
The
fact that only saturated products are obtained when equal
molecular quantities of maleic anhydride are allowed to react with
phenylmagnesium bromide is of interest in view of the results that
are obtained
when
the Grignard reagents are present in large amounts
(q.v.).
Apparently, equal molecular quantities of this reagent favor
a 1,4-addition of the second molecule of Grignard reagent, whereas
the second molecule of an alkyl reagent tends to add in the 1,2-position
See y,y-diethyl-y-hydroxyto the keto group of the ketoacrylic acid.
Here at best the yields are poor for both the /2-benzoyla-phenylpropionic acid and the by-product, l,2,4-triphenyl-l,4crotonic acid.
butanedione.
Various side reactions also take place, as
from the large proportion of biphenyl
is
evident
in the neutral fraction.
/J-Benzoyl-a-phenylpropionic acid, when prepared by this method
l,2,4-Triphenyl-l,4-butanedione,
purified, melts at 145 to 148.
melts
at
125
to
127.
desylacetophenone,
Compare these results with
and
those given for /3-benzoyl-a-phenylpropionic acid prepared by the
Friedel-Craft reaction, as described on page 91. Mixtures of the
propionic acids prepared by the two methods melt at 148 to
78
150.
GRIGNARD REAGENTS
ArMgX
III
1,2-1,4-Addition
Phenylmagnesium Bromide
Phenylmagnesium bromide
+ Water
>>
Maleic anhydride
/3-Benzoyl-a-
phenylpropionic
>
Triphenyl-1,4-
butanedione
acid 1,2,4-
The Grignard reagent in this preparation is prepared
customary manner from 2.4 g. of magnesium and 15.7 g. of
bromobenzene. It is then added dropwise, with constant stirring, to
an ether solution of 8.8 g. of maleic anhydride, which is constantly
Procedure.
in the
by means
maintained at
of an ice-salt bath.
Increasing amounts
of a white solid separate instantaneously with each addition of the
Grignard reagent. When the reaction is complete, the products are
separated with sodium carbonate into a neutral fraction consisting
of diphenyl, with small amounts of 1,2,4-triphenyland
an acid fraction of 5.9 g. of a red oil. The red
1,4-butanedione
oil is dissolved in benzene and then fractionally precipitated with
This gives three batches of uncrystallized oil and then 1.7
ligroin.
largely of 1.2
g.,
or
26%
g.
of the theoretical
propionic acid.
The pure
amount, of crude /3-benzoyl-a-phenylis obtained by recrystallization from
acid
an acetone-petroleum ether solution. The yield of 1,2,4-triphenyl1,4- butanedione from the neutral fraction is 5.4%.
Reference
Tarbel, D.
S., J.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 60, 215 (1938).
79
CH
C(C 6 H B ) 2
CH
C(C 6 H B) 2
ALKENEDIOL ANHYDRIDES
2,5-Dihydro-2,2,5,5-tetraphenylfuran
It would appear from this and the following preparations that the
use of an excess of Grignard reagent distinctly favors the 1,2-type of
additions to maleyl compounds. The fact that saturated by-products
are obtained in the next preparation with phenyllithium, however,
would indicate that a 1,4-addition of the second or third mole of
Grignard reagent can still occur under certain experimental conditions.
this with the preceding preparation, where phenylmagnesium
Compare
bromide
is
used in an equivalent amount.
Unfortunately, in the preparation given here only one substance
from the reaction mixture, and this is a deof
the
tetraarylalkenediol. This diol is undoubtedly
hydration product
so far has been obtained
formed during the reaction by the addition
to the carbonyls
of the maleate.
To
similar to the one where eight moles of
added to maleic anhydride
this
of four
extent,
moles
of reagent
the reaction is
benzylmagnesium chloride
is
(q.v.), except in that case the intermediate
tetraaralkylalkenediol is a by-product of the reaction, and that dehydration gives rise to a highly unsaturated triene,
In view of the relatively low yields obtained in all cases, one can-
not be certain, however, that the products isolated are the principal
products of the reaction. All these preparations can be profitably
restudied from the standpoint of what might be done to effect better
methods
complex mixtures of products.
2,5-Dihydro-2,2,5,5-tetraphenylfuran when precipitated from ether
of separation of the
melts at 190.
80
GRIGNARD REAGENTS
ArMpX
IV
1,2-1,2-1,2-1,2-ADDITION (TO CIS)
Phenylmagnesium Bromide
"V
H,C,-C
H C -C
2,5-Dihydro2,2,5,5-tetra-
phenylfuran
Procedure. The reagent is prepared from 6.7 g. of magnesium and
This is added cautiously and dropwise to an
g. of bromobenzene.
ether solution of 10 g. of dimethyl maleate in the usual manner. A
44
spontaneous vigorous reaction ensues. When the reaction has quieted
down, the mixture is heated for one hour on a water bath. The
then treated in the customary way, yielding a sirup upon
evaporation of the ether layer. This sirup partially crystallizes upon
product
is
standing.
The
crystals are freed of the adhering sirup by treating
of ether.
They are purified by dissolving in benzene
them with 2 g.
and precipitating with
ether.
Reference
Purdie, T. and
f
Arup, P. S., J.
Chem.
Soc. 97, 1537 (1910).
81
Ar
ALKENEDIOL AND BY-PRODUCTS
Ar
CH COH
CH COH
Ar
Ar
trans-l,l,4,4-Tetraphenyl-2-butene-l,4-diol
This preparation
is
interesting as giving fairly reasonable yields of
That there
some competition with a 1,4-addition
maleyl group
by the two by-products obtained,
since /3,y,y-triphenylbutyric lactone undoubtedly results from loss of
water from a y-hydroxy-/?,y,y-triphenylbutyric acid intermediate, and
the butenediol.
to the
is
is
illustrated
tetrahydro-5-hydroxy-2,2,3,5-tetraphenylfuran could readily result
from 3-hydroxy-2,3,3-triphenylpropyl phenyl ketone through a cycliza-
The cistion involving a transfer of hydrogen of the hydroxyl group.
isomer of l,l,4,4-tetraphenyl-2-butene-l,4-diol may be prepared in
manner from diethyl maleate.
Small amounts of phenol and phenyl benzoate are also obtained from
the aqueous solution left after the original extraction with ether. This
would indicate that some addition to the 1,6-positions of the maleyl
group may have occurred al3o during the reaction.
rans-l,l,4,4-Tetraphenyl-2-butenediol is obtained as colorless
prisms that melt at 195 to 201. When dissolved in concentrated
sulfuric acid, it changes from red through violet, to blue and then
The cis-isomer cannot be crystallized, but when boiled with
green.
acetic anhydride for 4 hours it yields 2,5-dihydro-2,2,5,5-tetraphenyl(q.v.).
furan, m.p. 182 to 184
/3,y,y-Triphenylbutyric lactone occurs as needles that melt at 162.5
when recrystallized from methyl alcohol. They show no
to 163.5
depression in melting point with the product isolated from the reaction
with phenylmagnesium bromide. Dissolved in concentrated sulfuric
acid, it imparts an intense yellow color to the solution.
Tetrahydro-5-hydroxy-2,2,3,5-tetraphenylfuran melts at 216 to
217 and gives no color in concentrated sulfuric acid. Treated with
similar
and concentrated hydrochloric acid, it gives the 2,3-dihydro2,2,3,5-tetraphenylfuran, and with hydriodic acid and red phosphorus,
acetic acid
1,2,4-triphenylnaphthalene.
GRIGNARD REAGENTS V
FUMARATES)
ArLi
1,2-1,2-1,2-1,2-ADDITION (TO
Phenyllithium
HOC-
C6 H 5
Phenyllithium
Water
Diethyl
fumarate
*rans-l,l,4,4-Tetraphenyl-2butene-l,4-diol
Procedure. A solution of 1.9 g. of diethyl fumarate in 40 ml. of
60 to
70. This is added over a 5-minute
dry ether is cooled to
ether solution of phenyllithium that has been
period to 50 ml. of & I
cooled to the same temperature. After 30 minutes the reaction mixture is allowed to increase slowly to room temperature. After 25
minutes at the new temperature, it is decomposed with acidulated
water, neutralized, and then extracted with ether. Upon standing, 0.3
of colorless needles of tetrahydro-5-hydroxy-2,2,3,5-tetraphenylfuran separate from the extract. These are recrystallized from an
ethyl acetate-alcohol mixture.
The extract is then allowed to evaporate, and the residue is taken
up in methyl alcohol. From the alcohol solution is obtained 1.55 g.
of l,l,4,4-tetraphenyl-2-butene-l,4-diol, which is recrystallized from a
mixture of benzene and alcohol.
g.
The mother
liquor yields 0.4
g.
of
,y,y-triphenylbutyric lactone.
References
K, Ann. 557, 82 (1945). <?/.:
Purdie, T., and Arup, P. 8., /. Chem. Soc. 97, 1537 (1910).
Scholtis,
83
DIKETOALKANES
5-Ethyl-3,6-octanedione
Substituted aliphatic diketones are the major products when maleic
esters are allowed to react with an eight-mole equivalent of alkylmagnesium bromides. These ketones result from the reaction of three
moles of the Grignard reagent with one of the maleate, two moles
adding to the carbonyl groups in the 1,2-positions and the third in
It is also possible for all three moles to add in the
the 1,4-position.
For example, in the reaction with butylmagnesium
small amounts of Bu 2 C(OH)CH=CHCOBu are formed as
1,2-positions.
chloride,
by-products in the reaction with maleic anhydride with butylmag-
nesium chloride.
5-Ethyl-3,6-octanedione is a colorless liquid with the following
properties: b 25 143
(^ 110), wg 1.438, and d 21 0.9661. The com-
pound undergoes the pyrrole reaction
characteristic of 1,4-diketones.
It does not react with semicarbazide in aqueous alcoholic solutions,
but can unite further with two moles of the Grignard reagent to yield
The benzyl analog is sterically hindered in this
a crystalline diol.
more than one molecule of reagent.
This procedure is a convenient one for synthesizing certain
substituted diketones and diols.
respect from adding
Use.
84
GRIGNARD REAGENTS
RMgX
VI
1,2-1,2-1,4-ADDITION
Ethylmagnesium Bromide
HC
5
HC
HC
II
+
H[OH
MgBr|
-(p=0
HC~H
H C ~C=0
6
Ethylmagnesium bromide
Dimethyl maleate
5-Ethyl-3,6-octane-
dione
Procedure. The Grignard reagent is prepared from 87 g. of pure
ethyl bromide and 19 g. of magnesium. This is added dropwise, with
constant stirring to a solution of 14.4
which
is
manner
maintained at
0.
g.
of
The product
for this type of reaction.
dimethyl maleate in ether,
is
worked up
in the usual
Acidic constituents are removed
with sodium carbonate solution, and the neutral fraction purified by
distillation under reduced pressure.
Reference
Weizmann,
C.,
and Bergmann,
F., J.
Am. Chem.
85
Soc. 60, 2647 (1938).
R C(OH) CH=CHC0 H
HYDROXYALKENOIC ACIDS
7,7-Diethyl-7-hydroxycrotonic Acid
The use of maleic anhydride in place of maleic esters in reactions
with large amounts of alkylmagnesium bromides leads to an asymmetric addition of the first two moles of the Grignard reagent to a
carbonyl group. Thus y,y-dialkylhydroxycrotonic acids are
obtained as the major product of these reactions instead of the saturated 1,4-diketones formed in the previous preparation. Further adsingle
dition of the Grignard reagent
may
With ethylmagnesium bromide,
also occur during these reactions.
this results in addition to the other
carbonyl group as well as a 1,4-addition to saturate the C:C bond,
giving 5,6-diethyl-6-hydroxy-3-octanone as the by-product. The less
reactive
butylmagnesium
chloride, however, forms only the unsatu-
rated 8-butyl-8-hydroxy-6-dodecen-5-one; whereas benzylmagnesium
chloride
gives,
compound
rated
diol,
is
The
2,5-dibenzyl-l,6-diphenyl-l,3,5-hexatriene.
last
undoubtedly produced by a dehydration of the unsatu2 5-dibenzyl-l,6-diphenyl-3-hexene-2,6-diol. Thus com;
plete alkylation of both carbonyl groups can occur only if the conjugated system is preserved throughout the series of four Grignard
additions.
y,y-dialkyl-y-hydroxycrotonic acids readily undergo
dehydration.
With the diethyl derivative, this takes place almost spontaneously so
that these compounds can be isolated only as crystalline esters, such
as the p-phenylphenacyl ester described in this preparation.
p-Phenylphenacyl y,y-diethyl-y-hydroxycrotonate melts at 77 to
The p-phenylphenacyl ester of y-ethylsorbic acid, the dehydra-
78.
tion product, occurs as quadratic plates melting at
138.
has the
5,6-diethyl-6-hydroxy-3-octanone
following
(b 37 112), ng 1.457, and d 2i 0.9269.
bi.5 75
Purified
properties:
Use. This method offers several possibilities for preparing branchedchain fatty acids and other compounds from maleic anhydride.
86
GRIGNARD REAGENTS
RMgX
VII
1,2-1,2- ADDITION
Ethylmagnesium Bromide
|BrMg
OH]
[BrMg
OH]
ft
HO-C
Ethyl-
Water
-f
magnesium
bromide
->
Maleic
anhydride
7,-y-Diethyl-Y-
hydroxycrotonio
acid
Procedure. The Grignard reagent is prepared from 87 g. of pure
ethyl bromide and 19 g. of magnesium, as in the previous preparations.
This is added dropwise, with constant stirring, to a solution
of 9.8 g. of maleic anhydride in ether at
0.
The
reaction mixture
is
manner by separating it into neutral and acid
by extraction with a sodium carbonate solution. Since the
treated in the usual
fractions
major product y,y-diethyl-y-hydroxycrotonic acid undergoes spontaneous dehydration, it is isolated as the well-defined p-phenylphenacyl
ester by the addition of p-phenylphenacyl bromide.
Small amounts
phenylphenacyl ester of y-ethylsorbic acid may be obtained
from the filtrate after removing the above ester. 5,6-Diethyl-6of the
hydroxy-3-octanone is recovered from the neutral fraction that
upon extraction with the carbonate solution.
Reference
Weizmann,
C.,
and Bergmann,
F., J.
Am. Chem.
87
Soc. 60,
2647 (1938).
is left
UNSATURATED KETO ACIDS
/Ar
<
X)H
/3-Benzoylacrylic Acid
This
is
one of the general methods used for preparing arylketones.
number of /?-aryloylacrylic acids have been made by
considerable
very similar procedures. The first step in the reaction is considered to be the formation of the complex compound of aluminum
this or
chloride and maleic anhydride, which reacts with the benzene to yield
When allowed to react with two moles of benzene,
the keto acid.
the maleic anhydride complex yields /?-benzoyl-a-phenylpropionic acid
(q.v,).
/?-Benzoylacrylic acid may also be prepared from maleic anhydride
by the Grignard reaction (q.v.), but the yield is very poor. Esters
have been prepared by removing hydrobromic acid from benzoylbromo-
The pure acid melts at 97.
Use, The use of /2-benzoylacrylic acid has been limited in the
past because of its tendency to form Pechmann's dye. This dye may
be prepared by refluxing ^-benzoylacrylic acid with acetic anhydride.
A copious precipitate of reddish needles or plates with a bronze luster
propionates.
is
obtained.
The exact
structure of this dye eluded chemists for a
period of 42 years. It is the diphenylacylfumaric lactone, a dimeric
condensate of /3-benzoylacrylic acid.
Studies of methods for processing /3-benzoylacrylic acid have continued to be attractive because ^-benzoylacrylic acid, like maleic
anhydride, contains a series of highly reactive groups, which should
(See discusundergo many of the reactions of the anhydride itself.
sions of Dibenzoylethylene
and Reaction of Nitroparaffins.)
88
FRIEDEL-CRAFT REACTANTS
Ar .(AlCli)
Benzene
Maleic
anhydride
>
/9-Benzoylacrylic
acid
A mixture of 10 g. of maleic anhydride and 100 ml.
heated on a water bath, with constant agitation, to 55
Fifteen grams of pulverized anhydrous aluminum chloride is
to 60.
then added in small portions, and the heating is continued for 6 hours.
Hydrogen chloride is slowly evolved during the reaction, and the
mixture forms two layers. Upon completion, 40 ml. of water containing a few milliliters of hydrochloric acid is cautiously added.
This causes the lower viscous layer to disappear when the three-layer
heterogeneous mixture is heated further. The mixture is then placed
The
in a separatory funnel, and the acidic aqueous layer is drawn off.
remaining clear benzene layer is washed with water while still warm
and extracted with a dilute alkali solution. A yield of 12 g., or 74%
of the theoretical amount, of crude /3-benzoylacrylic acid is obtained
when hydrochloric acid is added to the extract. This crude acid is
then recrystallized from the 480 ml. of hot water, yielding 9 g. of
Procedure.
of benzene
is
pure acid.
This method was
first
employed by von Pechmann.
References
and Colman,
Ber. 32, 395 (1899).
C/.:
Berliner, E., Org. Reactions 5, 229 (1949).
Bogert, M, T., and Ritter, J. J., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 46, 2871 (1924).
Bougault, J., Compt. rend. 146, 140 (1908).
Cattelain, E., Bull. soc. chim. France 41, (IV), 352 (1927).
Dave, K. P., et al., J. Univ. Bombay 7, (III), 191 (1938); 10, (III), 122 (1941).
Fieser, L. F., and Fieser, M., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 57, 1679 (1935).
Groggins, P. H., Unit Process in Organic Synthesis, McGraw-Hill Book Co., New York (1947), pp.
729, 761.
Haller, A., and Guyot, A., Compt. rend. 119, 139 (1894).
Koenigs, W., et al., Ber. 26, 558 (1893); 28, 1048 (1895).
Kohler, E. P., and Engelbrecht, H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 41, 768 (1919).
Kohler, E. P., and Woodward, D. W., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 58, 1933 (1936).
K6zniewski, T., and Marchlewski, L., Bull, intern, acad. act. Cracovie, 1906, 81; J. Chem. Soc. 90, (I),
759 (1906).
Kugel, M., Ann. 299, 50 (1897).
Lutz, R. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 52, 3405 (1930).
Lutz, R. E., and Couper, M., J. Org. Chem. 6, 77, 91 (1941).
McMullen, T. C., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 44, 2055 (1922).
Oddy, H. G., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 45, 2156 (1923).
Rice, G. P., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 45, 222, 232 (1923); 48, 269 (1926); 50, 1481 (1928); 52, 2094 (1930).
Ruhemann, S., and Stapleton, H. E., J. Chem. Soc. 77, 1179 (1900).
von Pechmann, H., Ber. 15, 881 (1882).
Gabriel,
S.,
J.,
89
KETO ACIDS
xAr
<
X)H
/3-Benzoyl-a-phenylpropionic Acid
Aluminum
chloride might also be expected to form a complex with
benzoylacrylic acid, as well as with maleic anhydride.
The preparation of benzoylphenylpropionic acid from benzene and
maleic anhydride under controlled conditions has also been reported.
It would appear that the initial phase in any reaction between maleic
anhydride and benzene in the presence of aluminum chloride is the
formation of benzoylacrylic acid, and that addition to the C:C bond
of maleic anhydride occurs only after the formation of the unsaturated
keto acid.
dure.
The
yield,
however,
is
very poor in this one-step proce-
That obtained by the method given on the opposite page, where
benzoylacrylic acid
is
used as the starting material, in contrast,
is
practically quantitative.
/?-Benzoyl-a-phenylpropionic acid, when recrystallized several times
Prepared by either procedure, the
acid, melts at 148.
from acetic
keto acids obtained are identical.
90
FRIEDEL-CRAFT REACTANTS
Ar-(AlCla)
II
Benzene
C 6H
C=0
HC
HC
<-H
HCH
A1C1
HC
-C,H.
HOC-0
Benzoylacrylic
HOC=
+
Benzene
/5-Benzoyl-oe-phenylpropionio
acid
acid
Procedure.
of benzene
/3-benzoylacrylie acid and 75 ml.
a water bath until the /J-benzoylacrylic acid
mixture of 2
g. of
heated upon
Then 20 g. of anhydrous aluminum chloride is added
The mixture
in small amounts over a period of half an hour.
is
has dissolved.
to
is
it
kept thoroughly agitated during this period and for the following 12
The solution changes from yellow to brown in forming a com-
hours.
plex with the
aluminum
chloride, such as occurs in the preparation of
/?-benzoylacrylic acid. When the reaction is complete, the mixture
cooled and thoroughly extracted with dilute alkali. The product
is
is
recovered from the extract by precipitation with hydrochloric acid,
and is then purified by three recrystallizations from 30% acetic acid.
The
yield
is
g.
References
Pummerer,
R.,
Bickel, C.
LM
and Buchta,
J.
E., Ber.
Am. Chem,
69B, 1005 (1936).
c/.:
Soc. 60, 927 (1938); 68, 941 (1946).
91
H
(RO) 2 C 6 H 4
ARYLSUCCINIC ANHYDRIDES
OR>0
2,4-Dimethoxyphenylsuccinic Anhydride
Unlike other aromatic compounds, m-dimethoxybenzene reacts with
maleic anhydride in the presence of aluminum chloride to form largely
the saturated substituted succinic anhydride instead of the benzoylacrylic acid derivative. Veratrole, p-dimethoxybenzene and methylSmall amounts of
anisoles, in contrast, react in the normal manner.
(2,4-dimethoxybenzoyl) acrylic acid and -(2,4-dimethoxybenzoyl)a-(2,4-dimethoxyphenyl)propionic acid are also formed during the
reaction with m-dimethoxybenzene, but it is clear from the yields
that the addition reaction is the one that predominates in this prepaWhen m-dimethoxybenzene is added to ft- (2,4-dimethoxyration.
benzoyl) acrylic acid, the isomeric, /?-(2,4-dimethoxybenzoyl)-/2-(2,4dimethoxyphenyl)propionic acid is formed in addition to the
/?,a-compound. The /?,/3-compound, however, has not been reported
as one of the products of the maleic anhydride reaction.
(2,4-Dimethoxyphenyl) succinic anhydride occurs as fine colorless
needles that melt at 147. It is soluble in acetone, benzene, toluene,
and chloroform. The acid melts at 160.
-
(2,4-Dimethoxyphenyl) aery lie acid, is yellow, losing its color at
and decomposing at 189. The /?,a- and ft- (2,4-dimethoxybenzoyl)-/M2,4-dimethoxyphenyl)propionic acids melt at 160 and 157,
/2-
180
respectively.
92
FRIEDEL-CRAFT REACTANTS
m-(RO) 2 C 6 H4-(AlCl3)
III
m-Dimethoxy benzene
(Resorcinol Dimethyl Ether)
H
C
HAids
II
H COi
5
i!OCH
Maleic
anhydride
m-Dimethoxybenzene
(2,4-Dimethoxyphenyl)
succinic anhydride
Procedure. A dark yellowish-green solution of 53.6 g. of purified
maleic anhydride in 71.5 g. of m-dimethoxybenzene is stirred rapidly
while 150 g. of carbon disulfide is added. The reaction mixture is
then cooled in an ice bath, and anhydrous aluminum chloride is
added in small portions. The mixture is kept thoroughly agitated
with the mechanical stirrer until the dark red product begins to set
It is then decomposed in the usual manner
to a complete solid mass.
with ice and concentrated hydrochloric acid. The product is removed
by filtration, air-dried, pulverized, and then extracted with several
small portions of ether.
from which
The yellowish
crystallizes 37.4 g.
residue
of the
is
dissolved in acetone,
colorless
anhydride.
Addi-
(2,4-dimethoxyphenyl) succinic anhydride can be obtained by
treating the residue from this solvent with toluene, giving a total
tional
g. or 40% of theory, based upon the weight of dimethoxybenzene originally taken.
Small amounts of (2,4-dimethoxyphenyl) succinic acid, /3-(2,4-
yield of 49.2
dimethoxybenzoyl) aery lie acid, and /?-(2,4-dimethoxybenzoyl) -a- (2,4dimethoxyphenyl )propionic acid may also be obtained from the acetone filtrate.
Reference
Rice, G. P., J.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 53, 3153 (1931).
93
UNSATURATED 1,4-DIKETONES
9tt(Ar) 2
trcms-Dibenzoylethylene
(l,4-Diphenyl-2-butene-l,4-dione)
This preparation
is
by
far the
most convenient and economical one
An excess of aluminum
for the synthesis of s-diaryloylethylenes.
chloride is required to obtain products of good color. The rate of
addition of the fumaryl chloride is also important. If the benzene
suspension
not
is
warmed
before the chloride
is
added, the reaction
and frothing with boiling over may result when the
temperature begins to rise suddenly. Should the stirrer stop for any
reason, it must be started again very cautiously.
ran-s-Dibenzoylethylene crystallizes from alcohol as yellow needles
that melt at 109 to 110. It is insoluble in ligroin, only partially
soluble in alcohol, but readily dissolves in acetic acid, benzene, and
starts slowly,
chloroform.
This
is
rans-s-diaryloylethylene that has been
the only
reported to melt below its cis-isomer (m.p. 134).
It undergoes many reactions that are similar to maleic anhydride,
including the addition of dienes, malonates, halogens, Grignard reagents, sodium bisulfite, amines, hydroxylamine, oxygen from hydrogen
peroxide, and the like. In the presence of acetic anhydride and a little
sulfuric acid it produces l,4-diphenyl-3-furanol acetate, and with
sodium ethoxide
in benzene, l,4-dibenzoyl-2,6-diphenyl-6-fulvenol. It
extremely easily reduced, being capable of forming upon reduction
either the saturated monomer or a saturated dimer.
Use, s-Diaryloylethylenes have been employed as the starting materials in the synthesis of various substituted f uranes f ulvenes dihydrobenzof urans cy clohexenes bicyclo [2-2*1] -2,5-heptadienes; cyclois
propanes; furanones; pyrazoles and pyrazolines; 4,4-dibenzoyl-lphenyl-2,2-butanedicarboxylic acid; o-dibenzoylbenzene; 3,6-diphenl,4-diphenyl-2-piperidino-l,4-butanediol;
dibenzoylylpyridazine;
acetylene; dibenzoylethanol dibenzoylethylene oxide and 1,2-diben;
zoyl-2-chloroethanol.
94
Ar
FRIEDEL-CRAFT REACTANTS IV
(AlCla)
Benzene
||
A1C1,
Benzene
Procedure.
aluminum
>
Fumaryl chloride
-f
mixture of 350
II
g.
of finely
<rana-Diben*oylethylene
powdered anhydrous
chloride and 1800 ml. of thiophene-free benzene
is heated
on a water bath while vigorously agitated. To this is slowly added
153 g. of fumaryl chloride until the mixture reaches 50 to 60. The
chloride is run into it at a fairly rapid rate over a period of 15 to 25
minutes. During this time the reaction mixture becomes dark red and
begins to boil rapidly. The refluxing is continued for 10 minutes after
the evolution of gas has practically ceased. It is then decomposed
in the usual manner and brought to room temperature by adding hot
water. The benzene layer is separated and washed. The solvent is
then removed on a water bath under reduced pressure until crystalliza-
A yield of
obtained.
tion ensues.
ethylene
is
78%
of the theoretical
amount
of dibenzoyl-
References
Lutz, R. E., Org. Syn. 20, 29 (1940).
Cf.:
Bailey, P. S. and Lutz, R. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 498 (1947).
Blatt, A. H., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 56, 2774 (1934).
Campbell, N., and Khanna, N., Nature 161, 54 (1948).
France 41 (IV), 1167, (1927).
Dupont, G., Bull. soc.
f
Mm.
Fuson, R. C., et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 2054 (194*5) J. Org. Chem. 10, 121 (1945).
Geiger, W. B. Arch. Biochem. 16, 423 (1948).
Jolles, E., Gazz. Mm. ital. 68, 488 (1938).
Kharasch, M. S., Nudenberg, W., and Fields, E. K, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 66, 127ft (1944).
Kohler, E. P., and Woodward, D. W., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 58, 1933 (1936).
Lutz, R. E. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 48, 2905, 2916 (1926) 49, 1106 (1927) 51, 3008, (1929)
52, 3405, 3410, 3421, 3423, 3432 (1930).
Lutz, R. E.,etal.,/. Am. Chem. Soc. 55, 1168, 1599 (1933); 56, 1341, 1980, 1987, 2065,
2145, 2679, 2698 (1934); 57, 1947, 1953, 1957 (1936); 58, 1885 (1936); 59, 2316
(1937); 60, 716 (1938); 61, 3007, 3010 (1939); 62, 1520 (1940); 63, 1148, 3171, 3175,
3189 (1941); 64, 2585 (1942); 67, 2229 (1946); 68, 2224 (1946); 72, 2002 (1950).
Oddy, H. G., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 45, 2156 (1923).
Smith, L. I., and Howard, K. L., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 65, 159 (1943).
;
95
CHAPTER
Compounds Containing Nitrogen
This chapter covers possibly one of the most interesting groups of
substances reacting with maleyl compounds from the standpoint of
synthesis of products with different types of structures. In general,
compounds containing nitrogen react quite readily with either the
ethylene bond or the carboxyl groups of the maleyl compound or combinations of these three groups.
The reactions of ammonia and hydrazine are unique to the extent
that numerous individual compounds can be readily obtained by varying the experimental conditions as shown in the several preparations
Generally, when reactive groups are capable of forming such
given.
numerous combinations, the products are difficultly separable resinous
Although the reactions of ammonia and hydrazine are quite
have been included to show the different reaction conditions and some deficiencies in the end products.
The reaction of benzalazine with two molecules of maleic anhydride
is one of the few examples of a 1,3-addition of a conjugated unsaturated grouping to maleic anhydride, leading to what has been termed
a criss-cross addition to the two moles of anhydride. In the presence
of water, this compound behaves like a Schiff's base, splitting off
mixtures.
similar, both
benzaldehyde to yield only the substituted maleyl hydrazide.
Another unusual reaction is that of benzaldehyde oxime with maleic
anhydride to form N-benzoylaspartic anhydride, where a rearrangeeffect of the oxime isomerizing to the amide during
ment has the net
the reaction.
SchifFs bases from aniline and 2-alkenals apparently
are tautomeric mixtures of the base and conjugated N-alkadienylanilines, since they undergo what amounts to a Diels-Alder addition
96
with the nitrogen forming an amide group in producing bicyclopyrrolidonecarboxylic acids.
Pyrroles also react in an unexpected manner to produce substituted
succinic acids instead of undergoing the usual Diels-Alder type of
addition of cyclic dienes such as takes place with the oxygen analogs,
When both the methylene carbons adjacent to the imide
the furans.
group are substituted, addition takes place at the 3-pyrrole carbon,
which is one carbon removed from the nitrogen atom.
The nitrogen
ring of benzyl azide
is
opened in
its
addition to ethylene
of fumarates to yield the l-benzyl-A 2 -l,2,3-triazoline-4,5-dicarboxylates, but carbamyl azide loses a mole of nitrogen in the same
bond
type of addition to form the l-carbamyl-2,3-aziridinedicarboxylate.
Diazomethane, like azides, also forms a heterocyclic ring upon addithe 1-pyrrolidine ring that is formed. Diazoniuin chloride, like carbamyl azide, loses a molecule of nitrogen during reaction in producing the a-aryl-/?-chlorosuccinates.
tion.
Two
In this case,
it is
molecules of fumaric ester are involved
when hydrogen cyanide
adds to the ester in potassium cyanide solutions.
accompanied by
This addition
either decarboxylation or cyclization, depending
experimental conditions. Since no direct method is
ducing the simple nitrile, this should be a fruitful
known
is
upon
for pro-
field for further
study.
Additional study might also be given to the reactions of both pri-
mary and secondary
nitroparaffins, since these reaction products
interesting possibilities for further synthesis.
97
have
H
H N9R(OH)
2
AMINOSUCCINIC ACID
2
Aspartic Acid
Most of the methods given in the literature for preparing aspartic
acid directly from maleyl compounds and ammonia give very poor
yields owing to the formation of other products and to losses during
separation.
Manufacturing methods have been developed, however,
that do not have these defects so that aspartic acid is now a commercial product.
Temperature, pressure, and the use of catalysts are
apparently the most effective means for increasing the yield as shown
in the procedure given.
The highest yield reported, however, is obtained by the hydrolysis of 2,5-dioxopiperazinediacetamide, which can
be prepared in almost quantitative yields from diethyl fumarate and
ammonia
(q.v.).
Ammonia
of maleyl
appears to react more readily with the carboxyl groups
compounds than to add to the unsaturatcd bond. There is
some evidence that the addition
of an amino group to the carbonyl
the
in
the
activates
ethylene bonds
maleyl radical. This may account
for the greater readiness with which aspartamides and imides are fre-
quently formed.
cM-Aspartic acid is a monoclinic crystalline solid melting at 270.
very soluble in water, alcohol, and ether. It may be separated
It is
into the
two optical forms. The d-acid melts at 251 and the i-acid
271. The latter acid occurs as columnar rhombic leafs.
,
at 269 to
Uses.
Aspartic acid
is
a valuable intermediate for organic syn-
2-aminoand fumaryldiaspartic acid are a few of the products that have been made from it.
Aspartic acid is also used therapeutically as an amino acid, as a
theses.
5-Hydantoinacetic
acid,
l,l,4,4-tetraphenyl-l,4-butanediol,
carbamylaspartic
diazosuccinic
growth substance for yeast, in the production of
stabilize vitamin C and soap.
98
acid,
acid,
penicillin,
and to
NH
AMMONIA
Ammonia
HCCOH
C COH
H->
H N->
H N CH
CH
O-COH
Ammonia
Procedure.
214
g. of
is
run
Fu marie
>
acid
One hundred and
ammonium
ammonia
0=COH
in.
sixteen
Aspartic acid
grams
of fumaric acid
and
chloride are placed in an autoclave, and 34 g. of
The contents are carefully heated to 180, which
The temperature is then held at
gives a pressure of 10 atmospheres.
this point for one hour, giving a yield of aspartic acid of 60 to Q5%
of the theoretical
amount, when the product
is
recovered in the usual
manner.
Other methods of preparing aspartic acid by treating maleic, fumaric, or bromosuccinic acids with alcoholic or aqueous ammonia
yield only 15 to
30%
of the acid.
References
Tutiya, Y., JT. Agr. Chem. Soc. Japan 17, 706-710 (1941); Bull Agr. Chem. Soc. Japan 17,
87 (1941) (in English). Cf.:
Dunn, M.
S.,
and Smart, B. W.
J. Biol.
Engel, R,, Butt. soc. chim. France 48,
(2),
Chem. 89, 41 (1930).
97 (1887).
TM
Finska Kemistsamfundets Medd. 46, 165 (1937); C. A. 32, 28167 (1938).
Enkvist, T., and Laasonen, L., Ber. 72B, 1927 (1939).
Fischer, E M and Koenigs, E., Ber. 37, 4585 (1905).
Fischer, E., and Raake, X., Ber. 40, 1051 (1907).
Korner, G., and Menozzi, A., Gazz. chim. ital. 17, 226 (1887).
Stadnikoff, G., Ber. 44, 44 (1911).
Enkvist,
99
ASPARTYL LACTAM
2,5-Dioxo-3,6-piperazinediacetamide
This lactam
ammonia.
of
is
very readily formed whenever there is a large excess
from water. These do not
It crystallizes as needles
melt but decompose above 250.
and
when
of
The compound
is
insoluble in alcohol
easily saponified to give crude sodium aspartate
refluxed with 6
sodium hydroxide solution. An overall yield
ether.
It is
96%
Use.
of crude aspartate
To prepare pure
is
obtained in this manner.
acid, the saponified mixture is
treated with oopper acetate, and the crystalline copper salt formed is
removed by filtration. This salt is then converted to the acid by dis-
solving
gen
it in
sulfide.
aspartic
a normal solution of acetic acid and treating with hydroC.P. dl-acid (57% theory) may be prepared by repeat-
ing this purification procedure.
2,5-Dioxo-3,6-piperazinediacetamide has
of chemical synthesis.
from the standpoint
large
number
of hydrophilic groups that
in surface active
compounds.
100
an interesting structure
The compound
contains a
might be used to advantage
AMMONIA
NH,
II
Ammonia
OC2 H
[H
N-
H
HN
C-0
=0
TT
H
HCH N
HC
!
HC
II
HC
&
N HCH
II
fo
NH
II
Diethyl fumarate
+ Ammonia
2,5-Dioxo-3,6-piperazine-
diacetamide
Procedure.
solution of 172
g.
of diethyl
fumarate and 82
g.
of
dry ammonia gas in 1100 ml. of 99.85% ethanol is heated for 24 hours
at 100 in a suitable pressure vessel.
Proper precautions should be
taken in handling such a mixture.
The
reaction mixture
is
then transferred to another vessel, and the
solvent removed under reduced pressure. Any solids left in the pressure vessel are added to the residue, and the combined solids are
crystallized
diacetamide
from water.
is
The
yield of crude 2,5-dioxo-3,6-piperazine-
practically quantitative
by
this
method.
References
Dunn, M.
S.,
Fischer, E.,
and Fox, S. W., J. Biol. Chem. 101, 493 (1933).
and Koenigs, E., Ber. 37, 4585 (1905).
101
C/.:
IMINOTETRACARBOXYLIC ESTER
9R(OR) 2
HN
\H
9H(OR) 2
Tetraethyl Iminobissuccinate
This reaction illustrates another manner in which ammonia can combine with maleyl compounds to give different products. The procedure obviously needs further study in view of the low yields, but
clearly shown is the effect of high temperature and excess ammonia
in favoring the addition of
pound.
ammonia
The formation of amides
amount of water present.
is
to
two moles
of the maleyl
com-
evidently partially prevented
by
the large
The
tetraethyl ester of iminobissuccinic acid is a viscous liquid, b 5
It is soluble in alcohol and ether but insoluble in water.
215-217.
The
acid has not yet been isolated.
This compound would offer interesting possibilities as a polybasic
ester for commercial organic synthesis if it could be obtained in favor-
able yields.
102
NH
AMMONIA
III
Ammonia
O
HOC CH
H-
*~H
HC COH
HOC CH
C COH
>
HC
HC
CH
-N-
HOC^O
O=COH
HOC=O
Fuinario acid
+ Ammonia
>>
CH
0=COH
Iminobissuccinio acid
Twenty grams of fumaric acid is dissolved in 38 ml.
ammonia of sp. gr. 0.908, to which 50 ml. of water has
Procedure.
of aqueous
been added.
This
is
placed in a pressure flask and heated with nec-
essary precautions at 120 to 130 for 20 hours. Then the reacted mixture is heated in an open vessel on a water bath to free it of ammonia.
then made acid to tropaeolin with hydrochloric acid and evaporated to a paste. The paste is extracted with cold water, the unreacted
fumaric acid filtered off, and the extract allowed to evaporate upon
It is
a water bath.
The
residue
is
dried over concentrated sulfuric acid
vacuum
desiccator, extracted with absolute alcohol, filtered, and
in the customary manner.
esters
to
The mixture of esters
converted
in a
is
separated by distillation in vacuo after removal of the solvent.
in this way, namely, 3 g. of crude diethyl
Three fractions are obtained
aspartate, 6 7 130-170; a small amount of liquid of b 7 170-215; and
The last fraction when redistilled yields pure
g. b 7 215-220.
tetraethyl iminobissuccinate.
Reference
Stadnikoff, G., Ber. 44, 52 (1911); J. Rus. Chem. Phya. Soc. 41, 900 (1911).
103
NH
MONOAMIDES
9R/
OH
Maleaniic Acid
The monoamides, maleamic and maleanilic acids, are formed when
maleyl compounds react with ammonia, or primary or secondary
amines under anhydrous conditions.
N-Alkylmaleamic acids when heated at elevated temperatures are
converted to the imides, whereas the
rans-isomers, the fumaramic
produce largely N-alkylaspartic acids.
acids,
volatilizes readily, yielding
N-Methylmaleimide
lachrymose vapors that are readily recog-
nized as characteristics of this compound.
Maleamic acid crystallizes as plates from water.
These decompose
153, but melt at 172 to 173 if heated rapidly. Maleamic
acid is soluble in water and hot alcohol. It is insoluble in ether,
benzene, and chloroform.
Use. This reaction of maleyl compounds in forming maleamic
at 152 to
acids
is
important in the syntheses of certain sulfa-drugs, such as
bis (/?-carboxyacrylylamino) diphenylsulf one,
4,4'-
p- (2-thiazolyl) sulf amyl-
maleanilic acid, and the like.
N-Alkylmaleamic
acids, as
N-dodecylmaleamic
acid,
can be
sul-
fonated to give valuable lathering aids when added to detergents.
Resins are readily produced from alkylmaleamic acid by polymerization.
N-Ethylmaleanilic acid
is
used in the separation of mixtures con-
taining methyl, ethyl, and methyl ethyl alkylated toluidines. Maleanilic acid reacts with phosphorus oxychloride to give maleanilide
dichlorophosphate.
maleanilide.
This anilinium salt
104
is
easily hydrolyzed to the
NH
AMMONIA
HNH
Ammonia
Procedure.
-f-
Maleic anhydride
solution of 10
g.
>
Maleamic acid
of maleic anhydride in
saturated in a hood with anhydrous
the precipitation of the gummy ammonium salt
dry benzene
salt is
IV
is
removed and dissolved
in water.
350
ammonia gas
is
This solution
complete.
is
g.
of
until
The
heated until
no further odor of ammonia is detected. It is then acidified with
hydrochloric acid, which causes the maleamic acid to precipitate as
fine crystals.
The yield is 70% of the theoretical amount.
N-Substituted maleamic acids may be prepared by similar proce-
They may
also be synthesized
by heating the reactants without a solvent at elevated temperatures under pressure; by treating
maleimide with alcohols; and by allowing N-alkylfurfurylideneamines
dures.
to react with maleic acid.
References
Anschutz, R., Ann. 259, 137 (1891). C/.:
Herz, W., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 1854 (1945).
Hoogwverff, S., and van Dorp, W. A., Rcc. trav. chim. 18, 358 (1899).
Kappelmeier, C. P. A., and van Goor, W. R., Verfkroniek 21, 136 (1948).
Michael, A., and Palmer, G. M., Ber. 19, 1375 (1886).
Moore, M. L., and Miller, C. S., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 64, 1572 (1942).
Pressman, D., Bryden, J. H., and Pauling, L., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1352 (1948).
Piutti, A., and Giustiniani, E., Gazz. chim. itaL 26 (I), 431 (1896).
Snyder, H. R., and Robinson, J. C., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 63, 3279 (1941).
U.S. 2,268,754; 2,459.964. Brit. 542.874; 617,810.
105
9R>NH
MALEIMIDES
N-Phenylmaleimide
(Maleanil)
Maleimides are usually obtained from the maleamic acids either by
heating them at elevated temperatures or by treating their solutions
with phosphorus pentoxide. N-Arylmaleimides, however, may be prepared directly from maleic anhydride and the anilines if a catalyst,
such as thionyl chloride,
tures
above 160.
is
added to the reaction mixture at tempera-
Below
this temperature, a-chloro-N-phenylsuccinimide and as?/m-N-phenylmaleimides are likely to be formed.
Maleanils may also be prepared from maleanilic acids by this pro-
cedure.
This would indicate that maleanilic acids are
first
formed
during the reaction in which the anils are produced directly from
maleic anhydride. Phosphorus trichloride and acetyl chloride may
also be used as catalysts in this procedure.
N-Phenylmalcimide crystallizes from water as yellow needles, which
melt according to some investigators at 90 to 91, but according to
others at 87.5 to 88.5. The molten liquid boils under 12 mm. pressure
at 162.1 to 163.
form, alcohol,
N-Phenylmaleimide
and
is
soluble in benzene, chloro-
ether, but only slightly soluble in petroleum ether
and carbon disulfide.
Heated with barium hydroxide and water, N-phenylmaleimide yields
maleanilic acid.
When
allowed to react with aniline,
it
gives a-anilino-
Maleanils also react, for example, with phenylform
to
a-substituted maleimides such as a-anilino-Nhydroxylamines
itself reacts like maleic anhydride in
Maleimide
phenylmaleimide.
N-phenylsuccinimide.
Diels-Alder syntheses.
Use. N-substituted maleimides are useful as insecticidal and fungicidal agents.
They have been employed as preserving agents for storing cottonseed, as modifying agents for treating rubber, and as reactants in copolymerizations. N-alkylmaleimides have similar uses.
106
ArNH2
ARYLAMINES
Aniline
J22Sa >
H
?
C
/ ~-?
HC
6
-/
&
Aniline
Procedure.
slowly to
it.
is
chloride at
>
Maleanil
solution of 98
g. of maleic anhydride in 665 g. of
heated to 180, when 93 g, of aniline is added
The mixture is then kept refluxing while 125 g. of thionyl
o-chlorobenzene
chloride
Maleic
anhydride
is
added by means
60.
The
of a stream of air saturated with the
refluxing
is
continued for an hour to eliminate
evolved gases. The bulk of the solvent is removed, and the product
obtained by distillation in vacuo. The yield is 82 g., or 47% of
theory.
References
Speer,
J.
H., U. S. 2,262,262 (1942).
Anschtitz,
RM
Harvey,
M.
and Wirtz,
Delalande, A.,
S. C.,
U.S. 2,244,636.
C/.:
L., and Hall, C. M. Plant Physiol. 21, 573
Ann. 239, 137 (1887).
Compt. rend. 224, 1511 (1947) Rubber Chem. and Technol. 21, 344
/. Am. Chem. Soc. 71, 1121 (1949).
Altschul, A. M., Karon,
L.,
Kyame,
(1946).
Q.,
Fr. 844,554.
107
(1948).
2,5-DIHYDROIMIDOOXOFURANS
asym-N-(p-Melhoxyphenyl)maleimide
[N- (2,6-Dihydro-2-oxo-5-furylidene) -p-mcthoxyaniline]
Compounds
of this type are probably formed to
some extent when
any maleanilic acid is heated with acetyl chloride at temperatures
below 160
but evidence for the formation of the asymmetrical isomer
;
complete only in the case of N-(p-alkoxyphenyl)maleimides.
Here both the colorless asymmetrical and yellow symmetrical comis
pounds have been isolated as separate
entities.
That the two forms
are not physical isomerides has been confirmed from studies of their
absorption spectra.
The manner
in
which the asymmetrical com-
pounds are formed would indicate that maleanilic acids exist in two
H0 CCH=CHCONHR'
H0 CCH=
tautomeric forms, namely,
and
2
2
See equation on opposite page.
It is interesting to note that, although a-chloro-N-phenylsuccinimide
CHC(=NR')OH.
may
amic
be formed by the reaction of acetyl chloride and N-phenylmaleacid, there is no evidence that acetyl chloride or acetic acid can
add to saturate the C:C bond of maleic derivatives, such as occurs
with some ethylene compounds.
as7/m-N-(p-methoxyphenyl)maleimide crystallizes from dilute alcohol as fine needles that melt at 145 to 146. It is very soluble in
benzene, ethyl acetate, acetone, and chloroform. It has a limited
solubility in carbon tetrachloride and carbon disulfide, and it is almost
and cold
alcohol, but very soluble in boiling alcohol.
symmetrical anil consists of yellow needles that melt at 148.5
insoluble in water
The
when pure.
It
is
obtained mixed with the asymmetrical anil when
is heated with phosphorus pentoxide in
p-methoxymaleanilic acid
toluene.
The two compounds add bromine but
Use.
No
particular use has yet been
108
at distinctly different rates.
made
of these
compounds.
ALKOXYMALEANILIC ACIDS
OH
NCH OR
4
p-Methoxymaleanilic Acid
HC
CH 8 COC1
NC H OCH
6
Procedure.
tion
ing
of acetone,
g.
is
it
The
g.
of
g.
>
aaym-N-(p-Methoxyphenyl) maleimide
dry p-mcthoxymaleanilic acid,
of acetyl chloride
reaction mixture
completed.
gently in a current of dry
V
6
mixture of 5
and 15
NC H OCH 8
p-Methoxymaleanilic acid
36
II
is
In this
air.
is
refluxed until solu-
then evaporated by heat-
way
all
the solvent,
any unreacted acetyl chloride, and volatile secondary products are
removed. The crystalline residue that remains has a green color. It
is
collected on a filter
and washed with a
fectly colorless product that
is
little alcohol,
leaving a per-
then crystallized from dilute alcohol.
References
17 (5), I, 635 (1908); 18
Napoli 15 (3), 315 (1909).
Curtiua, T., and Foesterling, H. A., /. prakt. Chem. 51, (2), 371 (1895).
Piutti, A., and de'Conno, E., Mem. reale accad. Lincei, Classe sci. fis. mat. e nat. 8
Piutti, A., Atti. reale accad. Lincei, Classe sci,
312 (1909) Rend, accad.
;
793 (1911).
Warren, W. H., and Grose,
sci. fis.
M.
mat.
R., /.
fis.
mat.
e nat.
e nat. Soc. reale
Am. Chem.
109
Soc. 34, 1600 (1912).
(5),
Cf.:
(5),
AMIDES
9tt(NH2 ) 2
Fumaramide
Ammonia does not add to the C:C bond of maleyl compounds when
they are allowed to react at ordinary or low temperatures, as is the
case of this reaction and the one for maleamic acid that follows.
Maleamide may also be prepared by this method, but, in such reactions, ammonia solutions have a tendency to cause maleic acid to
isomerize to fumaric acid.
This leads to very poor yields of pure
Only 24% has been obtained even when the reaction
carried out at 10.
maleamide.
Fumaramide
occurs as needles that melt at 266
at lower temperatures, according to
is
after carbonizing
McMaster and Langreck.
It is
but very soluble in alcohol and ether.
at 180 to 181.
When heated at its melting point,
it is readily converted to fumaramide.
A mixture of the two may be
separated by dissolving in methyl alcohol in which the fumaramide is
insoluble in water,
Maleamide melts
only slightly soluble.
Uses. Molding resins are obtained by allowing these compounds to
react with formaldehyde.
Heating with zinc chloride converts them
to the imide,
which can then be copolymerized with chlorobutadienes
to give synthetic rubbers.
Substituted amides prepared with hydroxyalkylamines in a similar
manner and then sulfonated
ing,
yield useful lathering, foaming, penetratThe quinoline derivatives have
and surface-modifying agents.
been used as printing assistants and as therapeutic compounds.
Amides from poly amines, when allowed to react with formaldehyde,
produce resin finishing materials for
textiles.
Dehydration of fumaramide and maleamide with phosphorus pentoxThese are reported to be valuable
ide yields the respective nitriles.
as insecticides and as agents for the synthesis of safety-glass adhesives,
and
of
compounds
like l,2-bis(4-methyl-2-thiazolyl) ethane
succinamide.
no
and dithio-
NH
AMMONIA V
Ammonia
+ OCH
If
H N-2
|H
H 2 N-C=0
II
HC
I=0
+ QCH
Ammonia
Procedure.
4-
H2 N~C=0
|
>
Dimethyl
fumarate
mixture of 9
aqueous ammonia
C=0
g.
Kumar amide
and 35 ml. of
of dimethyl fumarate
of a sp. gr. of 0.90
is
stirred occasionally for a
period of 24 hours, during which time the fumaramide slowly separates
as a white powder.
This product is removed by filtration, dried on
the
filter,
and then
in
an oven at 100.
gaseous ammonia that
The
filtrate is
saturated with
gives an additional amount of amide when
allowed to stand for 24 hours.
The
total yield
is
2.6
g.,
or
91%
of
theory.
References
McMaster, L., and Langreck, F. B., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 40, 970 (1918). Cf.:
Bergs, U. S. Dept. Com. OPB Rept. PB688, 5 pp.
Bischoff, C. A., and Walden, P., Ann. 279, 130 (1894).
Curtius, T M and Koch, F., Ber, 19, 2460 (1886).
de Wolf, J., and van de Straete, L., Bull, dasse sci., Acad. roy. Belg. 21 (5), 216 (1935).
Hagen, R., Ann. 38, 275 (1841).
Reiser, E. H., and Kessler, J. J., Am. Chem. J. 46, 523 (1911).
Keiser, E. H., and McMaster, L., Am. Chem. J. 49, 81 (1913).
Lewis, F. M., and Mayo, F. R., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1533 (1948).
Mommaerts, H., Bull. soc. chim. Beiges 52, 79 (1943); Butt, classe sci., Acad. roy. Belg.
28, 363 (1942).
Ossipoff, L, /. Ruse. Chem. Soc. 20, 83 (1888); J. Chem. Soc. 56, 124 (1889).
Smith, L. I., U. S. Dept. Com. OTS Rept. PB39709 (1942).
Viseux, G., Butt. soc. chim. Beiges 35, 426 (1926).
U.S.
2,240,516;
2,306,095;
2,438,019; 2,447,810.
2,371,103;
2,371,104;
Brit. 590,884; 596,087.
Ill
2,391,836;
2,431,921;
Belg. 448;283.
2,433,393;
N-SUBSTITUTED ASPARTIC ACIDS
RNH9R(OH) 2
N-Methylaspartic Acid
The procedure
where no attempt
given on the opposite page is a commercial one,
made to isolate the aspartamides that are formed
is
during the reaction. The preparation is a general one. It
be
used with a wide variety of primary amines, including the
may
Diamines react
alkyl, aryl, and various other substituted derivatives.
initially
with only one molecule of the maleic anhydride in this preparation.
in substituted amines are generally non-reactive for
Hydroxyl groups
all practical purposes.
Thus m-aminophenol behaves like any other
substituted amine. No mention is made, however, of p-aminophenol,
which
is
described in other preparations as forming as?/w-N- (p-hy-
droxyphenyl)maleimide and p-hydroxymaleanilic acid.
N-Methylaspartic acid crystallizes from water as monoclinic prisms
containing one mole of coordinated water. This hydrate melts at 133
to
134.
When
heated slowly at 100,
it
loses
water to form the
anhydrous acid melting at 178. It is very soluble in hot water,
giving a strongly acid aqueous solution. It has limited solubility in
cold water but dissolves readily in dilute alkalies. The monomethyl
The diethyl ester is an oil that is only slightly
soluble in water, but very soluble in acid solutions.
ester melts at 181.5.
N-Substituted aspartic acids contain two reactive carboxyl
a reactive secondary amino radical. They are reactants
besides
groups
in the manufacture of several dyestuffs, synthetic tanning agents,
Uses.
emulsifying agents, non-foaming wetting agents, detergents, textile
assistants, rapidogens for dyeing,
and related types
112
of substances.
RNH
AMINES
Methylamine
HCCOH
H
HC
8
N->
Methylamine
H
-f
H C-~N C COM
H H
C'
II
Maleic anhydride
>
Mothylaspartic acid
Procedure.
mixture of 500 g. of maleic anhydride, 200 ml. of
water, and 750 g. of methylamine is heated at 90 for 15 hours. Then
1150 g. of 40 Be sodium hydroxide solution is added, and the stirring
for an additional 20 hours.
The resulting solution
treated with animal charcoal, then filtered, and the filtrate is concentrated under partial pressure. The sodium N-methylaspartate obtained in this way is dissolved in alcohol, and concentrated hydro-
is
contained at 90
is
chloric acid is
added until the solution is acid to Congo paper. The
removed, and then the alcohol is evaporated
salt that precipitates is
off
with the aid of vacuo.
to
remove any remaining
yellow
oil
The
salt.
residue
is
then redissolved in alcohol
Evaporation of
this solution gives a
that solidifies to a crystalline mass upon standing.
References
Reppe, W., and Ufer, H., U. S. 2,200,220 (1940).
U. S. Dept. Com. OTS Repts. PBL58767, PBL70344, and PBL63022.
U.S. 2,324,712; 2,379,535; 2,412,708.
113
Cf.
H NH
ASPARTAMIC ACIDS
OH
6
*j8"
Asparagine
Maleic anhydride reacts with a concentrated solution of ammonia in absolute
rf- and
J-"/3"-asparagines as shown.
alcohol to give a separable mixture of
Z-"/3"- Asparagine is
the one
commonly found
in nature.
It is
an a-aminosuc-
cinamic acid, with the amino groups attached to the 2- and 4-carbons. These
stereoisomers of "/3"-asparagine apparently do not form a racemic product.
Racemic acids, however, have been obtained from equal molecular mixtures of
the dr and Msomers of some of the derivatives of asparagine.
"0"-Asparagine
may
also
be prepared from the jft-monoethyl ester of J-aspartic
from Z-aspartamide, and from 2,5-dioxo-3,6-piperazinediacetamide.
The isomeric "a"-asparagine, with the amino groups attached to adjacent
acid,
carbons, may be obtained as the inactive acid by treating dZ-aspartic acid with
an alcoholic solution of ammonia, or by reducing 0-aminomaleamic acid with
aluminum amalgam.
The product obtained in this preparation is a crystalline solid that decomposes on heating at 182 to 183. It is soluble in hot water but only slightly
Prolonged heating in this liquid causes
soluble in cold water.
The mixture is
The d- and
sphenoids.
234 to 235.
it
to decompose.
practically insoluble in absolute alcohol.
!-"|8"-optical isomers obtained
When heated
in a closed tube,
They have a density d\**
The dZ-"a"-asparagin crystallizes as
one mole of water.
This water
is lost
from
it
occur as rhombic bi-
both melt at 226 and decompose at
of 1 .5434.
triclinic
at 100
pinacoidal tablets containing
when the compound
is
heated
under partial vacuum. This asparagine decomposes at 213 to 215 without
48
of 1.4550.
It is very soluble in hot water, moderately
melting and has a d*
soluble in cold water,
and insoluble
in alcohol
and
ether.
used as a growth substance for yeast and other
molds. Its mercury salt has been employed in the treatment of certain infectious diseases.
Extensive studies have been made of its biochemical prop-
Use. Z-"|3"-Asparagine
is
It reacts with formaldehyde to yield the N^-methylene derivative,
which upon oxidation with hypobromite gives 5-bromo-6-oxo-4-pyrimidineerties.
carboxylic acid.
This preparation
is
a convenient one for obtaining <2-"/3"-asparagine, since
found in very small amounts in nature.
this optical isomer is only
114
AMMONIA
NH,
VI
Ammonia
O
H,N-
is
OH
>
-11
4- Maleic
absolute ethanol)
CC
H,0
Ammonia (in
H,N
-NH,
anhydride
"/9"<Asparagine
Procedure. To a saturated solution of 10 g. of ammonia in absolute ethanol
added 1 g. of maleic anhydride. This is placed in a tube that is sealed and
heated at 105 to 110 until a light yellow resin has formed. This resin is dissolved in water and then treated with Peligato's copper oxide, which gradually
gives rise to small crystals of the insoluble copper salt of the asparagines. These
asparagine salts are then removed, suspended in water, and decomposed with
hydrogen sulfide. This yields a mixture of d- and J-"/3"-asparagines that may
be separated by fractional crystallization. The yield of these asparagines is
approximately 25%, based on the weight of maleic anhydride taken. The
Z-isomer has the same optical rotation as the product obtained from natural
Larger quantities may be more conveniently prepared by carrying
out the reaction in a bronze autoclave.
sources.
References
Mm.
279 (1886); 17, 187 (1887); 18, 471 (1888); 27 (I), 147
C/.:
(1897); 34 (II), 43 (1904); Ber. 29, 2070 (1896).
Berlingozzi, S., and Carobbi, G. Gazz. Mm. ital. 60, 573 (1930).
BerJingozzi, S., Atti. reale accad. naz. Lincei., Classe sci. fis. mat.enat. 7 (6), 1037 (1928).
Carpenter, D. C., and Lovelace, F. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 64, 2899 (1942).
Michael, A., Ber. 28, 1632 (1895).
Timmermana, J., van Lancker, T., and Jaffe, J. Bull. aoc. Mm. Belg. 48, 33 (1939).
Schaal, E M Ann. 157, 25 (1871).
Thomas-Mamert, R., Bull. soc. Mm. France 17 (3), 60 (1897).
Piutti, A., Gazz.
ital 16,
115
ASPARTAMIDES
RNH9ll(NHR) 2
d^N,NSN''-Trimethylaspartamide
(N-Methylaspartylbismethylamide)
Complete animation takes place when maleates are heated under
pressure with amines in an anhydrous solvent, such as absolute alcohol.
Since the conditions are favorable here to the saturation of the olefin
bond of the maleates, esters of the substituted aspartic acid are also
formed as one of the products. Contrary to what takes place at lower
temperatures, it would appear that in this preparation the saturation
of the maleate precedes that of the formation of the amide.
for example, this preparation with the one given for
Compare,
fumaramide.
dl-N,N^N"-Trimethylaspartamide, when pure, occurs as long colorThe product is very soluble in water and alcohol but
less needles.
practically insoluble in absolute ether. Both the aqueous and alcoholic
When heated in water, this product
solutions are strongly alkaline.
loses
methylamine
to
form the aspartamic
116
acid.
AMINES
RNH,
II
Methylamine
H H V H
HsC-N-C-C-NCHj
HC-C-NCH
H
Methylamine
-j-
Diethyl maleate
^N,N'',N'''-Trimethylaapartamide
Procedure. Twelve grams of diethyl maleate is placed in a tube,
and 50 ml. of a 33% solution of methylamine in absolute ethanol is
added to it. The tube is then sealed and heated for 8 to 10 hours at
105 to 110. Two products are formed, a solid consisting of a mass
of fine needle crystals and a liquid.
Several volumes of ether are
then added to the mixture, and the crystals are removed by filtration.
When dry, they are recrystallized from absolute alcohol. Additional
amide is obtained from the alcoholic-ether mother liquor in addition
to the liquid product, which is diethyl N-methylaspartate.
Reference
Korner, G., and Menozzi, A., Gazz. chim. Hal. 19, 422 (1889).
117
HETEROCYCLOAMINOSUCCINIC ACIDS
R>N9Jl(OH) 2
Piperidinesuccinic Acid
Heterocyclic secondary amines readily react to saturate maleyl compounds, especially the esters of maleic acid. They apparently do not
Hence
spit off alcohol to form the amides as easily as other amines.
aspartic esters can be produced directly by reaction with maleic esters
as shown.
Heterocyclic compounds, such as piperazine, which contain two secondary amino groups react with two moles of the ester to yield disuccinic acids.
ethyl ester of piperidinesuccinic acid boils under 10 mm.
159. It has a density when freshly prepared of djf
It is soluble in alcohol and ether but insoluble in water.
The pure
pressure at
1.0469.
Use.
No
commercial use has as yet been made of these derivatives
of succinic acid.
They
offer,
however,
mediates in chemical synthesis.
118
many
possibilities as inter-
R>NH
AMINES
III
Piperidine
Hj Ha
C C
\N
Piperidine
-f
Diethyl fumarate
-^
C C
HC CO
H H
Diethyl piperidineauocinate
Procedure. A mixture of 92 g. of piperidine and 156 g. of diethyl
fumarate is carefully digested on a water bath for 8 to 10 hours. The
reaction is an exothermic one. The oily product obtained upon completion of the reaction is then distilled under 1 mm. pressure, and the
largest fraction boiling at 162 to 164 is collected and redistilled to
obtain a pure product.
References
C/.:
S., and Browning, B. A., J. Chem. Soc. 73, 723 (1898).
Clemo, G. R., and Graham, S. B., /. Chem. Soc. 1930, 213.
K6rner, G., and Menozzi, A., Ber. 21R, 86 (1888); 22R 735 (1899).
Pollard, C. B., Bain, J. P., and Adelson, D. E,, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 57, 199 (1935).
Ruhemann,
119
H
OH
Ais=N9R
QUATERNARY AMMONIUM SUCCINIC ACIDS
Succinic Acid Isoquinolinium Betaine
Tertiary amines also readily add to saturate the C:C bond of maleyl
compounds at temperatures above 100, by forming the quaternary
ammonium
intramolecular salts of the betaine type. The ammonium
first.
Addition to the unsaturated bond can
acid maleates are formed
then take place through a transfer of the hydrogen atom of the isoquinolinium ion to the /3-carbon of the ethylene group of the maleate.
Substituted succinates of this type have been prepared from a variety
of tertiary
amines including pyridine, a-picoline,
2-styrylquinoline, N-alkylpiperidine,
collidine, lutidines,
N-alkyltetrahydroisoquinolines,
methylolalkylaryl amines, and dimethylolalkylamines. The pyridinium betaine yields acrylic acid upon heating. Similar compounds
may
possibly be formed with antipyrine, pyramidone, and other ter-
tiary amines.
Succinic acid isoquinolinium betaine crystallizes from water with one
mole of solvent and melts at 149 to 150. The aqueous-free intrasalt
can be prepared from it. It melts at 151 to 152. It is soluble in
alcohol, acetone, and chloroform, only slightly soluble in water, and
very slightly soluble in ether and carbon tetrachloride.
Use. Products containing a long-chain alkyl group, such as succinic acid
N-dodecyltetrahydroisoquinolinium betaine, can be used as
Compounds of
wetting, washing, emulsifying, and dispersing agents.
such structures are of interest in synthesizing new fungicides, insecticides, textile assistants, corrosion inhibitors,
maceuticals.
120
dye
stabilizers,
and phar-
AMINES
IV
Isoquinoline
H
-HOC-C
C-
-co
-COH
II
HOC-C
Isoquinoline
...
Succinio acid iso-
Isoquinoliurn acid maleate
Maleic acid
quinoHnium betaine
Procedure.
Separate solutions are prepared of 32.5 g. of isoquinoof maleic acid in absolute ether.
Upon mixing, iso-
and 29 g.
qumolinium acid maleate is precipitated. This precipitate is removed
by filtration, washed, and dried. It is then rapidly heated to its
melting point at 103 and held at this temperature for a few minutes.
line
Rapid conversion
to the betaine salt takes place.
then purified by
dissolving in
charcoal.
An
The
82%
is
yield
method
alternate
is
amounts
amine and acid, and allow
two weeks, and then to recover
of the
for
slowly formed.
is
Intrasalts of this type
is
of theory.
room temperature
the betaine salt that
betaine salt
to prepare an aqueous or alcoholic solution
of the mixture of equivalent
this to stand at
The
hot water and treating with animal
have also been prepared from a,/?-dibromosuc-
cinic acid.
References
Lutz, 0., and Krauklis, A. Ber. 69B, 419 (1936).
f
C/.:
Bergmann, F., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 60, 2811 (1938).
La Parola, G., Gazz. chim. ital. 67, 645(1937).
Lutz, 0. E., Ber. 43, 2636 (1911); /. Russ. Phys. Chem. Soc. 47, 1549 (1915).
Lutz, 0., Klein, R., and Jirgenson, A., Ann. 505, 307 (1933).
Ogata, Y., Tsunemitsu, K., and Oda, R., Bull. Inst. Phys. Chem. Research (Tokyo),
Chem. Ed.,
Pfeiffer, P.,
23,
281 (1944); C. A. 42, 6746h (1948).
A., Ber. 43, 2926 (1910).
and Langenberg,
U.S. 2,310,109. Ger. 726,670.
121
(9RN) 8
CH OH
N-HYDROXYPHENYLTRIMALEIMIDE
2,4,6-Trimaleimidophenol
//
[2,4,6-Trimaleylpicramine
orN,N ,N -(2-Hydroxy-*-phenenyl)tri-maleimide]
This reaction
is
interesting since
it
takes place readily at
room
temperatures. Since triaminophenol is very susceptible to oxidation,
the preparation has to be carried out in an inert atmosphere. Use
of the hydrochloride instead of the free-base of triaminophenol has
not given satisfactory results.
2,4,6-Trimaleimidophenol is a light yellow solid melting at 200.
It is soluble in methyl alcohol, ethyl alcohol, and acetic acid.
Treated
with concentrated nitric acid, it reacts violently to yield dimaleimidoquinone, a crystalline product soluble in alcohol that melts at 93.
The corresponding trimaleamic acid has been obtained as a brown
powder when trimaleamidophenol is saponified with potassium hydroxide.
It melts at
about 150.
Its silver salt
prepared in red light
occurs as lustrous gray crystals.
Use. No use has yet been made of this compound.
122
sym-POLYAMINOPHENOLS
2,4,6-Triaminophenol
c-c
<X C-C
I
C-C'
H
\\
VN
0-C
C=0
HC=CH
Maleio
anhydride
2,4,6-Triaminophenol
Procedure.
2 ,4 6-Trimaleimidophenol
,
An anhydrous
benzene solution containing 2.94 g. of.
placed in a separatory funnel and run into a closed
vessel containing 0.53 g. of sodium carbonate dissolved in freshly
distilled water.
Nitrogen is then bubbled through the solution to
maleic anhydride
remove
all
is
traces of air from the vessel.
An
absolute alcohol solution
containing 2.48 g. of 2,4,6-triaminophenol hydrochloride is then careA light
fully added to the mixture through the separatory funnel.
yellow product
is
formed.
This
is
removed and dried
Reference
Covello, M., Gazz. chim.
ttal.
63,
517 (1933).
123
at
100.
H
ArNHNH9R(NHNHAr)
HYDRAZIDES
2
Na-Airilinoaspartic
Acid Bis(l-phenylhydrazide)
Addition of a hydrazine to the
C:C bond
of
maleyl compounds takes
place only at elevated temperatures, as with the amines. An excess
of the hydrazine favors the formation of the bishydrazide of the addition product, as shown in this preparation, whereas equivalent amounts
of reactants lead to the production of 5-oxo-3-pyrazolidenecarboxylic
acids (q.v.), such as obtained upon the hydrolysis of the
aspartic acid bis(l-phenylhydrazides).
N a -anilino-
N a -Anilinoaspartic
acid bis(l-phenylhydrazide) occurs as irregular
that
199
to 200.
It is insoluble in water and ether,
melt
at
crystals
but readily dissolves in boiling alcohol. It shows the usual reactions
It is reduced by Fehling solution upon standing in the
Strong acids and alkalies dissolve the compound by hydrolyz-
for hydrazine.
cold.
ing
it.
124
ArNHNH
HYDRAZINES
Phenylhydrazine
H H
H C N-N
5
H H
N-NC H
N-NC H
H H
6
H H
H H H
B
If
H H
N a-Anilinoaspartio acid
Maleic acid
Phenylhydrazine
Procedure.
bia(l-
phenylhydrazid e)
mixture of 116
and
At
this
phenylhydrazine
temperature the
mass slowly becomes liquid and loses water and some carbon dioxide.
The temperature is then raised to 140 and held at this point for half
an hour. The resulting sirup is treated with hot alcohol, giving a solution that yields a crystalline mass upon cooling.
The crystals are
removed and recrystallized twice from hot alcohol. The yield is 80%
108
g. of
is
g.
of fumaric or maleic acid
heated to 120.
of theory.
Reference
Duden,
P., Ber. 26,
119 (1893).
125
CYCLIC HYDRAZINES
ArNNH 9ROH
I
5-Oxo-l-phenyl-3-pyrazolidenecarboxylic Acid
Both the amino groups of hydrazines are capable of reacting with
maleyl compounds unless one of the amino groups is completely substituted.
Thus even a greater number of derivatives of maleic acid
from the hydrazine than from the amines. When
be
formed
may
conditions are favorable to the saturation of the
C:C
'group of the
maleyl bond, 5-oxo-3-pyrazolidenecarboxylic acids are obtained. A
large amount of resinification, however, usually accompanies such
reactions so that only part of the maleic acid
ing the product of this preparation.
is
actually used in form-
5-Oxo- l-phenyl-3-pyrazolidenecarboxy lie acid crystallizes from
al-
cohol as concentrically arranged needles, which melt at 210 to 212.
It shows very slight solubility in cold water, but it dissolves readily
The aqueous solutions have a strong acidic reaction, and
give a neutral equivalent for a monobasic acid.
Use. This compound may be used for a number of organic synFerric chloride, for example, readily oxidizes it to the pyrrotheses.
in hot water.
lone.
This latter compound
may
then be used as a reactant in pre-
paring coupling agents for color photography.
126
ArNH NH
HYDRAZINES
II
Phenylhydrazine
COH
HOC
tl
,N
HCN
B
C
II
Phenylhydrazine
~\-
Maleic acid
>
r
CH
H
5-Oxo-l-pheny-3pyrazolidene
carboxylic acid
A mixture of 116 g. of maleic acid and 108 g. of phenheated to 110, at which temperature water and carbon
dioxide are evolved. The temperature is then raised to 125 until
Procedure.
ylhydrazine
is
completion of the reaction.
This produces a brown sirup that is
The combined extracts are then
extracted several times with alcohol.
evaporated, and the product so obtained is recrystallizcd twice from
alcohol to yield 50% of the theoretical amount of pure acid. The
remainder of the maleic acid
is
apparently consumed in producing
resinous derivatives.
Reference
Duden,
P., Ber. 26,
119 (1893).
127
N- AMINOM ALEIMIDES
9R > NNHAr
N-Anilinomaleirnide
Solvents have a
marked
on the type of product produced by
effect
hydrazines. N-Aminomaleimides or their analogs are the major products when hydrazines combine with maleic acid or its anhydride in
glacial
may
acetic
acid.
Several
substituted
N-(arylamino)maleimides
Their yellow color indicates that
be prepared by this procedure.
they are the symmetrical compounds.
is
However,
if
aqueous acetic
substituted for the glacial solvent, N-a-(dianilino)aspartimide
formed instead of the maleimide from phenylhydrazine and maleic
acid
is
acid.
asyw-Aminomaleimide, however,
zine hydrate reacts with maleic
white
powder.
See
is
the major product
anhydride
in
when hydra -
alcohol.
This
a$7/ra-N-(p-mcthoxyphenyl) maleimide.
other product formed in fairly large amounts
is
is
The
the cyclic N,N'-
hydrazide; l,2-dihydro-3,6-pyridazinedione (q.v.).
N-Anilinomaleimide occurs as yellowish plates or needles.
The
(259 to 260
product darkens at 180 and then melts at about 260
261
to
260
to
to
and
265
accordDuden,
Hotte,
according
according
ing to Jolles)
centrated acid.
.
It is soluble in alkalies
128
and
is
reprecipitated
by con-
ArNHNH
HYDRAZINES
III
Phenylhydrazine
H
H
i
N-Anilinomaleiraide
Phenylhydrazine
Procedure.
anhydride and
glacial acetic acid solution containing 5 g. of maleic
5.5 g. of phenylhydrazine is heated to boiling and
allowed to reflux for 20 minutes. The reaction mixture is then diluted
with water, which precipitates the malehnide.
This
is
removed and
recrystallized from alcohol three times.
References
E. Gazz. chim. ital. 66, 717 (193G).
Cf.i
Curtius, T., and Foersterling, H. A., /. prakt. Chem. 51 (2), 371 (1895).
Duden P., Ber. 26, 121 (1893).
Jolles,
Hotte, B. /. prakt. Chem. 35
t
(2),
295 (1887).
129
NH
CYCLIC HYDRAZIDE
l,2-Dihydro-3,6-Pyridazinedione
(N,N'-Maleyl Hydrazide)
further example of the polyfunctional character of hydrazines is
by the formation of l,2-dihydro-3,6-pyridazinedione when
illustrated
maleic acid reacts hydrazine hydrate. The compound is one of the
products, even when sufficient alcohol is present to precipitate asym-
aminomaleimide, which
is
the major product under these conditions.
may be formed
from the asyw-aminomaleimide by simple molecular rearrangement.
This is most favored by the conditions given on the opposite page.
Two other products are also formed in this reaction. Neither of these
has been completely characterized. Both are formed in relatively
small amounts and are yellow in color. Neither is a salt of maleic
acid according to Curtius and Foesterling. See comments by Mizzoni
and Spoerri in reference given on opposite page.
It
is
possible that l,2-dihydro-3,6-pyridazinedione
l,2-Dihydro-3,6-pyridazinedione
do not melt below 250.
tals that
hot alcohol
is
obtained as small, colorless crys-
The compound
It is easily dissolved in hot
is very soluble in
water or acetic acid. The
aqueous solution is distinctly acidic.
Use. Several interesting applications are being studied at present.
These include the use of the diethanolammonium salt as a selective
herbicide, and as an agent to inhibit growth of shrubs and to delay the
flowering of fruits.
130
H NNH
2
HYDRAZINES
IV
Hydrazine Hydrate
H-N
CH
HN
CH
HN.
C
H
O
Hydrazine
-f
Maleic acid
1 , 2-Dihydro-3 ,6-py rid-
azinedione
Procedure.
Fifty grams of hydrazine hydrate
is
added to a solu-
tion of 98 g. of maleic anhydride, which has been dissolved in a small
amount of water. Alcohol is then slowly added to the mixture, care
being taken not to add enough to precipitate the asi/w-N-aminomaleiThe reaction mixture is then heated on a
first formed.
mide that is
water bath.
When
dione are obtained.
the mixture
is
cooled, crystals of the pyridazine-
These are separated and recrystallized from hot
alcohol or water.
Reference
Curtius, T.,
Arndt,
and
Foesterling,
H. A. /.
f
5
40, 1787
Chem. 51 (2), 371 (1895). C/.:
Istanbul 9A, 19 (1944); 13A, 103 (1948); C.A.
prakt.
F., et al., Rev. faculte set. univ.
579d (1950).
and Crafts, A. S., Science 111, 152 (1950).
Fuer, H., Bachmann, G. B., and White, E. H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 73, 4716 (1951).
Greulack, V. A., and Atchison, E., Bull Torrey Bat. Club 77, 262 (1950).
Currier,
H.
43,
B.,
Knott, J. E., Proc. Am. Soc. Hort. Sci. 55, 504 (1950).
Mizzoni, R. H., and Spoerri, P. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 73, 1873 (1951).
Moore, R. H., Science 112, 50 (1950).
Schoene, D. L., and Hoffmann, O. L., Science 109, 588 (1949).
White, D. G., Science 111, 303 (1950); Flower Grower 37 (No. 9), 28 (1950).
131
9R(NHNH
HYDRAZIDES
2) 2
Fumaryl Dihydrazide
Fumaric acid
esters react with hydrazine hydrate to form the dihyUnlike the analogous reaction with amines, considerable
amounts of by-products are also formed simultaneously. The reac-
drazide.
however, has been given very little detailed study, except to show
that the formation of this dihydrazide is markedly influenced by solvents. For example, little or no dihydrazide is obtained when alcohol
tion,
is employed as a diluent, as might be expected from the reaction with
maleic anhydride. This is another example of how a complex reaction
between the polyfunctional reactant hydrazine and polyfunctional
maleyl compounds can be controlled to give different products.
Fumaryl dihydrazide
These are yellow
crystallizes as glistening plates
in color
and melt at 200.
from alcohol.
They decompose when
The dihydrazide is only slightly soluble in cold water
but readily so in hot water. It is insoluble in ether.
It reacts with acetone and benzaldehyde to form hydrazones, and
with nitrous acid to give the explosive azide that can be converted to
heated to 220.
the carbamide.
132
H NNH
Z
HYDRAZINES V
Hydrazine Hydrate
H(
Hydrazine hydrate
-f
Dimethyl fumarate
H
!-N-NH a
Fumaryl dihydrazide
g. of hydrazine hydrate and 150 g.
heated rapidly until the ester completely dissolves.
Complete reaction takes place almost immediately. Upon
the
reaction mixture, an oil is obtained that when allowed to
cooling
Procedure.
mixture of 100
of dimethyl fumarate
is
stand several hours in the desiccator readily solidifies. The resulting
crystalline solid is then recrystallized from a small amount of hot
water.
The
yield
is
relatively poor
owing to the formation
products.
References
Radenhausen, R., J. prakt. Chem. 52 (2), 433 (1895). Cf.:
Curtius, T., and Foesterling, H. A., /. prakt. Chem. 51 (2), 371 (1895).
133
of other
ACYLHYDRAZONES
OH
9R/
N(Ar)N=CHAr'
Maleic Acid l-Benzylidene-2-phenylhydrazide
Hydrazones react with maleic anhydride to form simple acylhydra-
Union takes place at
zones, which are derivatives of maleamic acid.
the nitrogen atom of the hydrazone, which is alpha to the unsaturated
C=N
bond.
Several analogs of maleic acid l-benzylidene-2-
phenylhydrazide have been prepared by the procedure given.
reaction takes place, however,
zone
is
if
the
completely substituted, as
No
=NH group in the phenylhydra-
is
the case with l-benzylidine-2-
methyl-2-phenylhydrazone.
Pure maleic acid l-benzylidene-2-phenylhydrazide occurs as yellow
The compound is very soluble in
crystals that melt at 123 to 124.
acetone and chloroform.
It is less soluble in alcohol
slightly soluble in benzene.
and only very
It is practically insoluble in
ether.
154
petroleum
ArCH=N NHAr'
HYDRAZONES
Benzaldehyde Phenylhydrazone
H|
CeH
H,CC=N
II
C C
N->
CJEU
II
|
H,C*G==N--N
C C
\
H
Benzaldehyde phenylhydrazone
Procedure.
+ Maleio anhydride
>
Maleio aoid
l-benzylidene-2-phenylhydraiide
Ninety-eight grams of maleic anhydride and 196
g.
of
benzaldehyde phenylhydrazone are dissolved separately in simmering
benzene. The two solutions are then mixed while still hot, which
causes
them
to turn dark red.
The product
is
also
dark in color until
purified by recrystallization from alcohol.
Reference
La
Parola, G., Oazz.
Dutt, D.
BM
Mm.
tial.
and Guha, P.
65,
C., /.
624 (1934).
C/.:
Indian Chem. Soc. 27, 151 (1950).
135
BISPYRROLIDINE
3RK'
N
>9H>0
N<
l,2,3,5,6,7-Hexahydro-3,7-diphenylpyrazolo[l,2]pyrazole1,2,5,6-tetracarboxylic Dianhydride
(4,8-Dipheiiyl-l,5-diazabicyclo[3.3.0]octane-2,3,6,7-tetracarboxylic
Dianhydride)
Certain osazones, such as benzaldehyde azine and anisaldehyde
two moles of maleic anhydride to give what apparently is the bispyrrolidine compounds. The formation of these derivaazine, react with
from a 1,3-addition of the osazone, which
described as a "crisscross" addition.
tives is believed to result
is
Other osazones, such as acetone azine, acetophenone azine, and
acetaldehyde azine, and l,2-bis(benzylideneamino) ethane and 2,3diphenyl-5,6-dihydropyrazine also combine with two moles of the
anhydride, but the products are unsaturated. The latter addition
products do not have definite melting points and behave as resins
having intrasalt groupings. In no case has it been shown that comC:N N:C
C:C C:N
or
pounds containing the conjugated
N:C C:N group add maleic anhydride to form Diels-Alder
adducts without isomerization.
,
1,2,3,5 ,6,7-Hexahydro-3,7-diphenylpyrazolo[ 1,2] pyrazole-l,2,5,6-tet-
racarboxylic
dianhydride
insoluble in the
is
obtained
as
a white
powder that
is
common
organic solvents except boiling glacial acetic
acid and acetic anhydride. Alphen describes it as decomposing at
Wagner-Tauregg reports 243 to 244. When dissolved in alkali
and reprecipitated with an excess strong mineral acid, the acid is
obtained as a crystalline powder melting at 253. The acid may be
recovered unchanged after boiling in 70% sulfuric acid solution for
298
10 minutes.
136
RR'C=N N=CR"R"'
AZINES
Benzaldehyde Azine
Benzaldehyde
>
Maleic anhydride
azine
l,2,3,5,6,7-Hexahydro-3,7-diphenylpyra-
zole [1,2] pyrazole-L,2,5,6-tetraoarDOxylio
dianhydride
Procedure.
mixture of 10
g.
of maleic
anhydride and
7.5 g. of
benzaldehyde azine is heated for several hours at 100. The reaction
mixture melts at first and then solidifies. The solid obtained is
extracted with several portions of boiling benzene and then with
dry ether. This leaves a light brown powder from which the bispyrrolidine product
alcohol.
is left
This powder
as a white
is
powder after extraction with boiling
from boiling glacial acetic acid
crystallized
or boiling acetic anhydride.
References
van Alphen, J., Rec. trav. chim. 61, 892 (1942).
Wagner-Tauregg, T., Ber. 63, 3224 (1930).
137
Cf.:
H
NHCONH
I
9fc
CYCLIC UREIDES
NHCONH
5-Hydantoinacetylurea
(5-Hydantoinacetic Acid Ureide)
Urea does not react with maleates except
in the presence of
sodium
ethoxide, when it unites to saturate the C:C bond by forming the
cyclic ureides of succinic acid, namely, 5-hydantoinacetylurea and the
5-hydantoinacetic acid ester. Both these compounds may be hydrolyzed to give the acid. There is no evidence that the ureides of
fumaric acid are formed during the reaction.
5-Hydantoinacetic acid may also be prepared without a catalyst by
heating urea and asparagine at 125 and then digesting the product
with hydrochloric acid, or by allowing potassium cyanate to react
with aspartic acid in normal potassium hydroxide solution. Carbamylaspartic acid is formed when aspartic acid is heated with urea
barium hydroxide. 5-Hydantoinacetic acid may
be prepared from this compound by digestion with concentrated hydro-
in the presence of
chloric acid.
5-Hydantoinacetylurea is a crystalline compound that melts at 273
with decomposition. Methyl 5-hydantoinacetate melts at
123 and the acid at 213 to 214 according to Jerzmanowska-Sienkiewiczowa. Gabriel describes the crude acid as rhombic crystals
to 274
melting at 119, and when recrystallized as melting at 224 to 226.
Use. Compounds of this general type are useful as reactants in
preparing possible bactericides and insecticides.
138
CARBAMIDES
HjNCONH,
Urea
HN C=O
HCH
HN-C=0
,-A= (
~H
r
T
NH,
Urea
4-
Dimethyl
5-Hydantoinaoetylurea
maleate
Procedure. To a solution of 4 g. of sodium in 100 ml. of absolute
is added 10.4 g. of urea and the mixture is carefully heated
alcohol
to
75.
Then 10
g. of
dimethyl maleate is run in through a separatory
is continued for 15 minutes.
This results in a
funnel, and the heating
The reaction mixture is then cooled and
and the recovered precipitate is washed with alcohol. The
product is purified by dissolving it in water and precipitating with an
excess of 20% hydrochloric acid. The yield of crude ureide is 30 to
precipitate of the acetureide.
filtered,
40%
of theory.
The
5-hydantoinacetate. This
product may be obtained by evaporating the filtrate and extracting
the residue with acetone in a Sohxlet apparatus.
filtrate
contains
1Q%
of methyl
References
Jerrmanowska-Sienkiewiczowa, Z. Roctniki Chem. 15, 202, 510 (1935).
t
2933* (1936).
Gabriel, 8 M
Guaresohi,
Ann. 348, 87 (1906).
J.,
Gazz. chim.
ital. 5,
245 (1875);
Lippich, F., Ber. 41, 2953 (1909).
139
6,
370 (1876).
C.
A.
30,
2925,
PRODUCTS FROM IMIDES
OH
NAr
Maleanilic Acid
There
maleyl
is
no evidence that
compounds
under
Schiff's bases as
anhydrous
such can react with
conditions.
When
addition
with the tautomeric dienylaniline form of the base, as is
the case with N-hexenylideneaniline (q.v.). N-Cinnamylideneaniline,
occurs,
it is
for example, yields only
2%
of maleanilic acid
as product
if
the
reactants are mixed in dry ether, benzene, or dioxane. The reaction,
however, gives 96% of the theoretical amount of maleanilic acid
when water
is
present.
behave
N-Benzylideneaniline and N-benzylidenean-
manner.
van Alphen reports that bases like N-benzylidenemethylamine and
N-cmnamylidenemethylamine form unsaturated molecular addition
compounds under certain conditions. His compounds were resinous
thranilic acid
in character
in a similar
without sharp melting points.
Little
is
known about
their
molecular structure.
Maleanilic acid occurs as yellow crystals that melt at 173 to 175.
140
R=N
SCHIFF'S BASES
AT
Benzylideneaniline
(Benzalaniline)
HOC-C
HC C
6
H.C.N 4- *
H-
H.C.NC-C
A
Water
Benzyli- -f
deneaniline
Procedure.
dride and 182
Maleic
>-
Maleanilic acid
Ninety-eight grams of freshly distilled maleic anhy-
of pure benzylideneaniline (m.p. 48 to 49) are dissolved separately in small amounts of alcohol, and the two solutions
are warmed to 40 to 50 and mixed. Maleanilic acid is precipitated.
g.
It is separated and then recrystallized from alcohol.
The filtrate contains benzaldehyde, which may be recognized by its odor and characterized by forming the addition compound with sodium bisulfite.
References
La
Parola, G., Gazz.
Mm.
ital 64, 919 (1934).
Cf.\
Bergmann, F., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 60, 2811 (1938).
Herz, W., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 1854 (1945).
Lora Tamayo, M., and Vanes, J. F., Andes fis. y quim. (Spain)
1571d (1948).
Snyder, H. R., Hasbrouck, R. B., and Richardson,
(1939).
van Alphen,
J.,
Rec. trav. chim. 61, 895 (1942).
141
J. F., /.
43, 777 (1947)
Am. Chem.
C.
A. 42,
Soc. 61,
3558
OH
I
N-HYDROXYASPARTANILS
ArN 9R>NAr'
a- (N-Hydroxyanilino) -N-Phenylsuccinimide
(2,5-Dioxo-l-phenyl-3-phenylhydroxylaminopyrrolidine)
and
a-AnUino-N-Phenylmaleimide
(3-Anilino-2,5-dioxo-l-phenyl-3-pyrroline)
Substituted hydroxylamines add to the C:C bond of maleyl compounds in the same manner as substituted amines, as shown here in
the reaction with N-phenylmaleimide. When the reactants are refluxed for 4 hours, instead of 30 minutes, however, water is gradually
between the hydrogen of the /J-succinyl group of the pyrrolidine and the hydroxyl attached to the nitrogen of the a-amino group.
split off
This leads to the formation of a-anilino-N-phenylmaleimide, as shown
in the equation.
This latter compound may also be prepared from
a- (N-hydroxyanilino) succinimide.
The method given
is
a general one, since several analogs of these
compounds have been made in this way.
a- (N-Hydroxyanilino) -N-phenylsuccinimide
that melts at
is
a crystalline solid
189; a-anilino-N-phenylmaleimide melts
142
at
238.
ArNHOH
HYDROXYLAMINES
Phenylhydroxylamine
N-Phenylhydroxylamine
Procedure.
ylamine and 2
Water
N-Phenylmaleimide
>
>
a-(N-Hydroxyanilino)-N-
moloimide
pyridine solution containing 1.2
g. of
a-Anilino-N-phenyl-
phenylsuccininiide
N-phenylmaleimide
is
g. of
phenylhydrox-
refluxed for 30 minutes.
then added to the reaction mixture that precipitates the
succinimide. This precipitate is removed and purified by recrystalis
lization
from alcohol.
mixture is refluxed for 4 hours, instead of stopping the
reaction at the end of half an hour, a-anilino-N-phenylmaleimide is
obtained as a crystalline mass within the reaction mixture. It is
If the
purified in the
same manner, by
crystallization
Reference
Jolles,
EM
Gazz.
Mm.
ital 66,
717 (1936).
143
from alcohol.
H
ACYLASPARTIC ANHYDRIDE
ArCONH9H>0
N-Benzoylaspartic Anhydride
Both stereoisomers
of
benzaldehyde oxime react with maleic anhy-
dride to produce N-benzoylaspartic anhydride. The reaction may be
viewed as taking place in two steps, i.e., (1) addition of the oxime
to the
C:C bond
of the
maleyl compound, similar in manner to what
takes place with pyrroles (q.v.), and (2) a Beckmann rearrangement
of the resulting ketoxime to the N-acylaspartic anhydride. An even
simpler mechanism would be to assume that the benzaldehyde oxime
isomerizes during the reaction to benzamide, and that the addition
takes place between the amino group of the amide and C:C group
That small amounts of carbon dioxide and carbon
of the anhydride.
monoxide are evolved during the reaction and that a considerable
quantity of benzaldehyde is formed would indicate, however, that the
reaction is far more complex than shown by either of these mechanisms.
Maleic acid reacts with the oxime to give benzaldehyde.
N-Benzoylaspartic anhydride melts at 154. It is very soluble in
cold water but only slightly soluble in cold alcohol, acetone, ether,
and benzene. It readily absorbs water from the air to give the monohydrate of the acid, which may also be obtained by dissolving the
anhydride in water. The monohydrate softens and loses water when
dried at 75 to 80, or when confined under reduced pressure over
When
heated over a flame, it melts at
119, solidifying again at about 125 to 130 and finally melting at
154 as the anhydride.
concentrated sulfuric acid.
Use. The method described on the opposite page is a very convenient one for preparing N-acyl derivatives of aspartic and other
amino acids. N-Toluylaspartic acid and N-(methoxybenzoyl) asparacid have been prepared in this way.
derivative is 70%, as compared to only
tic
acid.
144
The
50%
yield of the
methoxy
for N-benzoylaspartic
ArC=NOH
OXIMES
Benzaldehyde Oxime
(Benzaldoxi me )
Benzaldehyde oxime
Maleic anhydride
>
N-Benzoylaspartio anhydride
maleic anhydride and 2 g. of
a- or /3-benzaldehyde oxime in 7 ml. of benzene is cooled in a freezing
mixture and then carefully brought to a 'boil in a hood and refluxed
Procedure.
mixture of
1.6 g. of
on a water bath for an hour. During this time, small amounts of both
carbon dioxide and carbon monoxide are evolved. The solution turns
dark yellow in color, and the product is precipitated as a white crystalWhen the reaction is complete, the crystals are removed by
line solid.
filtration
The
50%
and washed several times with small amounts
mainder
of the oxime.
Reference
La
of benzene.
yield of crude anhydride obtained in this way is approximately
The filtrate contains benzaldehyde from the reof theory.
Parola, G., Gazz.
Mm.
ital.
67,
481 (1937); 73, 94 (1943).
145
BICYCLOPYRROLIDONECARBOXYLIC ACIDS
NC H
6
2,4-Diethyl-7-oxo-6-phenyl-6-azabicyclo[3.2.1]-3-octene-
8-carboxylic Acid
Schiff's bases from aniline and 2-alkenals are apparently tautomeric
mixtures of the base and the conjugated N-alkadienylaniline. In
the latter form these bases add maleic anhydride like any other diene.
Hence this reaction may be looked upon as a simple Diels-Alder
addition, where the reactant rearranges to yield the more stable
bicyclopyrrolidonecarboxylic acid, instead of the usual substituted
tetrahydrophthalic anhydride. The dimethyl analog of the above
azabicyclopyrrolidonecarboxylic acid has also been prepared.
These reactions are further illustrations of the affinity of ammo
radicals for the carbonyl groups of the maleyl compounds. There is
no evidence that the conjugated
grouping in the
normal form of the Schiff's base undergoes Diels-Alder addition in
C=C C=N
The high yield of the azabicyclic product would indicate that the reaction takes place exclusively with N-alkadienyltautomer. Hetro conjugated groups generally do not react as dienes
this reaction.
toward maleic anhydride as pointed out under azines (q.v.). DielsAlder adducts apparently are only formed when isomerization takes
place, as occurs here and in the reaction with 2,3-dimethylquinoxaline
(q.v.).
2,4-Diethyl-7-oxo-6-phenyl-6-azabicyclo [3.2.1 ]-3-octene-8-carboxcan also be prepared from maleanilic acid and 2-ethyl-2hexenal, but not from N-phenylmaleimide nor the substituted butaThe yield from maleanilic acid is 60 to 70%, which is 10 to
diene.
15% less than obtained by the method described here.
ylic acid
2,4-Diethyl-7-oxo-6-phenyl-2-azabicyclo
ylic acid is deposited
[3.2.1 ]
-3-octene-8-carbox-
from alcohol as
colorless crystals that melt at
is soluble in sodium carbonate solutions,
145 to 146. The compound
from which it can be recovered by precipitation with acid. It is also
soluble in dilute alcohol solutions. Mixtures of products made by
the two methods show no lowering in melting points.
Use. These methods are a convenient means for preparing substituted pyrrolidone compounds for various uses.
146
CH=NC H
RCH==CR'
ALKENYLIDENEANILINES
2-Ethyl-2-hexenylideneaniline
ni
/ \
o
ii
HC H-C-C-
HC
"
H C C
2
ii
un r
HC-COH
H
2-Ethyl-2-hexenylideneaniIine
-f"
>
Maleio
anhydride
2,4-Diethyl-7-oxo~6-phenyl-6azabicyclo[3.2. l]-3-octene-8-
carboxylic acid
Procedure. A solution containing 67 g.
and 32.7 g. of maleic anhydride
aniline
of 2-ethyl-2-hexenylidenein 434 ml. of anhydrous
benzene is allowed to stand for 2 hours in a dry atmosphere. The
small amount of maleanilic acid that is precipitated is removed by
filtration, and the reaction mixture is heated for 3 hours, continuing
The mixture is set aside for
to exclude any atmospheric moisture.
several days for crystallization to take place. If necessary, it is seeded
with a few crystals of the product. When complete, the solid mass
is
removed and purified by
of 75 to
80%
recrystallization from alcohol.
of theory is obtained in this manner.
yield
References
Snyder, H.
RM
(1939).
Snyder, H.
Hasbrouck, R. B., and Richardson,
J. F., J.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 61, 3558
Cf.:
RM
and Robinson,
J. C., Jr., /.
147
Am. Chem.
Soc. 63,
3279 (1941).
PRODUCTS FROM AZINES
OH
NHN=CHAr
Maleic Acid Benzylidenehydrazide
(Benzalmaleinhy drazide )
At ordinary temperatures azines, such as benzaldehyde azine, do
not react with maleic anhydride unless water is present. When water
added, a reaction similar to that with Schiff's bases takes place, as
shown. This results in the formation of an acylhydrazone. In the
is
absence of water and solvents, however, azines react at 100 to form
tough yellow or dark-colored resins. With an excess of maleic anhydride,
they produce what appears to be bispyrrolidine compounds
(q.v.).
Maleic acid benzylidenehydrazide
common
solvents.
When
is
recrystallized
practically insoluble in
from
acetonitrile,
it
most
melts at
183.
Use.
No
industrial use has yet been
148
made
of these
compounds.
ArCH=N N=CHAr
AZINES
II
Benzaldehyde Azine
(Benzalazine)
?H
flc
+
N- *
N
HCC H
HOC C
-0-C
HN-Q-C
o'
\c-c
A"
1
HOC.H.
II
Benzaldehyde
Procedure.
hyde
5
-f-
Water
solution
is
Maleic
anhydride
Maleic acid
benzylidenehydrazide
prepared containing 5.2
azine, 2.5 g. maleic anhydride,
and 75 ml.
g.
of benzalde-
of ether that has been
This is allowed to stand for 4 days. The
is
then
collected on a filter, washed with ether, and
formed
hydrazide
recrystallized from acetonitrile. The yield in this case is 78% of
saturated with water.
theory.
The other product of the reaction, benzaldehyde, may be recovered
from the filtrate by means of a sodium bisulfite solution. The aldehyde can then be regenerated and identified by preparing the phenylhydrazone. This hydrazone melts at 156 to 157.
References
Snyder, H. R., Levin, R. H., and Wiley, P. F., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 60, 2025 (1938).
Caronna, G., Gazz. chim. ital. 77, 427,482 (1947); 78, 38, (1948).
149
C/.:
PYRROLE
ADDITION COMPOUNDS
2-Methyl-5-pyrrolesuceinic Anhydride
Heterocyclic compounds containing the conjugated pyrrole ring react
with maleic anhydride in a very unexpected manner. Several different
types of compounds may be formed during the process as a result of
subsequent reactions. The initial reaction in most cases, however,
appears to be one of the additions of the a-carbon of the pyrrole to
the
C:C bond
of maleic anhydride.
Union
of either one or
cules of the anhydride takes place at the carbon
atoms
two moleand 5-
in the 2-
This addition takes place only if these
positions of the pyrrole ring.
carbons of the pyrrole are unsubstituted. Pyrrole, for example, adds
two moles
of maleic anhydride to form 2,5-pyrroledisuccinic anhydride,
but this crystalline compound readily hydrolyzes in the reaction mixture at 60 to yield y,-dioxosebacic acid, dilevulinic acid. N-Methylpyrrole adds maleic anhydride in a similar manner, but refluxing the
reaction mixture causes decarboxylation to occur, producing N-methyl2,5-pyrroledipropionic acid. a-Methylpyrrole as shown gives the pri-
mary
product, 2-methyl-5-pyrrolesuccinic anhydride.
a-methylbenzopyrrole, and N-a-dimethylindole,
which have substituents attached to both the 2- and 5-pyrrole carbons,
a-Methylindole,
add maleic anhydride at the 3-pyrrole carbon to yield a mixture of
and the a-3-indyl-/J-indylcarbonylpropionic acid,
3-indolesuccinic acid
<x-8-indyl-y-oxo-S-indolebutyric acid. Maleic anhydride reacts with
in ethyl acetate to form 5a,10b,10c,ll-tetrahydroy-oxoazetodiindole-6-a-butenoic acid, diindolemaleic acid.
two moles of indole
2-Methyl-5-pyrrolesuccinic anhydride is a crystalline compound
melting at 134. Its dimethyl ester melts at 71.
Uses. Compounds of similar structures have been used in perfumes,
as rooting materials
and as
stabilizers for lubricants.
150
PYRROLES
TJ
YH
a-Methylpyrrole
-C
H,C
C->
+ C COH
ViH
a-Methylpyrrole
Procedure.
H.C-C
C COH
+
Maleio acid
C-C-COH
N
HC COH
H
2-Methyl-5-pyrroleauccinic acid
In preparing a solution of maleic acid, 3.6 g. of the
dissolved in 20 ml. of warm water. This solution
is first
anhydride
is then cooled to room temperature and 1 g. of a-methylpyrrole is
added to it. The mixture is shaken in a stoppered vessel until all
the pyrrole is dissolved. If necessary, it is cooled from time to time
to maintain a smooth reaction and to prevent the formation of fumaric
acid from
any marked increase
in temperature.
The
reaction mixture
becomes dark in color, and the product is precipitated as minute crystals.
These crystals are collected by filtration, recrystallized from
acetonitrile, and dried under reduced pressure over calcium chloride.
References
Diels, O., Alder, K.,
and Winter, D., Ann. 486, 211 (1931). C/.:
and Lubbert, W., Ann. 490, 277 (1931).
Diela, 0., Alder, K.,
151
PYRAZINOTETRAHYDROPHTHALIC ANHYDRIDE
NH C CH
l,2,3,4,5,10-Hexahydro-2,3-phenazinediearboxylie Anhydride
(l,2,3,4,4a,10a-Hexahydro-2,3-phenazinedicarboxylic Anhydride)
the
containing
grouping within aromatic
rings, generally do not react with maleic anhydride, but 2,3-dimethylquinoxaline is an exception. This compound, like hexenylideneanilines
Quinoxalines,
other
like
N=C C=N
or
compounds
cyclic
C=C C=N
(q.v.), consists of a mixture of tautomcrs, one form of which does not
contain a second aromatic ring embracing the conjugated grouping.
It is this exo-diene form that apparently undergoes the Diels-Alder
type of condensation, as shown on the opposite page.
As would be
quinoxaline, 2-methylquinoxaline, 2-methyl-3-phenylquinoxaline, and 2,3-diphenylquinoxaline do not react with maleic anhydride since they cannot form such a tautomer. Anthranil, which con-
expected,
tains a similar
form a
C=C C=N-
group between the two rings, reacts
colorless addition
compound. However, this product may
not be a true Diels-Alder type of adduct but rather one resulting from
substitution-addition at the C-carbon in a manner similar to pyrroles
(q.v.), since C-phenylanthranil does not react with maleic anhydride
to
when
treated in the
same way
as anthranil.
anhydride does
not melt below 305, but it sublimes at 260 when heated under 15 mm.
pressure, to give a brown sublimate from which the compound
1 ,2,3,4,5,10-Hexahydro-2,3-phenazinedicarboxylic
can be recovered by crystallization from acetic acid. It is soluble in
tetralin and methyl alcohol, but only slightly soluble in chloroform
and acetone. It is also soluble in 30% sodium hydroxide solution,
from which it can be recovered by carefully adding an equivalent of
concentrated hydrochloric acid.
It is
unchanged by
Anhydrides
Use.
refluxing in
The adduct
10%
of this type
is
soluble in excess acid.
caustic solution for one hour.
are valuable as reactants in the
preparation of bactericides, insecticides, and pharmaceuticals.
152
\CH
V\N
2,3-DIMETHYLPYRAZIlNES
CH
CH CH
2,3-Dimethylquinoxaline
c
"'
2,3-Dimethylquinoxaline
"A
H
N
VV V"
Maleio
anhydride
1, 2,3,4,5,
10-Hexahydro-
2 3-phenaz i nedicar boxy lio
,
anhydride
Procedure. A solution of 0.5 g. of anhydrous 2,3-dimethylquinoxaline and 0.3 g. maleic anhydride in 20 ml. of dry toluene is heated
This produces a brown sticky
to boiling and refluxed for 2^2 hours.
product, which is allowed to settle overnight in a refrigerator. The
supernatant toluene is then decanted off, and the gummy mass is dissolved in hot acetic acid. The acetic acid solution is then cooled and
placed in the refrigerator until the light greenish yellow crystals of
the product are obtained. These crystals are collected and recrystallized several times from acetic acid.
Additional amounts are obtained
when the mother
liquor
is
refluxed for 3 hours.
0.4 g.
Reference
Schonberg, A., and Mostafa, A., J. Chem. Soc. 1943, 654.
153
The
total yield is
H NCON<9R(OR) ETHYLENEUREADICARBOXYLIC ESTERS
2
Diethyl l-Carbamyl-2,3-Aziridinedicarboxylate
(Diethyl a,-(aminocarbonylimino)8uccinate or Diethyl
l-Carbamyl-2,3-ethyleniminedicarboxylate)
azide, unlike benzyl azide, loses nitrogen during addition
to the unsaturated C:C bond of maleates.
The primary product of
Carbamyl
this
reaction
ester
is
the
l-carbamyl-2,3-aziridinedicarboxylic ester.
the isomeric 2-oxo-4,5-imidazolidinedicarboxylic
also obtained. This latter ester is probably a secondary
amount
small
is
of
can be prepared by heating a dilute hydrochloric
the l-carbamyl-2,3-aziridinedicarboxylate. Prolonged digestion of this solution, with attendant evolution of carbon
dioxide, yields the ester of a,/?-diaminosuccinic acid.
Digestion with
a sodium carbonate or concentrated acid solution gives the 2,3product, since
acid solution
it
of
aziridinedicarboxylic ester.
Diethyl l-carbamyl-2,3-aziridinedicarboxylate crystallizes from
alcohol as rhombic leaves that melt at 154. Lance-like crystals are
obtained upon cooling a hot dilute hydrochloric acid solution. The
compound readily dissolves in half its weight of hot alcohol but is
only slightly soluble in the cold solvent. It is insoluble in ether,
chloroform, and benzene. Diethyl 2-oxo-4,5-imidazolidinedicarboxylate melts at
Use.
93.
Compounds having such
structures are valuable as reactants
in the preparation of adhesives; as agents for
improving the strength,
crease resistance, and the hydrophobic properties of cellulosic fibers;
and as reagents in the synthesis of detergents and other useful organic
products.
154
H NCON,
AZIDES
Carbamyl Azide
II
-COC 2 H
-COC 2 H
t-cocA
0=COC 2 H
Carbamyl azide
Procedure.
4-
Diethyl fumarato
mixture of 20
Diethyl l-carbamyl-2,3-aziridinedioarboxylate
g. of
carbamyl azide and 100
g.
of
diethyl fumarate is heated upon a water bath for 2 hours. During
this time there is a strong evolution of nitrogen.
Heating is then
continued for an additional 12 hours under a pressure of 80 to 100 mm.
The
reaction
mixture
is
with
treated
small
amount
of
cold
alcohol, and set aside for several days until crystallization ensues
under partial vacuo. After 4 to 8 days, the inside of the flask is
rubbed with a glass rod to increase the rate of crystallization. When
is complete, the solid mass is collected, sucked dry upon
with a limited amount of absolute alcohol, and then
washed
filter,
Based upon the amount of carbazide
from
alcohol.
recrystallized
taken, the yield is 40% of theory, as compared to 10 to 15% when
diethyl maleate is employed as the reactant.
Half a gram of diethyl 2-oxo-4,5-imidazolidinedicarboxylate may
also be obtained from the above filtrate by removing the solvent and
crystallization
distilling the oily residue
under 12
mm.
of pressure.
Reference
Curtius, T. and Dorr, W., J. prakt. Chem. 125, 425 (1930).
f
155
ArCHs
DIHYDROTRIAZOLEDICARBOXYLIC ESTERS
V
2
Dimethyl l-benzyl-A -l,2,3-triazoline-4,5-dicarboxylate
Considerable decomposition accompanies this addition of benzyl
The
azide to maleic esters.
likely to
vary widely
from one preparation to another. Dimethyl fumarate appears to give
much better results than the diethyl ester when allowed to react at
the
same temperature.
yield, therefore,
is
Prolonged heating causes a marked evolution
of nitrogen, with the formation of dibenzyloxamide
and benzylam-
monium benzyl oxamate.
2
Dimethyl l-benzyl-A -l,2,3-triazoline-4,5-dicarboxylate is obtained
as colorless, anisotropic prisms that melt at 75. This ester is insoluble in ether and in water. It is very soluble in alcohol. The compound decomposes with an evolution of nitrogen
that the free acid cannot be obtained from it.
156
when
saponified so
ArCH 2N
AZIDES
II
Benzyl Azide
H C CH
6
C COCH
\H
CCOCH
II
0==COC
OCH,
N-
Benzyl azide
Dimethyl fumarate
C COCH
Dimethyl l-benzyl-A2l^S-triaioline-^Sdicarboxylate
Procedure. A mixture of 6.7 g. of benzyl azide and 7.2 g. of
dimethyl fumarate is heated on a water bath at 85. The dimethyl
fumarate slowly dissolves as the mixture becomes yellow. At the
sign of evolution of nitrogen, the mixture is cooled quickly, and
the solid that separates is filtered immediately. This product is freed
of any unreacted ester by suction and is further purified by recrystalfirst
from a large volume of petroleum ether
best yield obtained is about 30%.
lization
The
Reference
Curtius, T., and Raschig, K., J. prakt. Chem, 125, 4G6 (1930).
157
(b.p.
60 to 70).
CH
PYRAZOLINECARBOXYLIC ACIDS
9R(OH),
NH
2-Pyrazoline-4,5-dicarboxylic Acid
Diazo compounds such as diazomethane, diazoacetic
acid,
and
diazodiphenylmethane unite with the ethylene group of maleates to
form the 1-pyrazoline derivatives that rearrange during the reaction
to yield the 2-pyrazoline isomers. These pyrazolinecarboxylic acid
derivatives lose nitrogen fairly readily either upon heating or when
allowed to stand at room temperatures, forming thereby the cyclo-
Pyrazolinedicarboxylic esters produce the
whereas
Jrans-cyclopropane acids,
pyrazolinedicarboxylic anhydrides
propanecarboxylic acids.
yield the czs-compound.
Diazo compounds like azobenzene containing substituents on both
nitrogen atoms do not react with maleyl derivatives. Diazonium salts
react by splitting off nitrogen (q.v.).
2-Pyrazoline-4,5-dicarboxylic acid occurs as rhombic plates that
melt at 97.
is
It is soluble in alcohol, chloroform,
to give brown-red solution.
ing the silver
Use.
and hot water.
It
and
In alkali, it dissolves
ligroin.
Free pyrazole may be obtained by heat-
only slightly soluble in ether
salt.
Compounds
of this type are useful reactants in the prepa-
ration of Pharmaceuticals, as coupling agents for color photography,
and
for special-purpose resins.
158
RCHN
DIAZO COMPOUNDS
Diazomethane
H
C-COCH
C-COCH
N=N-> ""
*
3
H
HC~>
Diazo-
I'
II
C-COCH
N I C-COCH
^ /TT
NH
H Q
>
Dimethyl 1-Py-
maleate
razoline-4,5-dicar-
HHC-COH
C
O-COH
H
NV
II
Dimethyl
methane
'
>
"
2-Pyrazolme-4,5dioarboxylio acid
boxylate
An ether solution containing 11 g. of dimethyl fumaallowed to absorb diazomethane until no further decoloration
Procedure.
rate
is
takes place. This operation should be carried out most carefully in
a well-ventilated hood. The ether is cautiously evaporated, and the
washed with the same solvent and then
of chloroform and ligroin.
This gives
of the above ester.
The 2-pyrazolinedi-
resulting colorless crystals are
recrystallized
from a mixture
a quantitative yield, 14 g.
carboxylic acid is then obtained by hydrolysis in the customary
manner.
Precaution should be taken in carrying out this reaction since
diazomethane
is
extremely poisonous.
References
von Pechmann, H.,
Ber. 27, 1890 (1894).
C/.:
Biichner, E. Ber. 21, 2640 (1888),
t
Buchner, E., and Witter, H.,. Ann. 273, 239 (1893); Ber. 23, 2684 (1890).
Darapsky, A., Ber. 43, 1119 (1910).
Staudinger, H., Anthes, E., and Pfenniger, F., Ber. 49, 1928 (1916).
Silberrad, 0., and Roy, C. 8., /. Chem. Soc., 89, 180 (1906).
van Alphen,
J.,
Rec. trav.
Mm.
62,
210 (1943).
159
Ar
a-ARYL-0-CHLOROSUCCINATES
9R(OR) 2
Cl
Dimethyl a-Chloro-/3- (p-chlorophenyl)succinate
chlorides, unlike diazomethane, lose their nitrogen when
maleic and fumaric esters. The aryl group of the
with
react
they
diazonium chloride in this reaction unites with one of the carbons
Diazonium
C:C
of the
unsaturated bond of the maleate or fumarate and the
chloride ion with the other carbon to give the a-aryl-/2-chlorosucciThe ^-chlorine atom is not stable to alkali so that the suc-
nates.
cinate
acid
is
quantitatively converted to the sodium salt of the arylfumaric
these substituted succinic esters are saponified with alcoholic
when
Arylmaleic anhydrides can be prepared by distilling the
arylfumaric acids with a small amount of chlorocymylsulfonic acid.
potash.
The arylmalcic
acids are prepared by treating the anhydrides with
When maleic acid is used as the reactant in place of
boiling water.
the esters, both dehydrochlorination and decarboxylation accompany
the loss of nitrogen during the reaction, resulting in the formation
of arylacrylic acids.
In this
(Cf. Grignard and Friedel Reactions.)
poor yields are obtained in the presence of acetone. Cupric
chloride but not cuprous chloride is catalyst for both of the above
case,
types of reaction.
Dimethyl a-chloro-/2-(p-chlorophenyl)succinate occurs as rhombic
crystals that melt at
222,
79.
(p-Chlorophenyl) fumaric acid melts at
the maleic acid at 141 to
143, and the anhydride at 146.
160
ArN
DIAZONIUM CHLORIDES
Cl
p-Chlorobenzenediazonium Chloride
II
C-COCH
X>CH 8
0=COCH
p-Chlorobenzene-
Dimethyl
fumarate
>
Dimethyl
-chloro-0-
(p-chlorophcnyl)succinate
diazonium
chloride
Procedure.
p-chlorobenzenediazonium chloride solution is prepared by diazotizing 32 g. of p-chloroaniline. This is added to a
solution containing 300 ml. of acetone, 10.5 g. of cupric chloride, 50.6
g. of
sodium monochloroacetate and 24
g. of
dimethyl fumarate.
The
carefully agitated at 15 to 20 for 3 hours, during which
time the nitrogen is slowly evolved. When the reaction is completed,
mixture
is
the mixture
benzene.
is
Any
steam-distilled, and then thoroughly extracted with
acidic constituents are removed by treating the ben-
zene extract with an aqueous soda solution.
The
extract
is
next dried
and the solvent removed by distillation. The 40.7 g. of residue is
dissolved in a minimum amount of methanol, and the solution is set
aside in a bath of cracked ice for 12 hours, during which time crystalThe
lization occurs, accompanied by the separation of a dark oil.
are
with
removed
a
washed
crystals
carefully
spatula, thoroughly
with ice-cold methanol, and then recrystallized either from methylcyclohexane or carbon tetrachloride.
The
yield
is
20.7
g.,
or
42.8%
of theory.
References
Meerwein, H., Btichner, E., and van Emster, K., J. prakt. Chem. 152, 237 (1939).
Koelsch, C. F., and Boekelheide, V., /. Am. Chem. Soc., 66, 413 (1944).
Rai, J., and Matur, K. B. L., /. Indian Chem. Soc. 24, 383 (1947).
161
Cf.:
C0 R
POLYCARBOXYLIC NITRILES
NC CH CH
:
9fc
2
9fc(OR)
Trimethyl 4-Cy ano-1 ,2,3-butanetricarboxylate
Maleyl compounds do not react, in general, with hydrogen cyanide
compounds. When addition to the C:C bond does
it
is
accompanied by dimerization of the fumarate and either
occur,
decarboxylation, as shown here, or cyclization, as described in the next
to give saturated
preparation of the trimethyl 4-cyano-5-oxo-l,2,3-cyclopentanetricarboxylic ester (q.v.). Some hydrolysis of the dimethyl fumarate to
At the same time the ester of methoxysucformed through reaction between the fumaric ester and
the acid ester also occurs.
cinic acid is
the solvent.
Normally such a reaction as the
last does
not occur
except in the presence of alkoxides (q,v.).
Fumaryl
chloride, formaldehyde,
and hydrocyanic
acid, in contrast,
react to give biscyanomethyl fumarate.
Purified trimethyl 4-cy ano-1, 2 ,3-butanetricarboxy late boils under
mm.
Use,
of pressure at 178 to
This compound
is
180.
interesting because of the possibilities
offers for organic syntheses.
162
it
HCN
NITRILES
Hydrocyanic Acid (Potassium Cyanide)
0= COCH
H
?
0=COCH
0=COCH
0=COCH 0=COCH
CH
HC
0=COCH
Dimethyl fumarate
+ Water + Hydrocyanic acid
3.25
g.
HC-C=N
H
8
Trimethyl 4-cyano- 1,2,3-
(Potassium cyanide)
Procedure.
butanetricarboxylate
With proper precautions a
solution
is
prepared of
and 50 ml.
of potassium cyanide in a mixture of 5 ml. of water
of methanol.
To
this is
added
7.2 g. of
dimethyl fumarate, and the
carefully shaken and set aside in a well-ventilated hood
for 48 hours.
The suspended ester slowly dissolves within 2 hours.
mixture
When
is
the reaction
is
complete, the mixture
is
neutralized with an
equivalent amount of hydrochloric acid and then diluted with 50 ml.
The potassium chloride that is formed is filtered off, and
of ether.
the ether is allowed to evaporate. The residue is then distilled under
reduced pressure into three fractions. The first contains 1 g. of
dimethyl methoxysuccinate, 6 2 85-100
acid maleate, 6 2
190-200.
145-155; and the
This last fraction
the second, 3.9 g. of methyl
last, 2.5 g. of a viscous oil, 6 2
;
is redistilled
to obtain pure trimethyl
4-cyano-l,2,3-butanetricarboxylate.
Every precaution should be taken in carrying out this reaction,
since lethal hydrogen cyanide
is
present.
References
Michael, A., and Warner, N., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 59, 744 (1937).
Henze, M., Ber. 33, 966 (1900).
Mowry, D. T., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 66, 371 (1944).
163
Cf.:
CYCLIC POLYCARBOXYLIC NITRILES
1
I
9RNC9R 9R
tttl
(OR) 2
OR
Trimethyl 4-Cyano-5-oxo-l,2,3-cyclopentanetricarboxylate
(Trimethyl 2~Cyano-2,3,5-tricarbomethoxycyclopentanone)
An anhydrous
solvent, in contrast to
what has been described
for
the previous preparation, prevents hydrolysis of the dialkyl fumarate
in this reaction with potassium cyanide.
Under such conditions, de-
carboxylation also does not occur, but cyclization takes place instead.
Such ring closure could easily be the result of a splitting off of methanol
from groups attached to the 1- and 4-carbon atoms of an intermediate
cyanodimer.
As
methoxysuccinate
amount of dimethyl
formed through reaction with the solvent.
in the last preparation, a large
is
Redistilled
4-cyano-5-oxo-l,2,3-cyclopentanetricarboxtrimethyl
ylate boils under 4 mm. pressure at 196.
Use. This compound is an interesting reactant, since it contains
both a
nitrile
and three carboxyl groups.
164
HCN
NITRILES
II
Hydrocyanic Acid (Potassium Cyanide)
O
? H
}-C
KLCOC-C
-i
CO< j
H coc=0
Dimethyl fumarate
AHC-C=N
r\
\j
r^tr
v/n.
I
H.coi-0
>
+ Hydrocyanic acid
Trimethyl 4-cyano-5-oxo- 1,2,3cyclopentanetricarboxylate
(Potassium cyanide)
Procedure. With the necessary precautions employed,
dimethyl fumarate is carefully added to a suspension of
14.4 g. of
6.5 g. of
potassium cyanide in 50 ml. of absolute methanol. The mixture is
then set aside in a well-ventilated hood for 4 days, at the end of
which time 3
is removed, the filan absolute methanol solution of hydrogen
Then the
chloride, and the potassium chloride formed is filtered off.
solvent is removed at room temperature by applying a partial vacuum.
A residue of 16.3 g. remains, which is divided into two fractions on
g.
of undissolved potassium cyanide
trate neutralized with
reducing the pressure to 2
mm.
The
first fraction,
75-78, weighs
methoxysucapproximately
The other, with a 6 2 196-205, weighs 5.4 g.
cinate (m.p. 107-108).
The latter is then redistilled under approximately the same pressure
5.5 g.
and
to give the pure product.
Reference
Michael. A., and Werner, N., J.
t>
consists largely of dimethyl
Am. Chem.
Soc. 59, 744 (1937).
165
POLYESTER AMIDES
9JIORN H-J*
Poly-2-maleamyl-2-methyl-l,3-propylene Maleate
Aminodiols, like 2-amino-2-methyl-l,3-propanediol, react with both
maleic anhydride and with succinic anhydride to form thermosetting
resins,
in
contrast
products produced with
This would indicate that both the amino and
to
the
thermoplastic
phthalic anhydride.
hydroxyl groups of the diol take part in this reaction.
it
For this reason,
would appear that amide groups are produced as the major cross-
Some additional polymerization may also take place
when maleic anhydride is employed as the reactant.
Use. These new resins have interesting properties that should
linking reaction.
result in technical applications.
166
H NR(OH)
2
AMINO ALCOHOLS
2-Amino-2-methyl-l,3-propanediol
CH,
Y
-OCH 2 ~C-CH 2 OCCH=CHC-
v/-
if
HOCH 2 -C-CH 2OH-
NH
Nil
i-o
CII
!H
C=0
Maleic
anhydride
Poly-2-muleamyl-2-methyl-l,3-propylene
maleate
2-Amino-2-methyl-l,3propanediol
Procedure.
mixture of 10.8
g.
of 2-amino-2-methyl-l,3-propanediol
of malcic anhydride
is
and 15.8
heated to 100 to 116
g.
and held
at this temperature for 15 minutes. This yields a balsam-like resin,
will set to a gel if the heating is continued until 66.5% of the
which
theoretical
amount
of
water has been collected.
Reference
Sprung,
M.
M., /.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 61, 3381 (1939).
167
H
2
NITROALKYLSUCCINIC ESTERS
NR9H(OR
)2
Dimethyl (l-nitroethyl)succinate
Primary and secondary nitroparaffins have labile hydrogen atoms.
Hence they might be expected to react with maleates by adding at
the alpha carbon to saturate the C:C bond of the maleyl group, such
as occurs with benzoylacrylates.
The structure of these nitroalkylsuccinates has not yet been confirmed.
German report suggests that they can be caused to under-
go reductive ring-closure, similar to y-nitropimelates, to form in this
case pyrrolidone derivatives. This, however, has not yet been verified,
and no experimental
details are given
upon which
to pass
upon the
claims.
Dimethyl (l-nitroethyl)succinate is a colorless liquid that boils
It has a specific
at 141 to 143 under 5 mm. pressure.
at
1.225
and
a
refractive
index
at 24 and
of
of
1.4480
24,
gravity
when pure
1.4531 at 10.5.
Use.
It
would appear that these compounds
offer
number
of
interesting possibilities for organic synthesis, since they contain, be-
two ester groupings. Similar types of products
have been suggested for use in plastic compositions, as insecticides,
and as intermediates for preparing ainino acids, alcohols, esters, and
amides in the synthesis of resins, plasticiz-ers, and drugs.
sides a nitro group,
168
RN0
NITROPARAFFINS
Nitroethane
\|
c-*
all
tion.
C COCH,
HC COCHa
H
II
II
Dimethyl maleate
To 500
II
II
>
II
>>
Dimethyl (l-nitroethyl)-succinate
ml. of methanol
is
agitation is continued for 30 minutes. The mixture is then
warm to 20 to 25 and held at this temperature while
The
g. of
HO
added 23 g. of sodium.
the sodium has reacted the methoxide solution is cooled to
and 130 ml. of nitroethane is added slowly with good agita-
allowed to
144
C COCH,
H->
Procedure.
10 to 15
CH,
C COCH, NaOCHa
/\
Nitroethane
When
CH,
dimethyl maleate is added from the dropping funnel over a
The mixture is cooled to 10 to 15, and 62 ml.
period of 2 hours.
is added, agitated for an additional 15 minutes,
and poured into a mixture of ice water and 100 g. of sodium bicarbonate. The aqueous solution is extracted with four portions of 200
ml. of ether, and the extracts are dried over 50 g. of anhydrous sodium
of glacial acetic acid
sulfate.
red-colored
oil is
obtained from the combined extracts.
This
is
under 20 mm.
freed of low-boiling constituents by distilling to 80
The pressure is reduced to 5 mm., and the fraction boiling
of pressure.
at 146 to 150.5
is
This
collected.
is
The
column at the same pressure.
then redistilled from a
yield
is
59%
Widmer
of theory.
References
Seigle, L.
New
W.,
Corp.,
Products Report, National Aniline Division, Allied Chemical and
New York
(1946)
C/.
Hopff and von Schichk, U. S. Dept. Com. OPB RepL PB169 (1946).
Kohler, E. P., and Engelbrecht, H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 41, 769 (1919).
Leonard, N.
Leonard, N.
Leonard, N.
J.,
J.,
J.,
and Beck, K. M., ,/. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 2504 (1948).
Hruda, L. R., and Long, F. W., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 690 (1947).
and Shoemaker, G. L., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 71, 1876 (1949).
U. S. 2,342,119;, 2,390,918 ;;2,554,831.
169
Dye
CHAPTER
6
Compounds Containing Oxygen
Reactions of oxygen-containing substances with maleyl compounds
and varied as those with the nitrogen reactants de-
are as unusual
scribed in the last chapter.
This is exemplified, for example, by the reaction with compounds
containing hydroxyl groups. Water and hydrogen peroxide add to
the ethylene bond of maleic acid, as might be expected, to form malic
and tartaric acids, respectively. Aliphatic alcohols add to the double
bond to form ethers when sodium or strongly alkaline catalysts are
Since the sodium alkoxide is used, this reaction is described
present.
in
Chapter
4,
page
65.
In the
or acids, they yield only the esters.
presence
Phenol,
of
dehydrating
agents
when catalyzed with a
few drops of sulfuric acid, forms an asymmetric-disubstituted anhydride similar in structure to phenolphthalein through replacement of
the oxygen of one of the carbonyl groups with two hydroxyphenyl
groups.
p-Cresol, however, undergoes an oxidation reaction with sulwith maleic anhydride to form the
furic acid, in its condensation
cyclic
methylcoumarin.
/Mer-Butyl-6-hydroxy-5-methylbenzyl
al-
cohol undergoes condensation by splitting off water to yield a heteroAllylarylcarbinols react
cyclic substituted chromandicarboxylic acid.
as if water were lost to the anhydride with the formation of a
This last reaction is a convenient means of preparing the
Diels-Alder adducts of the 1-arylbutadienes, which polymerize too
rapidly to yield any appreciable amount of the adduct.
butadiene.
A number of interesting modifications of the Diels-Alder synthesis
are also included in this chapter. Furan, unlike its imino analog,
pyrrole, combines with maleic anhydride as if it were a simple cyclic
conjugated hydrocarbon.
Ketene acetals could be looked upon as
170
behaving in the same manner, if it were assumed that the acetal undergoes a dimeric condensation before reacting with maleic anhydride.
Abietates with conjugated unsaturated groups in different rings do not
react with maleic anhydride until isomerization occurs. Propenylphenyl ethers react like vinyl aromatic hydrocarbons, but the reaction
accompanied by the formation of large amounts of copolymers.
p-Methoxyarylethylenes add two moles of maleic anhydride as if they
were cyclic tetraenes, but no reaction occurs if the methoxy group
Similar bis-adducts are formed in the reacis in the ortho position.
is
tion with anethole.
a-Pyrone-type compounds, such as methyl coumalate, however, lose
a mole of carbon dioxide in producing bis-adducts such as methyl
bicyclo [2.2.2] -7-octene-2,3,5,6,7-pentacarboxylic dianhydride. Bimolecular alkyl anhydroacetone benzils dissociate to give the cyclopentadienone, which then adds two moles of maleic anhydride by splitting
off
carbon monoxide.
Other intriguing reactions of oxygen compounds with maleates include that of benzoyl peroxide, which forms small amounts of phenyl-
Ozone at low temperatures in organic solvents produces
ozonides, but in water reacts only as an oxidizing agent. Peracids,
in contrast, are non-reactive.
Mixtures of carbon monoxide and
succinates.
hydrogen
in the presence of a cobalt catalyst
cinates.
171
produce a-formylsuc-
IIYDROXYSUCCINIC ACIDS
HOQR(OH)
Malic^Acid
The di-malic
acid obtained commercially from this preparation
occurs as colorless crystals that melt at 127 to 128.5. It has a den-
The acid is very soluble in water, acetone, and
of 1.601.
sity, d|
alcohol but only slightly soluble in ether. It is readily resolved into
,
the optical isomers
and
is
The
by the usual methods.
It is the
only slightly soluble in alcohol.
The
ent of
many
253.
The dimethyl
fruits.
diethyl ester
ester boils at
is
242.
/-acid melts at 100
major acid constitu-
a colorless liquid boiling at
The normal
but the acid salts crystallize well.
Uses. di-Malic acid has many different uses.
of high-bond-strength glues.
flavoring,
It is
and as a preservative
pectin extracts, ice
creams,
recommended
salts deliquesce,
It is
an ingredient
widely used as an acidulent, as
in bottled soft drinks, candy, jellies,
ices, gelatin
powders, and desserts.
It is
and raspberry jellies. It
particularly
has also been employed as an ingredient in dentifrices and mouthwashes; and an electrolyte for condensers and lightning arresters; as
an impregnant for radio condensers; as a dispersing agent for borax
in fire-retardent finishes and emulsions; as a pigment dispersant in
alkyd enamels; as an anti-gelling agent in jellied fuels; as an ingredient in electrolytes for the oxidation of aluminum and in a hydrolysis
for pear, apple,
bath for cellulose acetate.
It is also used as a reagent in the
manu-
facture of certain phenolic resins, shellac substitutes, and special alkyd
resins for electrical insulation.
Copper salts are used to kill fungus
spores.
The sodium
salt is incorporated in
pharmaceuticals as a com-
pounding and dispensing agent and as a therapeutic agent.
used as a condiment by those who cannot use common salt.
is used in effervescent salts and laxatives.
Malic acid
variety
of
It
is
also
The
acid
also a very valuable intermediate in the synthesis of a
compounds, such as coumarin, dithiocarbethoxysuccinic
is
acid, mercaptosuccinic acids, coumalic acid, a-hydroxyethoxysuccinic
acid y-lactone, polymalates, nitrosuccinic acid, oxalacetic acid, and
phenylpyrazolonecarboxylic acids.
172
WATER
Water
HO
HCC
HC COH
H->
H0~
HO
HOC CH
A
Water
>
Fumaric acid
-f
OH
CO-OH
dJ-Malic acid
An aqueous solution containing 18% of fumaric acid
placed in a corrosion-resistant pressure vessel. The contents are
carefully heated to 186 and held at this temperature for 20 hours.
The reacted mixture is then cooled to 25, and the bulk of the
Procedure.
is
unreacted fumaric acid is removed by filtration.
The malic acid is recovered by evaporation of the
fied
by
retical
fractional crystallization.
The
yield
is
and puriof the theo-
filtrate
70.5%
amount.
References
M., and Downs, C. R., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 44, 1118 (1922). Cf.:
Weiss,
Fenton, H. J., and Jones, H. O., J. Chem. Soc. 77, 77 (1900).
Gregory, T. C., Uses and Applications of Chemicals and Related Materials, Rheinhold
J.
Publishing Corp., 2 vols. (1939-1944).
B., Ber. 58B, 1822 (1925).
Jungfleisch, E., Bull. soc. chim. France 30, 147 (1878).
Holmberg,
Lachman,
Am. Chem.
A., J.
Soc. 43, 2084 (1921).
Lloyd, F., Ann. 192, 80 (1878).
Meldrum, A. N., and Bhatt, D. M., /. Univ.
Bombay
3,
149 (1934); C. A. 29,47346
(1935).
Murty, N. N., Plastics (London) 9, 585 (1945).
Niuewland, J. A., Vogt, R. R., and Foohey, W. L., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 52, 1018 (1930).
Pictet, A., Ber. 14, 2648 (1881).
022. chim. ital. 26 (I), 431 (1896).
Piutti, A., and Giustiniani, E.,
Ruhemann, S., and Hemmy, B. A., J. Chem. Soc. 71, 334 (1897).
Skraup, Z. H., Monatsh. 12, 107 (1891); 14, 501 (1893).
Tanatar, S., /. Russ. Chem. Soc. 22, 310 (1892); ,/. Chem. Soc. 62, 1305 (1892); Ber.
27, 1365 (1894); Ann. 273, 31 (1893).
van't Hoff, H. J. Ber. 18, 2713 (1885).
von Pechmann, H., Ann. 264, 272 (1891).
Walden, P., Ber. 32, 2706 (1899).
Wislicenus, W., Ann. 246, 306 (1888).
T
Yorston, F. H., Rec.
trav.
chim. 46, 711 (1927).
U.S. 1,245,976; 1,245,984; 1,275,275; 1,280,862; 1,385,525; 1,412,514; 1,413,144;
1,413,145;
1,421,604;
1,424,137;
1,427,903;
1,489,744;
1,516,206;
1,491,465;
1,918,804;
1,891,345;
1,965,682;
1,965,683;
1,965,684;
1,994,213;
2,372,643;
Brit. 395,894; 396,354; 403,401; 407,914; 421,989; 435,272.
2,381,487; 2,382,313.
173
SIMPLE ESTERS
9H(OR) 2
Diethyl Fumarate
Many esters of maleic and furaaric acids have been prepared by
methods similar to the one described on the opposite page. When
hydrochloric acid is used as the catalyst, isomerization occurs, and
is invariably the fumarate.
Esters may also be
the
silver salts to react with alkyl iodides.
This
prepared by allowing
latter method, however, is not suitable for isopropyl, amyl, or higher
the resulting product
molecular-weight esters. Diesters have also been synthesized from
fumaryl chloride and alcohols, by refluxing dibromosuccinic esters
with pyridine, and by ester interchange.
The half or acid esters may be produced by partial hydrolysis of
the above diesters, with a calculated amount of potassium hydroxide.
Methyl acid maleate has been made by refluxing maleic anhydride
with an equivalent amount of absolute methanol.
Diethyl maleate is a colorless liquid with a characteristic pungent,
violet odor.
It boils when very pure at 225, 6 19 99.
Use. These simple esters are common reactants for carrying out
many of the reactions of the maleyl bond, as has already been seen.
They also have numerous other uses. Active diamyl maleate, for
example, is employed as an insecticide, and dialkyl esters as plasticizers for cellulose derivatives.
Unsaturated alkyl esters are used as
solvents, plasticizers,
and as reactants
copolymers.
174
for the
manufacture of various
MONOHYDRIC ALCOHOLS
ROH
Ethanol
HC-ClOH HlOCA H
+
2 0|H
HO]C-CH
HC
6
S0
HC-COC.H,
4>
H C OC-CH
6
.4
Fumario acid
+ Ethanol
>
Diethyl fumarate
Procedure. Three moles (348 g.) of fumaric acid is added to
350 ml. of 96% ethyl alcohol containing 15 ml. of concentrated sulfuric
acid.
The mixture is heated slowly to 110, during which time
200 ml. of a mixture of alcohol and the water that forms continuously
distills from the flask.
Alcohol vapors are then passed into the reaction mixture at such a rate as to maintain the mixture at 115 to 120.
After 2 hours approximately 910 ml. of distillate is collected. The
reaction upon cooling is neutralized with an aqueous sodium carbonate
The ester layer is separated, and the aqueous layer is
extracted with benzene. The benzene extract is then added to the
solution.
ester,
and the two are fractionally
distilled at
normal pressures.
The
the portion boiling at 223 to 225. A yield of SQJb
pure product
of theory is obtained in this way.
This yield may be increased to
where
desired
ml.
of toluene to the reaction mix720
96%
by adding
is
ture and distilling off the ternary mixture of alcohol, water, and hydrocarbon. Numerous other modifications have also been employed.
References
Corson, B. B., Adams, E., and Scott, R. W., Org. Syn. 10, 48 (1930). C/.:
Borglin, J. N., Ind. Eng. Chem. 28, 35 (1936).
de Wolf, J., and van de Straete, L., Bull, daaee act. Acad. roy. Belg. 21, 216 (1935).
Eddy, G. W., and Carson, N. B., J. Econ. Entomol. 41, 31 (1948).
Gordon, P. L., and Aronowitz, R., Ind. Eng, Chem. 37, 780 (1945).
I. G. Farbenindustrie (Lab. reports by Piepenbrink), U.S. Dept. Com. O.T.S. Rept. PB73887, frames
6942-6944.
Lecat, M., Compt. rend. 222, 733 (1946)
Lewis, F. M., and Mayo, F. R., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 1533 (1948).
Lovelock, J. E., Nature 156, 782 (1944).
Mayer, E. L., Tally, F. B., and Woodward, C. F., U.S. Dept. Agr., Bur. Ent., Plant Qwirantin*
E-709 (1946).
soc. chim. 4 (5), 1661 (1937).
Chem. 59, 739 (1891).
M. K., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 1457 (1947).
Micovic, V. M., Butt.
Shields, J., J. Soc.
Siegel,
E. F., and Moran,
U.S. 2,127,660; 2,295,513; 2,363,501; 2,368,765; 2,378,833; 2,394,512; 2,404,103: 2,411,136: 2,411,148,
Ger. 547,384.
Brit. 572,455.
175
.ORO
POLYESTERS
<
XORO-1
Glycol Maleate Polyester
The white amorphous
88 to 95.
solid obtained in this preparation melts at
similar product of m.p. 90 to 92
maleate and ethylene bromide.
has been prepared
When
dried under partial
insoluble
the
solid
an
infusible
material.
pressure,
amorphous
yields
Use. Although these pure products are only laboratory curiosities,
from
the
silver
method given
in the
for their preparation is extensively used by industry
manufacture of various modifications of glycol maleate polyes-
Excessive polymerization such as undoubtedly occurs here is
easily controlled by carrying out this reaction in the presence of drying
ter.
The maleic resins so prooils, fatty acids, and other modifying agents.
duced are extensively used in coating materials for all types of purThese polyesters may be copolymerized with other unsaturated
poses.
substances to yield other useful products.
Mannitol sorbitol maleate polyesters have been suggested for sizing
1,9-Nonanediol bis (acid maleates) have been condensed
amines
for producing de-emulsifying agents for crude oil.
with various
textile yarns.
Cellulose polymaleates have been recommended as wash-fast sizes,
as textile fibers, and as a plastic for color photographs, films, and foils.
Moldable esters may also be prepared from pentaerythritol, whereas
mixed esters with sebacic acid and 1,3-propanediol have been employed
for pressure-sensitive tapes.
The
ferrous salt of diethylene glycol
for the copolymerization of
monomaleate has been used as a catalyst
styrene with glycol fumarate. Simultaneous acetylization and esterification of polyvinyl alcohol with formaldehyde and maleic anhydride
are said to give filaments or fabrics of enhanced strength without sacrifice of softness or flexibility.
176
POLYHYDRIC ALCOHOLS
R(OH) 2
Glycol
oA-S
HOCH
+
C'
1
HOCH
H
C C O C c-~o
<
A
Maleic anhydride
Procedure.
of glycol
is
H H
-f-
Glycol maleate polyester
(rlycol
mixture of 32.5
heated to 195 to 200
reduced to 0.2
g.
of maleic
for 4 hours.
anhydride and 18.6 g.
The pressure is then
mm. and
additional 3 hours.
the heating continued at 210 to 215 for an
The residue while still warm is dissolved in eth-
ylene chloride and filtered. The product separates as an oil, which
changes to a white powder in 2 hours when kept at 5 to 10.
References
W. H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 51, 2560 (1929). <?/.:
de Buigne, J., Rev. prod. Mm. 41, 65 (1944).
Gardner, W. H., Encyclopedia of Chem. Technol. 1, 517 (1947).
Gibello, H., Peintures, pigments, vernis 22, 245 (1946).
Hermann, F. J., Centraal Inst. Materiaal Onderzoek Afdel. Verf Circ. 35,
41, 7137a (1947).
Kienle, R. H. and Petke, F. E., /. Am. Chem. ,Soc. 62, 1053 (1940).
Rowland, C. S., Interchem. Rev. 5, 83 (1946).
Tsuzuki, Y., Bull. Chem. Soc. Japan 10, 17 (1935).
Vincent, H. L., Ind. Eng. Chem. 29, 1267 (1937).
Vorlander, D., Ann. 280 191 (1894).
Car-others,
(1947); C. A.
U. S. 2,067,862; 2,357,933; 2,369,818; 2,370,962; 2,371,429;
2,373,527;
2,375,529;
2,381,116; 2,384,080; 2,413,275; 2,426,994; 2,427,255; 2,445,553; 2,454,210.
177
DIHYDROXYSUCCINIC ACIDS
(HO) 2 9R(OH) 2
Tartaric Acid
Mesotartaric acid from this reaction occurs as rectangular tablets
that melt with the formation of the anhydride at 140. The acid is
very soluble in water, quite soluble in alcohol, but only slightly soluble
The diethyl ester melts at 53.5 to 55. The dZ-acid in
contrast loses water at 100, forming an anhydride melting at 204 to
206. It occurs as monoclinic crystals. The diethyl ester of the
in ether.
d- and di-acid melts at 17
The
ester of the Z-acid boils
to a liquid that boils at
under 19 mm. at 162.
280;
6 15 170.
Use. Tartaric acid is employed as a fungicide for feeds, as an
acidulent in beverages, and as a clarifying agent for beer. It is also
used to increase the plasticity of mortar, as a material in marking
ceramics, and as an ingredient in dry batteries, condensers, and electroIt is employed in dyeing, in the silvering
lytes for lightning arresters.
of mirrors and electric lamps, in fire extinguishers, in the bleaching of
and in baking powder. It has been described as a peptizing
agent for pectin, as a preservative for dried fruits, as an agent for
treating yeast. It may be used as a gelating agent for solid methanol
fuels, as a disintegrating agent for certain insecticides, and as a laundry sour. It has also been recommended in etching, tin plating, coloring metals, flotation of ores, cleaning of aluminum, hat sizing, metal
It may be used in paint
polishing, and artificial teeth cleaning.
removers and in the manufacture of blueprint and photopapers, synthetic rubber, artificial stone, and Pharmaceuticals.
In addition, it
has been suggested as a coagulant of latex, as a liberant for bleach,
flour,
and as an agent for sugar refining, silk dyeing, and calico printing.
Esters have been used as plasticizers in lacquer.
be employed as a reagent in the manufacture of adrenalin, flavanthrene, iron and nickel catalysts, sulfur dioxide, opium
extracts, Z-2-amino-l-m-hydroxyphenyl-l-propanol, apple oil, toka
bean extract, vanilla bean extracts, detergents, and medicinals such
It also
may
as sulfonal.
178
PEROXIDES
Hydrogen Peroxide
O
C COC H
H O-
(HsOsCOH
HO-C-- COC H
Oa0 4
HO C COC H
CCOCaHfi
Hydrogen peroxide] + Diethyl|maleate
>
Diethyl meso-t&rtr&ie
Procedure* An anhydrous solution of hydrogen peroxide in tertbutyl alcohol is first prepared from 100 ml. of a 30% aqueous solution
of the peroxide, according to the directions given in J. Amer. Chem. Soc.
61, 1844 (1939).
This solution is diluted with the anhydrous solvent to give a 5.95%
solution of hydrogen peroxide, and 8.6 g. of diethyl maleate is added
to
The new
it.
tetroxide
is
solution
added.
The
is
cooled to
0, and
reaction mixture
is
1.5
ml. of
allowed to
warm
osmium
room
to
temperature, and is then set aside for two days. The solvent is disand the residue fractionally distilled under approximately
18 mm. of pressure.
(There is no mention as to whether peroxides are
a hazard in this distillation.) The viscous portion, 6 18 162-166, is
saved and allowed to crystallize from ether. The pure product is the
ester of weso-tartaric acid.
This, upon saponification in the usual
the
desired
acid.
manner, yields
The dJ-acid has also been obtained by this method from diethyl
fumarate. Other oxidizing agents, such as chlorates and permanganates, may also be used, Maleic anhydride, however, does not react
with peracids. Tartaric acids may also be prepared from the dibrotilled off,
mosuccinic acid with moist silver oxide, and by the hydrolysis of
a-hydroxyglyoxylonitrile, or by the oxidation of mannitol with nitric
acid.
References
S., and Mason, H. 8., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 61, 1844 (1939); 58, 1302 (1936);
59,2345(1937). C/.:
Braun, G., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 51, 228 (1929).
Glaus, A., Ber. 10, 928 (1877).
Gregory, T. C., Uses and Applications of Chemicals and Related Materials, Reinhold Publishing
Corp., New York.
Hatcher, W. H., and Mueller, W. H., Can. J. Research 3, 291 (1930).
Kekule A., and Anschutz, R., Ber. 13, 2150 (1881).
Milas, N. A., and Terry, E. M., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 47, 1412 (1925)
Swern, D., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 1692 (1947).
Milas, N. A., Sussman,
U.S. 2,371,097.
179
MALEINS
CH=-CH
C
HO
-o-o
Phenol in alein
Maleic and succinic anhydrides combine with hydroxy aromatic
in the same manner as phthalic anhydride.
The products
are similar to the phthaleins, both in structure and in many of their
Resorcinols and w-aminophenols in a like fashion yield
properties.
compounds
compounds corresponding to fluoresceins and rhodamines. The
maleins are more highly colored than the succeins because of the
unsaturated ethylene bond. These dyes crystallize with one mole of
water, which can only be removed by heating for 6 to 7 hours in an
air oven.
Like the phthaleins, four moles of bromine may be sub-
The ethylene bond
add bromine under these conditions, as shown
by the absorption maxima of the brominated product. Compounds
stituted in the aromatic ring of the molecule.
of the maleins does not
such as resorcinolthol-
m-aminophenolby this method.
Bromosuccinic acids
,
o-cresol2-naphhave
been prepared
phenylenediaminemaleins
pyrocatechol,
pyrogallol-
be used in place of maleic anhydride.
Unlike maleic anhydride, they do not require an added catalyst. The
hydrobromic acid split off during the reaction in this case serves to
may
Dibromosuccinic acid, in contrast, gives a
an
dye containing
acetylene group in place of the ethylene bond in
effect the condensation.
the phenolmalein.
Purified phenolmalein
is a light-colored brown powder melting at
and
at
195
170. Methanol and ethanol solutions of it
blackening
are brown, whereas the acetone solution is a deep red. Addition of
alkali changes the color to a bright pink.
Phenolmalein is insoluble
in chloroform, benzene, and petroleum ether.
Use. These dyes are valuable for certain special uses, such as
adsorption indicators in argentometry and the like.
180
PHENOLS
ArOH
Phenol
O\
/s
x o =|
c=o
Phenol
f-
C
/
Phenolm&lein
Maleic anhydride
Procedure. A few drops of concentrated sulfuric acid is carefully
added to a mixture of 5 g. of phenol and 3 g. of maleic anhydride.
The reaction mixture is cautiously heated to 125 to 135, and agitated
for 10 hours at this temperature.
Upon cooling below 100, the mixture
is
remove any unreacted phenol, and the residue
and thoroughly extracted with a dilute ammonium hydroxsolution.
From this extract, the crude product is obtained by
is
steam-distilled to
collected
ide
It is purified by
careful precipitation with dilute hydrochloric acid.
treating a boiling alcohol solution of it with animal charcoal. After
is removed, the purified dye is recovered as a fine
precipitation with acidulated water, collected, and dried.
the charcoal
by
powder
References
N. D., and Tewari, J. D., Proc. Indian Acad. Set. 13A, 68 (1941).
and Pope, F. G., J. Chem. Soc. 123, 2934 (1923).
Burckhardt, R., Ber. 18, 2864 (1885).
Dutt, S., /. Chem. /Soc. 1926, 1138.
Dutt, S., and Thorpe, J. F., J. Chem. Soc. 125, 2524 (1924).
Lunge, G. and Burckhardt, R., Ber. 17, 1598 (1884).
Mehrotra, R. C. Tewari, R. D. and Dube, H. L. /. Indian Chem. Soc.
Dass,
I.
Cf.:
Briggs, S.,
24, 165 (1947);
Current Sci. (India) 16, 119 (1947).
Rao, N. V. C., Seshadri, T. R., and Venkateswarlu, V., Proc. Indian Acad. Sci. 26A, 299
(1947).
Tewari,
J.
D., Proc. Indian Acad. Sci. 1929, 1642.
181
COUMARINS
6-Methylcoumarin
Maleic and fumaric acids react with p-cresol at elevated temperatures in the presence of concentrated sulfuric acid by undergoing
oxidation, decarboxylation, dehydration, and cyclization to form
6-methylcoumarin.
The unsaturated C:C bond
of the
maleyl com-
unaffected by the reaction.
pound
6-Methylcoumarin melts at 73 to
is
give a dibromide melting at 65 to
189 to 190.
74. It may be brominated to
66. The mercurichloride melts at
The method is a relatively simple one for preparing certain other
substituted coumarins.
Use.
The coumarins
are well
known
as antioxidants.
182
as perfume ingredients
and
CRESOLS
p-Cresol
H,C
p-Crcsol 4- Maleic acid -f
Sulfurio acid
6-Mothylcoumarin
Procedure. To a 72% solution of sulfuric acid is added 10.8 g.
and 116 g. of maleic or fumaric acid. This mixture is
then carefully heated to 160, with constant agitation, and held at
160 to 180 for 2 hours. During this time there is an evolution of
carbon dioxide and sulfur dioxide. When this is complete, the reaction
mixture is allowed to cool and is then poured onto chopped ice, yielding a tarry black mass. The coumarin is extracted from this mass
with alcohol. The alcoholic extract is decolorized with charcoal, and
the 6-methylcoumarin is obtained from it as a white flocculate by pourof p-cresol
ing the solution onto chopped
ice.
The
yield
is
80%
of theory.
References
Thompson, T.
J.,
and Edec, R. H.,
J.
Am. Chem.
Ger. 338,737.
183
Soc. 47, 2557 (1925).
Cf.i
HETEROPOLYCYCLIC ACIDS
6-tert-Butyl-8-methyl-2,3-chromandicarboxylic Acid
Hydroxybenzyl alcohols react with maleates to saturate the olefin
bond of the maleate by forming the heterocyclic chromandicarboxylic
the one produced directly. The cis-acid
may
by converting the trans-acid to the anhydride
with acetic anhydride, and then treating the resulting anhydride with
dilute alkali.
The reaction appears to be a general one for preparing
acids.
The
rcws-acid
be obtained from
is
it
substituted chromandicarboxylic acids.
irans-6-^eri-Butyl-8-methyl-2,3-chromandicarboxylic acid is a crys245. The cw-acid melts at 222.
talline solid that melts at
The preparation is particularly interesting in illustrating the
compounds that may be formed from hydroxybenzyl alcohols
the preparation of maleic alkyd-phenolic resins. These compounds
Use,
type of
in
should be valuable modifying agents in the preparation of such resins.
reactions suggest how new maleic types may be prepared.
The
184
o-HYDROXYBENZYL ALCOHOLS
H
3-tert-Bu lyl-6-hydroxy-5-methylbenzyl Alcohol
M-c
(H 3 C) 8 C
H2 o
C-C-OC H
H
&
Diethyl rnaleate
S-terf-Butyl-G-hydroxy-J
methylbenzyl alcohol
Procedure.
(H 3 C) 3 C
mixture of 50
ylbenzyl alcohol and 175
g. of
0-/erf-Butyl-8-methyl-2,3-chromandioarboxylio acid
of 3-^6r^-butyl-6-hydroxy-5-meth-
g.
diethyl maleate
is
heated at 220.
The
is removed by distillation under reduced pressure, and
the residue saponified with 60 g. of 33% sodium hydroxide solution
for 2 hours and acidified.
The precipitated resin is dissolved in ether
unchanged ester
and shaken with sodium carbonate
mandicarboxylic acid
is
37
g.,
or
solution.
47%
Reference
Hultzseh, K., J. prakt. Chem. 158, 275 (1941).
1 85
The
of theory.
yield of the chro-
HETEROPOLYCYCLIC ADDUCTS
7-Oxabicyclo[2.2.1]-5-heptene-2,3-dicarboxylic Acid
(3,6-Epoxy-4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic Acid)
Conjugated heterocyclic dienes containing oxygen, like the furans,
and the pyrones, add maleic anhydride as if they were simple conjugated dienes (q.v.). The sulfur analogs, however, resemble benzene
and do not react with dienophiles. See diaccnaphtho [l,2-b,l',2'-d]thiophene. Pyrroles and indoles, the amino analogs, yield substituted succinic and disuccinic acids by adding maleic anhydride at the
carbon atoms alpha to the nitrogen atom, provided that these groups
are not substituted.
Furan gives the triphenyl phosphine
test for quinones.
The
addi-
tion of maleic anhydride may thus be looked upon as resembling the
type of addition expected with aromatic quinones.
7-Oxabicyclo [2.2.1 ] -5-heptene-2,3-dicarboxylic acid
the monohydrate that sinters at 95. At 103 to 105
is
obtained as
loses water
form the anhydrous acid that remelts at 135. The monohydrate
forms large, clear crystals that are easily soluble in warm water.
Hypobromous acid can be added to the unsaturated bond of this
epoxy adduct to form the bromolactone acid.
Use. These compounds offer several possibilities for organic synAdducts have been prepared from a number of furan derivatheses.
it
to
2-isopropyl-5-methylfuran,
compound, instead of
in
this
carbons
as
at
the
preparation, adds maleic
2,5-furan
adding
what
is
to
give
proba'bly
3a,4,5,6-tetrahydro-4,5-benzofurananhydride
tives,
including
,2-diphenylbenzof uran,
The
2-vinylfuran, and 2-furylethylene.
last
dicarboxylic anhydride:
H
O
/ \ C/ \CH
HC
2
C-
\H/H
C
186
CONJUGATED HETEROCYCLIC DIENES
Furan
H
C
HC
HC
COM
C COH
\1
H
Furan
>
Maleic acid
)xat
7-Oxabicyclo[2.2.11ylu acid
5-heptene-2,3-dicarboxylio
.
Procedure. A solution of maleic acid is prepared by dissolving
60 g. of maleic anhydride in 150 ml. of water. Thirty ml. of furan is
then added to this solution at a temperature not exceeding 20, and
the mixture is vigorously agitated for 3 days, during' which time the
furan completely dissolves. The adduct is recovered in the usual
manner and is purified by dissolving it at 60 to 65 in three times
its weight of water.
Complete solution is usually, obtained in about
45 minutes. The aqueous solution is then allowed to evaporate
slowly, depositing large crystals of the monohydrate.
References
Diels, O., Alder, K., Nienburg, H., and Schmalbeck, 0.,
Butz, L. W., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 57, 1314 (1935).
Ann. 490, 247 (1931).
and Mailer, K., Ann. 490, 257 (1931).
Chem. 6, 566 (1941).
Herz, W., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 67, 1854 (1945).
Nazarov, I. N., and Nagibina, T. D., Bull. acad. sci. (USSR), Classe
Cf.i
Diels, O., Alder, K.,
Fried,
J.,
and
Elderfield, R. C., J. Org.
C.A.
Paul, R., Butt. soc.
7736e (1948).
chim. France
Woodward, R.
and Baer,
641;
U.
42,
B.,
10,
H.,./.
163 (1943).
Am. Chem.
Soc. 70, 1161 (1948).
S. 2,406,657; 2,432,890; 2,433,645; 2,437,955,
187
sci.
Mm.
1046,
ETHERS OF DIHYDROPHTHALIC
ANHYDRIDE
3,5-Diethoxy-2,4-cyclohexadiene-l,4-dicarboxylic Anhydride
(3,5-Diethoxy-l,6-dihydrophtlialic Anhydride)
This reaction of maleic anhydride with a 2,2-bis-ether substituted
ethylene is unique in several respects. Both addition and condensation take place during this reaction.
Two
moles of acetal are involved
that result in the formation of a cyclic diene dicarboxylic anhydride.
3,5-Diethoxy-2,4-cyclohexadiene-l,4-dicarboxylic anhydride occurs
as fine yellow crystals that melt at 110 to 111
when
recrystallized
from xylene.
This anhydride can react with an additional mole of maleic anhydride in benzene solution to form 1,5-diethoxybicyclo [2.2.2] -5-octene3,4,7 ,8-tetracarboxylic
dianhydride by addition in the usual manner of
the anyhdride across the diene structure of the alicyclic ring.
Use. The reactive groups in these anhydrides make them especially
interesting for synthetic work.
188
H C=C(OR)
2
KETENE ACETALS
Ketene Diethvlacetal
HC
5
H-/VI.\
ILC,0-C
H
Ketene diethylacetal
-f
Maleic
anhydride
3,5-piethoxy-2,4-cyclohexadiene- 1 ,4-dicarboxylic
anhydride
Procedure.
To
a solution of 4.9
maleic anhydride in 75 ml,
g. of
The reaction
of dry ether is added 11.6 g. of ketene diethylacetal.
mixture rapidly takes on a yellow, then red color, and the solution
starts to boil within 2 minutes.
the vigorous reaction subsides,
vessel.
The yellow
washed with dry
Whereupon,
it is
it is
cooled.
formed is collected upon a filter,
and recrystallized from xylene. The yield is
precipitate
ether,
of theory.
Reference
McElvain,
S.
As soon as
set aside for 12 hours in a closed
M., and Cohen, H., J. Am. Chem.
189
Soc.
64,
260 (1942).
HC
a
ALKENEPOLYCARBOXYLIC
CO.H
ACIDS
H,
H
H(CH S3'2
).
H,C
Methyl 4,4a,4b,5,6,7,8,8a,9,10-Decahydro-2-isopropyl-4b,8dimethyl-3,10a(3)-ethanophenanthrene-8,ll,12-tricarboxylic
Anhydride
Unlike chain conjugated dienes, or cyclic conjugated dienes containing both unsaturated groups in the same ring, abietic acid and abietates do not react with maleic
anhydride at temperatures below 100. When heated with the anhydride above
this temperature, the abietates isomerize to the levopimarates, which add the anhydride readily. Hence the adduct may also be prepared from pure levopimaric
acid, or directly from rosin by heating the pine oleoresin with the anhydride.
The adduct obtained from methyl abietate melts at 214 to 215. It has a ()D of
26. It is readily soluble in chloroform, methyl alcohol, acetone, and ether.
Although the adduct contains an unsaturated bond, it does not absorb bromine
from a chloroform solution of the halogen. No yellow color is obtained with tetranitromethane in the same solvent, nor is methane obtained from the micro-Zerewitinoff
The tribasic acid obtained from it melts at 227 and shows a ()D of
reaction.
250. The trimethyl ester prepared from this acid decomposes at 113. It has a
4 8
dlof 1.084, and 7iJ> of 1.4869. These derivatives are identical with those prepared
from levopimaric acid and from rosin.
Use. Very extensive use is made commercially of this type of reaction in the
manufacture of modified rosins, ester gums, and maleic alkyds. These resins give
improved gloss, rate of drying, and hardness to paint and varnish films. The maleic
anhydride adduct of stearyl abietate has been recommended as a rust-inhibiting
'
agent.
This type of reaction has been widely used in the elucidation of the structure
sterols
and
of various resin acids.
190
POLYCYCLIC DIENECARBOXYLIC
ACIDS
H
CIKCHJ,
3/2
H,C
H,
Melhyl Abietate
HjC
Methyl abietate
>
pO,CH,
Methyl lovopimarate
C02CII S
'
H.V.
>
Mnthyl
4,4a,4b,5,6,7,8,8a,9,10-
decahydrO"2-isopropyl-4b,8dimothyl-3, 10a(3)-ethanophenanthrene-8, 11,1 2-tricarboxy 1 io
anhydride
A mixture of 79 g. of methyl abietate and 25 g. of maleic anhydride
heated for 8 hours at 160. The resulting reaction mixture is then thoroughly
extracted with hot petroleum ether to remove all ,the unreactcd constituents, leavThe acid is
ing a pure crystalline product from which the acid may be obtained.
obtained by saponification with 0.5 AT aqueous potassium hydroxide.
Procedure.
is
References
Ruzicka, L., Ankeremit, P. G., and Frank, B., HAv. Chim. Acta 15, 1289 (1932). C/.:
Arbuzov, B., J. Gen. Chem. (USSR) 2, 806 (1932).
Armitage, F. and Cottrell, J. A., Paint Technol. 13, 133 (1948).
Fieser, L. F. f and Campbell, W. P., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 60, 162 (1938).
Gardner, W. H. f Encyclopedia of Chem. Tech. I, 526 (1947).
Gee, G., and Rideal, E. K., Proc. Roy. Soc. (London) A1S3, 116 (1935).
Graff, M. M., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 68, 1937 (1946).
Harris, G. C., and Sanderson, T. t /. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 334 (1948).
Hicks, E. M., Jr., Berg, C. J., and Wallis, E. 8., /. Biol. Chem. 162, 645 (1946).
Levin, R. H., Weener, M. M., and Meinzer, E. M. t J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 2834 (1948).
McElvain, 8. M., and Cohen, H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 64, 260 (1942).
McKennon, F. L., Johanson, A. J., Field, E. T., and Lawrence, R. V., Ind. Eng. Chem. 41, 1296 (1949)
MorreU, R. 8., and Davis, W. R., J. Soc. Chem. Ind. 55, 261T (1936).
Rinse, J., J. Polymer Sci. 3, 371 (1948).
Ruzicka, L., Bacon, R. G. R., and Kuiper, 8., Helv. Chim. Acta 20, 1542 (1937).
Ruzicka, L., and Kaufman, 8., Hdv. Chim. Acta 23, 1346 (1940).
Ruzicka, L., Silbermann, H., and Pieth, P., Helv. Chim. Acta 15, 1285 (1932).
Wicks, Z. W., Dalv, 0. W., and Lack, H., J. Org. Chem. 12, 713 (1947).
Wienhaus, H., and Sandermann, W., Ber. 69B, 2202 (1936).
Woods, G. F., and Sanders, H., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 2926 (1947).
(
U.S. 2,025,947; 2,358,048; 2,359,980; 2,363,792; 2,376,823; 2,379,376; 2,398,668; 2,398,670; 2,409,930;
2,447,750; 2,450,358. Brit. 588,041; 592,167. Ger. 739,438.
191
iMALEINIZED OILS
IJ N
R'O 2 CR<
>9R>0
/
CI
Methyl Linoleate Adducts
anhydride reacts with the fatty ester in this preparation to
These reaction products have not been completely
separated and purified, but they have been divided into a volatile and non-volatile fracIt is necessary, therefore, to rely largely upon analytical values for a
tion, as described.
It is clear from studies of this type
picture of the possible structures of the adducts.
of reaction, and from the properties of the products, that both monomeric adducts and
copolymers are formed during this process. The first reaction, which probably produces
the volatile fraction, may involve the addition of one molecule of anhydride to a carbon
adjacent to one of the unsaturated bonds of the methyl linoleate. This step appears to be
accompanied by a shifting of the double bond, since the volatile fraction contains 12% of
conjugated reaction products.
The non-volatile fraction is probably also a mixture, in this case, of copolymers. The
observed values indicate an adduct containing three molecules of anhydride to two of the
Since substantial amounts of the monomeric adducts are formed, sufficient
fatty ester.
anhydride is left for the formation of such adducts. The dimeric structure shown fits all
the data now available. These results may readily be accounted for, as suggested by
Teeter, Geerts, and Cowan, by assuming a free-radical mechanism for the reactions.
Compare this with similar reactions described in Chapter 1.
Methyl oleate reacts with maleic anhydride under similar conditions to give a light
yellow oil that distils under 1 mm. pressure at 196 to 205. Bickford and co-workers
show this product to consist of nearly equal amounts of the four possible monoadducts:
Approximately
90%
of the
yield a complex mixture of adducts.
CH,(CH 2)eCHCH=CH(CH 2) C0 CH
2
CH (CH CH^CHCH(CH )CO CH
8
2) 7
3,
CHCO
CHCO
o
CH CO
2
CH CO
CHCH= CH (CH CO CH
2
CH (OH
2)
7(X) 2 (
'
3,
an d
,'Hi (<
!H) 7
2) 8
8,
CHCO
CHCO
CH CO
CH CO
\O
and yields of fission products.
addition of maleic anhydride to non-conjugated esters is an important reaction in the manufacture of modified drying oils for the paint and varnish industries.
Rapid drying characteristics are imparted to slower drying oils and alkyd resins by this
treatment.
as judged by analysis
Use.
The
192
R'CH=CHCH CH=-CHR"C0 R"' NON-CONJUGATED FATTY
2
ESTERS
Methyl Linoleate
CH 8
(CH 2 ) 4
CH
CH
CH 2
II
CO CO
H H
CII
CH 2
(CH 2 ) 6
COoCHo
Methyl
linoleate
+ Maleic
Mono- and Polyadduets
anhydride
A mixture of 50 g. of pure methyl linoleate and 31.4 g. of maleic anheated in an atmosphere of carbon dioxide for 7 hours at 200. The reaction
is then passed tiirough a molecular still at 107 to 124
under 0.4 to 0.8 micron
The resulting crude adducts
pressure to free the products of any uncombined reactants.
are separated into two fractions by passing them twice through a falling-film molecular
still at 157 to 162
under the same pressure. Heat is applied to both the inlet and the
outlet tubes of the still to obtain the proper flow of these highly viscous products.
A
volatile fraction weighing 12.9 g. and a non-volatile fraction of 26.0 g. are obtained in this
way. The volatile fraction is further purified by passing it through the still at 152 to
163 at 0.7 to 1.0 micron, taking a center cut of 6.7 g.
Procedure.
hydride
mixture
is
References
Teeter, H. M., Geerts, M. J., and Cowan, J. C., J. Am. Oil Chemists' Soc. 25, 158 (1948).
C/.:
Bickford, W. G., Fisher, G. S., Kyame, L., and Swift, C. E., J. Am. Oil Chemists' Soc. 25,254 (1948).
Bickford, W. G., Krauczunus, P., and Wheeler, D. H., Oil
Soap 19, 23 (1942).
Falkenburg, L. B., Teeter, H. M., Skell, P. S., and Cowan, J. C., Oil
Soap 22, 143 (1945).
Farmer, E. H., Trans. Faraday Soc. 38, 340 (1942); J. Soc. Chem. Ind. (London) 66, 86 (1947); Rubber
Chem. and Technol. 21, 27 (1948).
Farmer E. H., Koch, H. P., and Button, D. A., J. Chem. Soc. 1943, 541.
Farmer, E. H., and Sutton, D. A.,/. Chem. Soc. 1943, 119.
Gardner, W. H., Encyclopedia of Chem. Technol 1, 517 (1947).
Gunstone, F. D., and Hilditch, T. P., J. Chem. Soc. 1946, 1022.
Konen, J. C., Oil & Soap 21, 202 (1944).
Morrell, R. S., and Davis, W. R., Jr., J. Soc. Chem. Ind. 55, 101T, 65 (1936).
Payne, H. F., Caldwell, L. E., Bailey, R. H., and Schrnutzler, A. F., Am. Ink Maker 25, No. 12, 23
(1947); 26, No. 1, 28; No. 2, 27 (1948).
Ross, J., Gebhart, A. I., and Gerecht, J. F., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 68, 1373 (1946).
Ruzicka, F. C. J., Oil Colour Trades J. 144, 442 (1948).
&
&
U.S. 1,933,697; 2,188,882; 2,280,862; 2,384,595; 2,384,846; 2,385,794; 2,387,393; 2,387,395; 2,387,396;
2,396,763; 2,414,712; 2,423,230. Brit. 552,095; 565,431; 565,432; 588,018.
Note.
These formulas for the products are used purely to
Other isomers and polyadducta are undoubtedly present.
193
illustrate
the types of compounds formed.
ETHERS OF TETRAHYDRONAPHTHALENEDICARBOXYLIC ANHYDRIDE
l,2,3,4-Tetrahydro-3-methyl-6,7-methylenedioxy1,2-naphthalenedicarboxylic Anhydride
Propenylphenyl ethers react with maleic anhydride and maleates to
yield a mixture of products of which the crystalline tetrahydronaphthalenedicarboxylic acids and their anhydrides usually comprise 20 to
30%. The remainder of the product consists of copolymers of the
reactants and polymers of the propenylphenyl ether. The copolymers
are similar in structure to those obtained with other substituted ethylenes (q.v.). The mixture of products is usually a red gel or oil.
Most of the gels melt fairly sharply.
An
ether group in the p- or o-position greatly favors the addition
Thus anethole adds two moles of anhydride to
of maleic anhydride.
Maleic acid when used in place of its
the
of the normal non-aromatic type of
favors
formation
anhydride
Diels- Alder compound such as is obtained with conjugated vinylnaph-
form the tetra-acid adduct.
thalene (q.v.).
The monomeric adduct of isosafrole and maleic anhydride melts at
144 according to Bruckner, but according to Hudson and Robinson at
142 to 143. Bruckner reports the free acid as melting at 185
Hudson and Robinson report 143. The ethyl ester is a liquid, b 1<3 205210. When the anhydride is heated at elevated temperatures, dehydrogenation occurs with the formation of 3-methyl-6,7-methylenedioxy-l,2-naphthalenedicarboxylic anhydride. This compound also
results from the distillation of a mixture of the reactants.
Use. Esters of l,2,3,4-tetrahydro-3-methyl-6,7-methylenedioxy-l,
;
2-naphthalenedicarboxylic acid are effective in fly sprays when mixed
with 0.025% pyrethrum. The percentage of flies killed is more than
double the number when the active ingredient is pyrethrum alone.
The red oil obtained by allowing the maleate to react with isosafrole
may be used directly for this purpose after one extraction with petro-
leum
ether.
194
PROPENYLPHENYL ETHERS
CH=CHR
Isosafrole
H c:
2
Isosafrole -f Maleic anhydride
,2,3,4-Totrahydro-3-raethyl-
6, 7-methylcncdioxy- 1 2-naj> h,
thalencdicarboxylie anhydride
Procedure. A mixture of 37.0 g. of isosafrole and 19.6 g, of malcic
anhydride is heated upon a boiling water bath for 3 hours. The
viscous, orange-red reaction mixture is then cooled in a refrigerator
and thoroughly extracted with approximately 400 ml. of cold ethyl
The yellowish powder that is left is dried and extracted with
alcohol.
carbon
tetrachloride.
This carbon tetrachloride extract, when
boiling
cooled and allowed to evaporate, yields 12.9 g. of the 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-3-methy 1-6,7-methy lenedioxy- 1 ,2-naphthalenedicarboxylic
an-
hydride.
The
11.8
g.
tetrachloride
of insoluble residue left
consists
of
equal
from the extraction with carbon
of the two
molecular copolymers
reactants and melts at 334 to 335. The alcohol extract contains the
unreacted isosafrole, maleic anhydride, 8.4 g. of diisosafrole, and 1.8 g.
of the acid of the above anhydride.
References
Bruckner, G., Jr., Ber. 75B, 2034-2050 (1942). Cf.\
Bruckner, G., Jr., and Kovacs, J. Nature 161, 651 (1948).
Hudson, B. J. F., and Robinson, R., J. Chem. Soc. 1941, 715.
Lora Tamayo, M. L., et al., Anales fis. y quim (Spain) 36, 44 (1940); 37, 392 (1941);
39, 525 (1943); 40, 394, 808, 1178 (1944); 41, 1151, 1325 (1945); 42, 809 (1946);
Anale* real soc. espan.fls. y quim., Ser. B, 44, 223 (1948); C. A. 42, 8175a (1948)];
Nature 162, 969 (1948); Rev. real. acad. dene, exact., fis. y mat., Madrid 39, 185
(1945); C. A. 45, 5122c (1951).
Prill, E. A., and Synerholm, M. E., Contrib. Boyce Thompson Inst. 14, 221 (1946).
f
Synerholm,
Synerholm,
M.
M.
E., /.
E.,
Am. Chem.
and
Soc. 67, 345, 1229 (1945).
Hartzell, A., Contrib. Boyce
195
Thompson
Intl. 14, 81 (1945).
ARYLETHYLENE BIS-ADDUCTS
],4,4a,5,6,7-Hexahydro-2,3-dirriethoxy-8-phenyl-l,4-ethano-
naphthalene-5,6,9,10-letracarboxylic Dianhydride
The position of the methoxy substituents in 1,1 -diary lethylenes has
marked effect upon the course of their reactions with maleic anhyAs can be seen on the opposite page, addition occurs with the
dride.
a
ring containing these groups if they are in the p- or 3,4-positions.
In such cases, these 1,1 -diary lethylenes react as if they were tetraenes
by adding two moles of maleic anhydride, in contrast to re-establishing
the original aromatic ring after the addition of one mole of anhydride
by a shift of the double bond from the new ring, such as takes place
in the reaction with isosafrole (q.v.}
This directing effect of methoxy
.
similar to that of phenyl groups, but the opposite in effect
groups
to that of a p-methyl substituent in one of the rings.
If, however, the
is
methoxy group is ortho to an exocyclic double bond in
rings, no reaction occurs with maleic anhydride.
Somewhat similar bis-adducts are formed in addition
either or both
to other prod-
ucts in the reaction of maleic anhydride with anethole, with 1-meth-
oxy-4-propenylbenzene, and with l-methoxy-4-propenylnaphthalene,
but they have not been reported for the l,2-dimethoxy-4-propenylbenzene reaction. A methoxy substituent in the 6-position of a- or /3cyclopentenylnaphthylenes apparently does not affect the reactivity
of these
compounds as vinylnaphthalenes
(q.v.).
l,4,4a,5,6,7-Hexahydro-2,3-dimethoxy-8-phenyl-l,4-ethanonaphthalene-5,6,9,10-tetracarboxylic dianhydride crystallizes from a mixture
of acetic anhydride and acetic acid as prismatic rods that melt at
245 to 246. These bis-adducts readily dissociate into their components when heated. In the presence of hydrobromic or hydroiodic
acid, only one mole of maleic anhydride is split off and the methoxyaubstituted ring becomes aromatic. The bis-adducts are readily dehydrogenated with sulfur to yield the substituted naphthalene dicarboxylic anhydrides, which may be decarboxylated to obtain the
naphthalenes. The asymmetrical dimethoxy derivative
obtained from the dianhydride described here, however, undergoes
decarboxylation only at temperatures above 400, so that most of the
material is completely decomposed during the decarboxylation
substituted
process.
196
METHOXYARYLETHYLENES
l-(3,4-Dimethoxyphenyl)-l-phenyIethylene
1LCO
H CO
ILCO
l-(3,4-Dimethoxyphenyl)-l-phenylethylene + Maleic anhydride
l,4,4a,5,6,7-Hexahydro-2,3-dimethoxy8-ph<myl-l,4-othanonaphthadianhydride
lene-f>,6,9, 10-tetntcarboxylic
Procedure. A mixture of 2.4 g. of l-(3,4-dimethoxyphenyl)-lphenylethylene and 9.8 g. of maleic anhydride is heated in a stoppered
The reaction mixture turns a redvessel for 3 hours at 140 to 160.
brown color. When the heating is completed, the unreacted maleic
anhydride is removed by distillation under reduced pressure. The
crude product is dissolved in a minimum amount of boiling alcohol,
and the solution allowed 24 hours to crystallize. The crystals are
collected, sucked dry on the filter, and then recrystallized from a mixture of acetic anhydride and acetic acid. The yield obtained is 60%
of theory.
References
F. Szmuszkovicz, J. and Fawaz, G., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 1776 (1947).
Baehrnann, W. E., and Kloetzel, M. C., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 60, 2204 (1938).
Bruckner, G., Jr., Ber. 75B, 2034 (1942).
Bruckner, G., Jr., and Kovacs, J., Nature 161, 651 (1948).
Szmuszkovicz, J., and Berginann, F., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 1779 (1947).
Bergmann,
197
Cf.:
BICYCLOPOLYCARBOXYLIC
POLYANHYDRIDES
Bicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octene-2,3,5,6,7-pentacarboxylic
2,3,5,6-Dianhydride Methyl Ester
(7-Carbomethoxybicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octene-2,3,5,6-tetracarboxylic
Dianhydride)
This is a more or less general reaction of a-pyrones when they are
allowed to react with an excess of maleic anhydride at elevated temperatures for prolonged periods. The normal Diels-Alder adduct, a
compound containing an ester bridge, is produced first, since
the product formed when the reactants are refluxed in toluene, or
when this reaction is stopped after 5 hours. Fusing methyl coumalate
bicyclic
it is
with maleic anhydride causes an immediate loss of carbon dioxide,
with the formation of the dianhydride. Similar reactions take place
with coumalin and other substituted a-pyrones, such as dimethylcoumalin and isodehydroacetic acid, 2,4-dimethyl-l,2-pyrone. The dianhydride from coumalin may also be prepared from 3,5-cyclohexadiene1,2-dicarboxylic acid and maleic anhydride.
Bicyclo [2.2.2] -7-oetene-2,3,5,6,7-pentacarboxylic
2,3,5,6-dianhydride methyl ester melts at 331. The pentamethyl ester prepared
from it melts at 137 to 138.
The mono-adduct,
6-hydroxy-4-cyclohexene-l,2,3,5-tetracarboxylic
1,2-anhydride 8-lactone methyl ester, occurs as colorless crystals melting at 198. When an aqueous solution of this mono-adduct is evaporated to dryness and treated with methyl alcohol and hydrogen chloride, trimethyl trimesate, trimethyl 1,8,5-benzenetricarboxylate, is produced. In a similar way, trimesic acid may be obtained by heating
this adduct with four atoms of bromine at 200 for 2 hours.
Appar-
ently, oxidation occurs during esterification of the
mono-adduct
in
addition to hydrolysis of the ester bridge, dehydration, and decarboxylation. It is interesting to note that, in these two reactions, the
carboxyl group forming the bridge
decarboxylization, in contrast to
the dianhydride.
is
not the one that undergoes
in the formation of
what takes place
198
a-PYRONES
Methyl Coumalate
H
H COC-C
w11**^-'
XXqOvJO
3
TJ/"I
I!
nQ
t/^O
^o
/>-
CVx
v
HC
H
Methyl coumalate
+ Maleic
Bicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octene-2 3,5,6,7-pentacarboxylic 2,3,5,6-dianhydriae
l
anhydride
methyl ester
One and a
Procedure.
half
grams
of
methyl coumalate and
of maleic anhydride are dissolved in a small
the solution
is
refluxed for 24 hours.
During
amount
this
of xylene,
1 g.
and
time the product
gradually separates as a white crystalline precipitate. When the
reaction is complete, the solid crystalline mass is collected upon a
filter,
dried,
trile.
The
and then recrystallized several times from boiling acetoniyield
is
30%
of theory.
References
Diels, O., Alder, K.,
Fried,
J.,
and
and
Miiller,
K, Ann.
Elderfield, R. C., J. Org.
490, 257 (1931).
Chem.
199
6,
Cf.:
566 (1941).
ALK YLDIPHEN YLBIC YCLOTETRACARBOXYLIC ACIDS
l-Methyl-7,8-diphenylbicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octene-2,3,5,6-
telracarboxylic Dianhydride
The
reactions of bimolecular anhydroacetonebenzils with maleic anhydride
are unique, both with respect to the type of products formed and the marked
influence that substituent groups have upon the course of these reactions.
Generally, these bimolecular compounds react with maleic anhydride only at
temperatures sufficiently high to render them unstable, so that there is an
accompanying dissociation into a transitory monomeric cyclopentadienone or
a splitting of the carbon monoxide bridge or both.
Bimolecular compounds derived from alkylanhydroacetonebenzils, such as
shown on the opposite page, undergo both types of decomposition simultaneously in their reactions with the anhydride. Two products are thus formed
One of these is the dianhydride shown in the equation. The
in this case.
33112404, which
other, the major product of the reaction, is a monoanhydride,
has not yet been fully characterized. It is produced apparently by the addition
of maleic anhydride to the bimolecular compound with an accompanying loss of
both carbon monoxide and benzene, yielding a compound containing three
phenyl groups. Presumably, the angular phenyl group attached to the 3acarbon
is
the one that
tively rare.
is split off.
Such behavior
of phenyl groupings
The cleavage of the carbon monoxide bridge
when coumalates (q.v .) are allowed to react with
is
is rela-
similar to
what
takes place
maleic anhydride.
With bimolecular compounds derived from s*/w-dialkyl-derivatives of these
benzils, addition apparently occurs only as a result of their dissociation into
the cyclopentadienones. Depending upon the amount of maleic anhydride
used in the reaction, yields of 95 to 99% of either the mono- or di-adduct of the
cyclopentadienone may be obtained under similar conditions to those used
above. A typical example of this type of reactant is the bimolecular compound
obtained upon dehydrating,
2,5-dimethylanhydroacetonebenzil, 2,5-dirwthyl-
4-hydroxy-3,4-diphenyl-2-cydopenten-l-one.
The bimolecular compound
derived from the unsubstituted anhydroacetone
Hence, addition occurs only as a result of
benzil does not dissociate readily.
splitting off of
carbon monoxide.
l-Methyl-7,8-diphenylbicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octene-2,3,5,64etracarboxylic dianhydride melts at 325. It can be distilled without change under 7 mm. pressure
at 340 to 360 but decomposes
other product melts at 288.
when
so treated at atmospheric pressures.
200
The
BIMOLECULAR ALKYLANHYDROACETONEBENZILS
Bimolecular Methylanhydroacetonebenzil
H6
X
H '6 C6
C6 ~
-C
(
rt
\c=o
II
CH 8
CH 8
2-Methyl-3,4-diphenylcyclopentadienone
3a,4,7,7a-Tetrahydro-2,7dimethy 1-3 3a, 5, 6- tetraphenyl,
4J-methanoindene-l,8-dione
Maleio anhydride
2-Methyl-3,4-diphenylcyclopentadienone
l-Methyl7,8-diphenylbicyclo[2.2.2]-7-ootene-2,3,5,6-
tetracarboxylio dianhydride
Procedure. A mixture of 24 g. of bimolecular methylanhydroacetoneand 10 g. of maleic anhydride is carefully heated in a well-ventilated
hood at 220 until the poisonous carbon monoxide is completely evolved. The
reaction mass is then cooled and extracted for 1 hour with 125 ml. of boiling
benzene, filtered, and dried. The 10 g. of residue is crystallized from 50 ml. of
trichlorobenzene and then recrystallized from acetic anhydride to obtain the
benzil
above dianhydride in pure form.
Dilution of the benzene extract with an equal volume of
a mono-anhydride product.
yet been determined.
The
ligroin yields 16 g. of
precise structure of this
compound has not
References
C/.:
Allen, C. F. H., and Van Allan, J., /. Org. Chem. 10, 333 (1945).
Allen, C. F. H., and Gates, J. W., Jr., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 64, 2120, 2123, 2127 (1942).
Allen, C. F. H., and Spanagel, E. W., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 55, 3773 (1933).
Allen, C. F. H.,
and Van Allan,
J.,
J.
Am. Chem.
201
Soc. 64, 1260 (1942).
HETEROCOPOLYMERS
CH(SCOR )CH 2 9R(OR")2
],
Ethyl Poly (thiolacetoxyethylenesuccinate)
The copolymer prepared as described on the opposite page may be
processed to yield hard, colorless resinous objects. Similar resinous
products may be made by either simply heating the reactants together
an organic solvent. Various other
benzoin
and acyl peroxides may be used also. The
catalysts such as
reaction may be carried out in bulk or in solution, at 50 to 200, and
in the presence of a catalyst or in
in the presence or absence of ultraviolet light.
Clear colorless films
may be obtained from the copolymers by pressing them at 120 under
1000 Ib. per sq. in. Various esters of both maleic and fumaric acids
be employed as one of the reactants.
Maleic acid, its anhydride, and its esters also react with numerous
other hetero-substituted vinyl and ethylene compounds to yield a wide
may
variety of useful copolymeric products. In general, maleic compounds
have the tendency to produce 1 1 copolymers of the general structure
:
shown
Other examples of such are the copolymers with various
esters of acrylic and methacrylic acids, isopropenyl acetate, 4-phenylhere.
3-butene-2-one, methyl vinyl ether, and l-acyloxy-1,3 butadiene.
Use.
These copolymers
may
be used in molding compounds, as
binding compositions, coatings, thickeners,
acid fixers for basic dyes, and intermediates in the manufacture of
films, filaments, lacquers,
resins.
202
H C=CHSCOCH
HETEROVINYL COMPOUNDS
Vinylthiolacetate
Vinyl thiolacetate
Diethyl fumarate
An
Procedure.
aqueous emulsion
thiolacetate, 30 g. of diethyl fumarate,
is
prepared of 70
and
of copper-free water, with the aid of 10 g. of a
acid solution, 1
g.
of
g.
of vinyl
0.5 g, of diacetyl in
1%
90
g.
polymethacrylic
monopotassium phosphate, and
sufficient
pH
This emulsion
of 6.
potassium hydroxide solution to produce a
is kept agitated under an inert atmosphere while it is exposed for 5
hours at 70 to 80
to a commercial 100-watt mercury arc placed at
from the reaction vessel. At the end of this time the mixture is
cooled and the resulting granular suspension is collected on a filter.
4
in.
The
yield
is
85
g.
of a
copolymer containing 21.6% of
sulfur,
i.e.
68.9%
of vinyl thiolacetate.
References
Imperical Chemical Industries, Brit. 585,755 (1947). Cf.:
Losev, I. P., and Trostyanskaya, E. B. J. Gen. Chem. (USSR) 17, 122 (1947); C. A.
42, 2923d (1948).
Minsk, L. M. Waugh, G. P., and Kenyon, W. O., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 72, 2646 (1950).
(
U.S. 2,432,460; 2,452,165.
Brit. 595,881; 600,408.
203
ARYLTETRAHYDROPHTHALIC ACIDS
(OH),
Ar
cis-3-o:-Naphthyl-cis-4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic Acid
(cis-cr-Naphthyl-l,2,3,6-ci-tetrahydrophthalic Acid)
Some butadienes polymerize
so rapidly that they cannot be obtained
monomers. Such is true of several of the 1-arylbutadienes. The
method using the unsaturated alcohol affords a suitable means for
preparing the maleic anhydride adducts in such cases. This method
It has also been used to prepare the
is apparently a general one.
and
3,4-dimethoxyphenyl3-piperonyl-4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic
Maleic anhydride serves here both as a dehydrating agent and
acids.
as
a condensing agent in this reaction with arylalkylcarbinols. The anhydride rather than the acid is the product obtained when the carbinol
The yield of
is refluxed with maleic anhydride in boiling xylene.
anhydride is somewhat less than the yield of acid.
Theoretically, the addition might also take place at the /^-carbons
of the chain and of naphthalene ring to produce a substituted phenanthrenedicarboxylic acid of the type formed with vinylnaphthalenes
(q.v.).
Aryltetrahydrophthalic acids, however, apparently are proin these reactions, since no evidence has been re-
duced exclusively
ported that vinyltetrahydrophenanthrenedicarboxylic acid is one of
the products of this reaction. That the substituted phthalic acid
would be the predominant product in any case may be predicted from
resonance forms of the diene.
cis-3-a-Naphthyl-ci5-4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic acid crystals
begin to decompose at 165. The anhydride, when recrystallized from
benzene-petroleum ether mixtures, melts at 160 to 161, and the
dimethyl ester at 79 to 81. The dimethyl ester of 3-<x-Naphthyl-4cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic acid can be dehydrogenated to pro-
duce the 3-a-naphthylphthalate.
Hydrogenation of the acid gives the
when treated with anhy-
substituted hexahydrophthalic acid which
drous hydrogen
fluoride undergoes cyclization to 7a,8,9,10,ll,llahexahydro-7-oxo-7#-benz [de] anthracene-8-carboxylic acid.
Use. Nothing specific has been reported. For suggested uses see
other tetrahydrophthalic acids.
204
ArCH(OH)CH
CH=CH
ARYLALKENYLCARBINOLS
a- Ally 1- 1 -naph thaleneme thanol
(a-Naphthylallylcarbinol or l-Naphthyl-3-buten-l-ol)
Ho
C,
/ \H
HC
C-C-OII
II
m-3-a-Naphthyl-cts-4-
tt-Allyl-1-naphthylene-
methanol + Maleic
anhydride
cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylio acid
Procedure. A reaction mixture of 9.9 g. of a-allyl-1-naphthalenemethanol and 4.9 g. of maleic anhydride is carefully heated to approximately 150. This initiates a violent exothermic reaction, which is
controlled by cooling under running water. After the reaction has
subsided, the flask is heated for 45 minutes in a bath held at 145 to
155. The mixture is cooled, and the resulting tan, brittle crude
product is thoroughly extracted with ether. From this extract, there
An excess
is obtained 7.4 g. of white crystals of the pure product.
of maleic anhydride gives lower yields than when the above proportions are employed.
The carbinol may be prepared
from allylmagnesium chloride and
a-riaphthaldehyde by the method described in the following reference.
References
Arnold, R. T., and Coyner, E. C., J. Am, Chem. Soc. 66, 1542 (1944).
Hudson, B. J. F., and Robinaon, R. J. Chem. Soc. 1941, 715.
f
205
C/.:
H
R0 C (CH )
2
2 8
CH
ALKANETETRACARBOXYLIC
ACIDS
9R(OR) 2
C0 R
2
Tetraethyl
This
is
1, 2,3, 6-Hexanetetracarboxy late
an interesting reaction in that the cyclic ketone
is split
by
the potassium ethoxide so that a straight-chain tetracarboxylic acid
When sodium ethoxide or piperiis formed with the diethyl maleate.
dine
is
used as the catalyst, in place of potassium ethoxide, for the
of the maleic ester, l-carboxy-2-oxocyclopentanesuccinic
probably first formed, and the ring may not be broken until
addition
ester is
the resulting triethyl ester is saponified with concentrated hydrochloric
acid.
Unfortunately, the data available do not distinguish between
the two possible initial products in these cases, the succinate and
the tetracarboxylate. The fact that the boiling points of the products
from the sodium ethoxide and from piperidine are lower than those
obtained from potassium ethoxide would suggest that possibly the
succinate is formed with these two catalysts. The tetraethyl esters
prepared from the acids obtained by any of the methods are identical.
when sodium ethoxide is the catalyst.
Yields are poor
Tetraethyl 1,2,3,6-hexanetetracarboxylate boils at 182 under 4 mm.
The acid is a thick sirupy liquid. The ester undergoes
of pressure.
the
Dieckmann condensation with sodium dust
or
six-membered
to yield either a five-
ring system; namely, triethyl 3-carboxy-2oxocyclopentanesuccinate or 3,6-dicarboxy-2-oxocyclohexaneacetate.
This ketonic ester may be hydrolyzed to give a solid keto acid.
206
CYCLOPENTANONECARBOXYLIC ESTERS
r C0 R
2
H,
Ethyl 2-Oxocyclopenlanecarboxylate
OC 2 H 6
COC2 H
H
C-COC H
C-COC2 H
2
H,C
l\
COC 2 H
C-
2
H H II,
I*'
H 2 C-C-C
C
C-COC2 H
2
o
c-o 0=0
II
R
6
O
C2 H 5 C2 H 6
II
H,
Ethyl 2-oxocyclopentaneoarboxylate -fPotassium etnoxide + Diethyl maleate
Tetraethyl 1,2,3,6-hexanetetracarboxylate
(water)
Procedure. A solution of potassium ethoxide is first prepared
from 0.4 g. of metallic potassium and 55 ml. of absolute ethyl alcohol.
To this solution is added 15.6 g. of ethyl 2-oxocyclopentanecarboxylate
and 17.2 g. of diethyl maleate. After it has stood for 3 days at room
temperature, the reaction mixture is poured into acidulated water containing a small amount of floating ice, and the oil that separates is
then thoroughly extracted with ether. The ether extract is washed
with water, dried, and the solvent removed in the usual manner.
The residue is distilled under reduced pressure, collecting as product
that fraction that boils at
E>
182.
The
Reference
Ghosh, K.
CM
yield
is
36
g.
This
may
be
with 150 ml. of concentrated hydrochloric
saponified by refluxing
acid to obtain 30 g. of the sirupy acid.
it
J. Indian Chem. Soc. 24, 45 (1947).
207
a-PHENYLSUCCINATES
Ar9R(OR) 2
Dimethyl Phenylsuccinate
The
tion.
3%
shown
one of several taking place in this preparaDimethyl phenylsuccinate is recovered only to the extent of
of the reaction mixture, but it is of special interest in illustrating
reaction
is
one manner in which benzoyl peroxide
may
react.
It should be noted
required to complete the reaction. This must be
obtained from other molecules in the reaction mixture.
that hydrogen
Two
either
other
isomeric
is
crystalline
products
tetramethyl
esters
are
of
also
produced.
These
are
1,2,3,4-tetralintetrac.arbuxylic
acid or of 1-methylhydrindenetetracarboxylic acid. They are possibly formed by the cyclization of tetramethyl l-phenyl-1,2,3,4butanetetracarboxylate, which would result from a reaction of di-
methyl maleate with dimethyl phenylsuccinate.
The non-volatile portion of the products contains more than two
maleate units per phenyl group. It is undoubtedly comprised of the
higher polymers. Compare with reactions described on pages 26
and
54.
Partial decomposition during distillation of the reaction mixture
from which benzoic acid and the unreacted benzoyl peroxide have
been carefully removed yields additional benzoic acid. This indicates
that
some benzoyloxy-addition products are
208
also formed.
ACYL PEROXIDE
ArCOO OOCAr
00
Benzoyl Peroxide
CCOCHj
H C<r-C O
H CrC~6
H C6 C COCHi
H C COCH,
C COCH, IST
H
To 200
Procedure.
Benzoyl peroxide
tionwise 168
>
Dimethyl maleate
g.
Dimethyl phenyLsuccinate
of dimethyl maleate
is
carefully added por-
The reaction mixture is heated
700 hours at 55. Any unreacted peroxide
of benzoyl peroxide.
g.
under a reflux condenser for
remaining at the end of the reaction
is destroyed by slowly adding
a solution of sodium iodide in acetone. The acetone is evapoThe ether extract is
rated, and the mixture is extracted with ether.
to
it
next washed with an aqueous bicarbonate solution, dried, and the
solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue is separated
into four fractions at approximately 1 mm. pressure, giving \k% of
unreacted dimethyl maleate, bi 60-63
Z% of crude dimethyl phenyla
of
mixture of tetracarboxylates,
about
succinate, 61 105-115;
24%
;
182-195; and
bj
The
manner with a bicarbonate
and
of benzoic acid
of
of a non-volatile residue.
fraction distilling at 105 to 115
the usual
ni>
43%
1.492.
is
crystal of pure product.
mm.
an
is then washed in
remove any traces
having a
readily upon seeding with a
These crystals are then dried by pressing
redistilled to give
This fraction
them against a porous
at 1
solution to
initial fraction
solidifies
plate.
References
E. J. and DeTar, D. F., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 69, 52 (1947).
and Noaaki, K., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 68, 1495 (1946).
Brown, D. J., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 62, 2657 (1940).
Mayo, F. R., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 65, 2324 (1943).
Price, C. C., Ann. N. Y. Acad. Sci. 44, 365 (1943).
Marvel, C.
8., Prill,
Bartlett, P. D.,
209
C/.:
OZONIDE
-9K(OR) 2
Diethyl Maleate Ozonide
The procedure given on
preparing
the
ozonide
the opposite page serves equally well for
diethyl fumarate. If decomposition
from
reactions are to be avoided, a procedure employing an inert solvent
and lowered temperatures, such as described, must be used for this
purpose.
Ozonides prepared from maleic anhydride and fumaric acid are
highly unstable. They readily explode quite violently at comparaIn a series of
tively low temperatures even in the presence of solvents.
preparations, carried out
five out of eleven
by Briner and co-workers
experiments ended in explosions.
at
Some
60 to
80,
of the explo-
A white solid precipitates during
Obviously, no analyses are given,
but an equivalent molecular amount of ozone is absorbed in those
experiments where it is possible to obtain complete ozonization.
sions are
accompanied by flame.
the reaction with the anhydride.
The ozonides from both
diethyl maleate and diethyl fumarate are
have
a barely perceptible yellowish color.
limpid liquids. They
the
amounts of carbon and hydrogen and
contain
theoretical
They
have the following physical properties:
Ozonide of diethyl maleate refractive index, nf? 1.4384; density,
18 and dielectric
d|
1.1561; dipole moment, 2.53 X 10~
constant,
;
8.95.
Ozonide of diethyl fumarate
1.1591; dipole
dj
moment,
refractive index, n$ 1.4382; density,
10~ 18 and dielectric constant,
2.29
7.54.
The molar
refractions are higher than theory
by 4.93 and 5.10
units,
Raman
spectra of both compounds show, besides the
distinguishing lines for ozonides, a characteristic line for one ethylene
bond. This is not in accord with the generally accepted views of the
respectively.
structure of ozonides, but similar observations have been recorded for
the spectra of the ozonides of substances like eugenol, containing an
unsaturated allyl group.
210
OZONE
O8
Ozone
H O
!OC 2 H 8
fC
COC H
2
H
Ozone
Procedure.
-f-
>
Diethyl maleate
Diethyl maleate ozonide
maleate in 25 ml. of
stream of oxygen containing approximately 3% of ozone is then bubbled through this solution at a rate of 10 liters per hour for a period of 7 hours, without
allowing the temperature to rise. In this way, the reaction is consolution of 10.4
carbon tetrachloride
is
g.
cooled to
of diethyl
to
5.
tinued beyond the point of maximum rate of absorption of ozone, in
order to obtain the addition of a stoichiometric quantity. Of the
amount of ozone bubbled through the solution, 78%
The carbon tetrachloride is removed at the end of the
total
is
absorbed.
reaction
by
evaporation under highly reduced pressure.
References
Briner, E., Perrottet, E., Paillard,
H. and Susz,
B.,
Heh. Chim.
Ada
19, 1163,
1354 (1936).
Cf.i
Briner, E.
and Frank D.
Helv. Chim.
Briner, E., Perrottet, E., Paillard, H.,
20,
Ada
20, 1211 (1937).
and Susz,
762 (1937).
211
B.,
Heh. Chim.
Ada
19,
658 (1936);
ALDO ACID
OCH C02H
Glyoxylic Acid
Ozone apparently reacts with maleic acid solely as an oxidizing
agent when water is employed as the solvent, as in this preparation.
Under these conditions, it differs in its behavior in many respects
from what has been described in the previous preparation. There is
no direct indication that any ozonide is formed here. If produced,
it must decompose immediately, since only glyoxylic and oxalic acids
have been detected as the reaction products. The same type of oxidation reaction also occurs with aqueous suspensions of dimethyl maleate,
producing methyl glyoxylate.
Similar oxidation reactions to those in water
may
occur
when ozone
bubbled through solutions of maleates in the ionizing solvent, glacial
It is to be
acetic acid, but the products have not been isolated.
is
may be made of them, since much might be
concerning the true nature of these oxidizing reactions.
Maleic acid and dimethyl maleate, for example, absorb only 0.66
hoped that further study
revealed
mole of ozone before reaction
much more
is
complete.
Dimethyl fumarate, which
up approximately 1.7 moles of ozone.
without
compounds
conjugated carbonyl groupings, in
Simple
contrast, rapidly absorb stoichiometric quantities of ozone.
Glyoxylic acid occurs as rhombic prisms, which dissolve readily in
reacts
slowly, uses
olefinic
water.
The
acid
and many
of water, indicating that
it
of its salts crystallize with one molecule
may
have a structure analogous to that
of chloral hydrate.
212
OZONE
II
Ozone
H
O
Ozone
H O
O=C COH
HO~-C~~COH
Glyoxylic acid
4*
Oxalic acid
,u
C COH
Uc
H
+
Procedure.
Maleic acid
Ozone
is
bubbled for a period of 2 hours through an
aqueous solution containing 2 g. of maleic acid in 10 ml. of water.
The glyoxylic acid formed is isolated by converting it to the phenyl
hydrazone with phenylhydrazinium acetate. A yield of 1.4
glyoxylic acid phenylhydrazone is obtained in this manner.
The remainder of the products consists largely of oxalic acid.
is
g.
of
This
recovered from the aqueous solution by precipitation as the calcium
salt.
References
Harries, C., Ber. 36, 1936 (1903).
Cf.:
Noller, C. R., Carson, J. F., Martin, H.,
and Hawkins, K.
24 (1936).
213
8., J.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 58,
H
HC
a-FORMYLSUCCINATES
9K(OR) 2
Diethyl a-Formylsuccinate
This is the only reaction reported for preparing aldehyde dicarboxylates directly from maleates. Although the procedure involves the
use of a poisonous gas at relatively high pressures, it is a practical
one with several features of real merit, not the least of which is the
relatively high yield.
Diethyl a-formylsuccinate can also be prepared from diethyl sucEach method has certain marked advan-
cinate and ethyl formate.
tages and disadvantages.
Ethyl a-formylsuccinate obtained by this method has a boiling point
of 104 to 105
1.4486.
It is
5
pressure and a refractive index of nf>
pure as ascertained by titration. The pure ester
at 0.04
95%
mm.
has a 61 5 137. The product obtained from ethyl formate generally
boils at 124 to 125, and the p-nitrophenylhydrazone melts at 100 to
101.
Uses. Although diethyl a-formylsuccinate has not been extensively
studied as a reactant, several interesting reactions are reported where
it has been used as an intermediate in organic syntheses.
With
it
reacts
to
form
benzoyl chloride,
diethyl a-benzoyl-j9-formylsuccinate.
With benzyl amine,
it gives diethyl a-(benzylaminomethyThis product can be readily converted to 1-benzyl3-carbethoxy-5-pyrrolinone. Various other amines react in a similar
manner. Alanine esters, <x-aminopropionates, for example, give
a- (1-carboxyethylaminomethylene) succinates.
Acetamidine
dialkyl
lene)succinate.
yields ethyl 4-hydroxy~2-methyl-5-pyrimidine acetate.
the
Aniline gives
(phenylaminomethylene) succinates, y-anilinoitaconates. Hydroxylamine produces an oxime which, upon distillation, gives an alkyl
a-
/?-cyanopropionate.
Hydrolysis of ethyl a-formylsuccinate gives /Mormylpropionic acid.
This, with sulfuric acid, yields trimeric, six-membered, substituted,
This trimer on distillation produces the biscyclic oxymethylene.
CH 2 CH) 2 0.
/J-Formylpropionic
acid in pyridine reacts with malonic acid to
give adipenic acid,
y-(butyrolactone)
ether,
((^COCH 2
H0 2 C(CH 2 2 CH:CHC0 2 H..
)
Ethyl
0-formylpropionate
with
ma-
lonic ethyl ester gives the neutral ester of the pentacarboxylic acid,
2-dicarboxymethyl-l,l,4-butanetricarboxylicacid.
214
CO + H
ROELEN REACTANTS
Carbon Monoxide and Hydrogen
H-
i+
JL
C COC H
+1
C->
>
<3H
2
Carbon
monoxide
-f
4-
[Co(CO) 4 ]2
0=COC H
Hydrogen
OHO
111COC H
HCC
HCH
0=COC H*
a
Diethyl fumarate
>
Diethyl a-formylsuccinate
The dicobalt octacarbonyl catalyst is prepared
manner described in J. Am. Chem. Soc. 70, 383 (1948).
Procedure.
in the
first
When this has been done, 40 ml. of the resulting ether solution containing 2.2 g. of the catalyst is placed in a steel bomb, and 17.20 g.
of diethyl fumarate and 40 ml. of ether are added to it. The mixture
then allowed to react with an excess of carbon monoxide and hydrogen at a pressure not to exceed about 5050 Ibs. per sq. in. and an
ultimate temperature of 125. The pressure is released when the
bomb has cooled to room temperature, and the product is recovered
in the usual manner.
Purification is carried out by fractional distillation under 1 mm.
pressure, collecting the portion that boils at 85 to 120. This fraction
is redistilled to give a final product, 60.04 104-105, with a yield of
is
51%
of theory.
See the original article for details of the pressure reaction and for
the precautions to be taken in handling the high pressures and poisonous reactants.
References
Adkins, H. and Krsek,
G M J. Am.
Chem. Soc. 70, 383 (1948). Cf.:
38 (1922).
Gravin, A. I., J. Applied Chem. (USSR) 16, 105 (1943).
Ranganathan, S. K., J. Indian Chem. Soc. 16, 107 (1939).
Robinson, R., and Rose, J. D., /. Chem. Soc. 1933, 1469.
Shchukina, M. N., and Preobrazhenskil, N. A., Ber. 68B, 1991 (1935).
Todd, A. R., and Waring W. S. /. Chem. Soc. 1944, 548.
f
Carrtere, E.,
Ann. chim.
17,
U.S. 2,327,066; 2,377,395; 2,384,068.
215
CHAPTER
Sulfur
Compounds
Sulfur compounds and sulfur probably add to the ethylene bond of
maleyl compounds with greater avidity than the compounds of any
other group. In all the reactions described in this chapter, there are
but three exceptions where the sulfur atoms do not add directly to
one of the ethylene carbons of the maleyl reactant.
Sulfur itself reacts to produce the dicarboxyethylene sulfide in impure
Alkylthiols, unlike their oxygen analogs, readily unite with the
ethylene group of the maleyl group even in the absence of a catalyst,
Thiol acids, even when
to give a whole series of interesting homologs.
form.
they contain an amino group, react as
The amino group
if
in o-aminothiophenol,
they were simple mercaptans.
however, unites with one of
the carboxyls of maleic acid to give the heterocyclic 3,4-dihydro-3oxo-1, 4,2//-benzothiazine-2-acetic acid.
Thioacetic acid unites with maleic acid to produce the thioester of
malic acid with relative ease. This is particularly interesting, since
no similar reactions are reported
well
known
that acetic acid
is
for the
oxygen analog, although it is
forming esters with olefinic
capable of
hydrocarbons.
The great ease with which the ethylene bond of maleyl compounds
unites with sulfur atoms is most clearly demonstrated in the case of
Here sulfonation occurs even from aqueous solution at
bisulfites.
temperatures ranging about 50.
This reaction
used commercially
to produce an important series of wetting agents that are employed
in various manufacturing processes.
Sulfur trioxide
ment
is
is
unique as a reactant in that
of one of the hydrogens of the ethylene
216
it
causes a replace-
bond of maleic anhydride
in giving sulfomaleic acid instead of a derivative of succinic acid, us
Sulfinic acids react in the normal fashion.
is the usual case.
Thiosulfates split during addition to yield a-sulfo-/?-thiosuccinic
acids.
Both the amino and the thiol groups of thiourea unite with maleic
acid in the same manner as o-aminothiophenol, but in this case, union
takes place at adjacent carbons to yield 2-imino-4-oxo-5-thiazolidineWith thiosemicarbazones, three groups take part in the
acetic acid.
addition, namely, the imino group, the thio group,
group, to give
an azinedioxothiazolideneacetic
and the amino
acid.
The
reaction of diacenaphtho[ 1,2-6, l',2'-d]thiophene with maleic
anhydride is an example of a Diels-Alder type synthesis where the
is split off during the preparation of an aromatic
Heterocyclic sulfones lose sulfur dioxide upon adding maleic
anhydride in a similar manner.
hydrogen sulfide
product.
217
THIIRANEDICARBOXYLATES
S>9R(OH) 2
Diethyl 2,3-Thiiranedicarboxylate
(Diethyl Ethylenesulfide-,0-dicarboxylale)
This preparation is an interesting one as illustrating the readiness
with which sulfur and most of its compounds unite with the olefin
bond of maleyl compounds. The reaction is worthy of further study.
With modern molecular distillation techniques, undoubtedly a much
purer compound can be obtained than is given in the procedure on the
opposite page.
No properties of 2,3-thiiranedicarboxylic acid or its esters are
recorded other than that the diethyl ester is an amber-colored liquid,
which cannot be
distilled
without decomposition even under reduced
pressures.
218
SULFUR
Sulfur
C COCC H
II
C COCaH*
II
CH
<L:
0=CO(>C H
2
!OC*H 8
Sulfur
Diethyl fumarate
>
Diethyl
2,3-thiiranedicarboxylate
Procedure. A mixture of equivalent amounts of diethyl fumarate
and sulfur is heated with good agitation, at 160, until the fumarate
no longer tends to vaporize. The temperature in the flask is raised
to 210 and held at this point for 2 hours, after which the temperature
is allowed to cool to 180, and the pressure is reduced to 20 mm. in
order to remove any unreacted fumarate. The mixture is cooled to
room temperature, and any uncombined sulfur is removed by solution
in
an equal volume of absolute
ether.
Reference
Michael, A., Ber. 28, 1633 (1895).
219
MERCAPTOSUCCINATES
RS0R(OH) 2
Dibutyl Amylmercaptosuccinaie
The procedure
given on the opposite page is one of several similar
methods that have been used for preparing mercaptosuccinic acids,
their anhydrides or esters.
Variations in procedures include the use
of elevated temperatures or a mercury salt in place of the sodium
methoxide employed in this preparation. In some cases the presence
of oxygen apparently inhibits the reaction, but it tends to accelerate
it in the presence of both light and a mercury salt, according to
Phenol, hydroquinone, or a copper salt may be added to
prevent any polymerization of the product when the reaction is carried out at 70 to 100.
In gome cases simply refluxing the mercaptan
Kaneko.
with sodium maleate
and a small amount
in
an alkaline solution containing 40% alcohol
an excellent yield of the
of piperidine will give
mercaptosuccinic acid.
under a presare
Alkylmercaptosuccinates
readily oxidized by hydrogen peroxide at 18 to 20 to the alkylsulfoxysuccinates,
Dibutyl amylmercaptosuccinate boils at 144 to 145
sure of
mm.
of mercury.
by bromine water to a-bromo-^-alkylsulfonylsuccinates, and by potassium
with
Reaction
permanganate to
alkylsulfonylsuccinates.
bromine in acetic acid, however, yields the a-bromo-/?-alkylmercaptomaleates.
Uses. Mercaptosuocinic
acid
and
its
derivatives
have been
of
marked
bacteriostatic action against certain organisms where other drugs are ineffective, and as an antidote for mercury,
interest for their
lead,
and arsenic poisoning.
Alkylmercaptosuccinic acid esters, such as bis(tetrahydrofurfuryl)
amylmercaptosuccinate, have been shown to be superior to dibutyl
phthalate as a plasticizer for butadiene-acrylonitrile rubbers. (p-Halophenylmercapto)succinic acid and its derivatives have been used as
intermediates
for
producing Pharmaceuticals, pest-control agents,
plant-growth regulators, epithelial stimulants, and resins. For example, carboxyhalothiachromanones can be readily obtained from the
p-halophenylmercaptosuecinic acids by simply heating them with sul-
furic acid.
220
RSH
MERCAPTANS
1-Pentaiiethiol
C~CO(CH CH
CCO(CH CH
"
4S-
H->
2) 8
2)8
NaOCH
C(CH,) 4 SC
HOCO (CH )iCH,
A
^
Dibutyl inaleate
-f
A
1-Pentanethiol
CO(CH,),CH,
Dibutyl amylmercaptoauccinate
Procedure.
methanol solution of sodium methoxide is first preTo this solution is added 156 g. of
of sodium.
l-pentanethiol(aw]/lwercaptaw) and then slowly 376 g. of dibutyl
maleate, with constant agitation, care being taken to keep the temduring the operation. The reaction mixture is
perature below 40
pared from 1.8
g.
next set aside at room temperature for 2 days, following which it is
washed three times with water, dried, and fractionally distilled under
reduced pressure.
The
tained in this
is
way
yield of dibutyl amylmercaptosuccinate obg., or 95% of theory.
474
References
T., and Hook, E. O., U.S. 2,389,489 (1945).
Cf.:
Barry, V. C., O'Rourke, L., and Twomey, D., Proc. Roy. Irish Acad. 51B, 223 (1947).
Block, W. D., Buchanan, 0.
M and Freyherg, R. H., J. Pharmacol. Exptl. Therap. 76,
Dean, R.
355 (1942).
Dawson, M. H., and Hobby, G. L., J. Pharmacol. Exptl. Therap. 69, 359
Fieser, L. F., and Turner, R. B., J. Am. (them. Soc. 69, 2335 (1947).
Fitger, P., Ber. 54B, 2952 (1921).
Freyberg, R. H., Proc. Staff Meetings
(1940).
Mayo Clinic 17, 534 (1942).
Heilman, F. R., Science 91, 366 (1940).
Hornby, H. E., J. 8. African Vet. Mcd. Assoc. 12, 90 (1941).
1
Kaneko, T., and Mii, S., J. Chem. Soc. Japan 59, 1382 (1938); C. A. 33, 2106 (1939).
,/.
P.
60
A.,
46,
Hyg.
(1948).
McNally,
Meidinger, F., Arch, intern, pharmacodynamie 76, 351 (1948).
Otto, G. F., Maren, T. H., and Brown, H. W., Am. J. Hyg. 46, 193 (1947).
Sabin, A. B., Proc. Staff Meetings Mayo Clinic 17, 542 (1942).
Sabin, A. B., and Warren, J., J. Bact. 40, 823 (1940); Science 92, 535 (1940).
U.S. 1,672,615; 2,209,876; 2,370,593; 2,434,100.
221
FT. 845,793.
MERCAPTOTRICARBOXYLIC ACIDS
H0 CRS9K(OH)
2
Carboxymethylinercaptosuccinic Acid
Thiol acids react in the same manner as the mercaptans with maleic
The presence
acid, thereby producing mercaptopolycarboxylic acids.
of an amino or amide groups in the thiol acid has little or no effect
For example, cystene forms 2-amino-2-carboxyethylmercaptosuccinic acid by uniting with maleic acid in the same manner as thiolacetic acid. More complex aminothiol acids, such as
on the reaction.
H0 2 CCH (NH 2 CH 2 CH 2 CONHCH (CH 2 SH)
)
The procedure
CONHCH 2 C0 2 H,
thus a general one for thiol acids.
Carboxymethylmercaptosuccinic acid when recrystallized from
water softens at 135 and then melts at 140.5. The compound is
react similarly.
is
readily soluble in water, methanol, ethanol, and acetone. It is less
soluble in cold ether, slightly soluble in ethyl acetate, and in acetic
acid,
and
and practically insoluble
in chloroform, benzene, toluene, xylenes,
light petroleum.
Use.
These acids
offer
a number of
possibilities for various syn-
The
presence of several carboxyl groups in their structure
suggests that interesting resins can be prepared from them. The
theses.
monoesters, such as carbooctyloxymethylmercapto- and carbododecyloxymethylmercaptosuccinates, show surface active properties.
Through oxidation, sulfonyl and sulfo groups can be introduced to
replace the mercapto group.
HSRC0 H
THIOL ACIDS
Thiolacetic Acid
OHO
HO
O
NaOC
C 6oNa
C^-S~*
CCONa
Sodium
thiolacetate
HO6-C~S~C--COH
Acid
"^
>
Sodium maleate
HC--COH
Carboxymethylraercaptosuccinio
acid
To 400
ml. of an aqueous solution of 12.8 g, of sodium
added
200 ml. of an aqueous solution of 8.9 g.
maleate, pH
of sodium thiolacetate of the same alkalinity.
The mixture is then
diluted with 400 ml. of water and held at 37 under partial pressure
Procedure.
of 7.4, is
for 22 hours.
The
reaction product
tion with mercuric sulfate
sulfide to
crystallize
water.
purified
by repeated
precipita-
sulfate, using hydrogen
decompose the precipitates. The acid is then allowed to
from a concentrated solution and is recrystallized from
If a correction is
the yield
is
and with cadmium
is
made
for the 4.2 g. of unreacted thiolacetate,
practically theoretical.
References
Morgan, E. J M and Friedmann, E. Biochem. J. 32, 733 (1938). C/.:
Larsson, E., Trans. Chalmers Univ. TechnoL, Gothenburg No. 47, 3 (1945); C. A. 40,
f
2796 (1946).
Mulvaney,
J. F.,
Murphy,
J.
G.,
and Evans, R.
U.S. 2,449,418.
223
L., /.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 70, 2428 (1948).
ACETOTHIOMALIC ACID
II
RCOS9H(OH)
Mercaptosuccinic Acid Acetate
(Acetothiomalic Acid, Thiomalic Acetate)
further illustration of the ease with which sulfur
compounds com-
bine to saturate maleyl compounds by a S C linkage is shown by
When fumaric acid is used in place of maleic acid
this preparation.
Maleic anhydride yields
the reaction takes place much more slowly.
mercaptosuccinic anhydride acetate. An analogous reaction with
acetic acid has not been reported, although it is well known that this
oxygen analog readily adds to
duce acetates.
many
unsaturated compounds to pro-
Mercaptosuccinic acid acetate is a colorless crystalline solid that
melts at 125 to 126. It can readily be converted to the anhydride
that melts at 71 to 73. The anhydride absorbs moisture from the
air
if
acid
allowed to remain exposed to it. Upon saponification, thiomalic
obtained. This acid melts at 150 to 151.
is
Use.
They
They
These compounds should have a number
of
commercial uses.
are of particular interest as possible insecticides and fungicides.
have also been recommended for imparting tack to GR-S types
of synthetic rubbers.
224
RCOSH
THIOCARBOXYLIC ACIDS
Thioacetic Acid
HC C
8
HC C
C COH
S-+
GO
8
^
H->
II
-f
||
o
Thioacetic acid
COM
HC-COH
<!~-COH
Maleic acid
Mercaptosucoinio aoid acetate
Procedure. A solution containing 23.2 g, of maleic acid, 20 g. of
and 80 ml. of ethyl acetate is refluxed for one hour. The
reaction mixture is cooled and 400 ml. of benzene is added to it. The
addition of benzene causes the product to separate; it is collected and
thioacetic,
dried in the usual way.
The
yield
is
32
g.,
or
83%
of that required
by theory.
References
1
Holmberg, B. and Schjanberg, E., Arkiv. Kemi, Mineral Oeol. 14A (7), 22 pp. (1940). C /.:
Danielli, J. F., Daniclli, M., Fraser, J. B., Mitchell, D., Owen, L. N., and Shaw, G.,
Biochem. J. 41, 325 (1947).
Fraser, J. B., Owen, L. N., and Shaw, G., Biochem. J. 41, 328 (1947).
f
U.S. 2,449,418.
225
Na0 S
8
OR
SULFOSUCCINATES
ONa
Disodium Octyl Sulfosuccinate
The procedure given is a general one
its mono esters.
Essentially, it is
and
ion and that of the maleate ion.
affinity
for preparing sulfosuccinic acid
a reaction between the bisulfite
It illustrates further the
marked
that sulfur-bearing ions and compounds have for maleyl
When neutral esters are employed, sodium bisulfite must
derivatives.
be used as the other reactant.
Sulfosuccinic acid and its derivatives may also be prepared from
bromosuccinic acid and bisulfites and by the oxidation of mercapto-
and sulfinosuccinic acids or their esters. The yields and simplicity
of procedure, however, do not favorably compare with those obtained
by the procedure described. Small amounts of sulfosuccinic acid are
also obtained
when
succinic acid
is
treated with sulfur trioxide.
a white, amorphous, somewhat
that
dissolves
very easily in water. Aqueous solutions
sticky product
show marked emulsifying and wetting properties. Sulfosuccinic acid,
Disodium octyl sulfosuccinate
is
forms hygroscopic crystals containing one mole of water.
heating, it decomposes at 60 and darkens badly at 80 without
in contrast,
Upon
melting.
Use.
Compounds
of the above type
may be employed as wetting
and as agents for preparing emulsions
polymerizing solutions, and insecticidal sprays.
agents in textile processes,
synthetic rubber latex,
These are but a few of
many
industrial uses that
226
might be
cited.
SULFITES
NaHSOa
Sodium
HuC OC=0
Na
Sodium
CH
bisulfite
~*
fe
I
NaOC=0
1
NaOC=0
Sodium
H U C OC=0
CH
NaOS
nin
4
8
>f
H-*
Bisulfite
octyl acid maleate
>
Disodium ootyl sulfoeuccinate
Procedure. To a solution of 126 g. of sodium sulfite in a liter of
The reaction mixture is
is added 228 g. of octyl acid maleate.
heated to 50 and gently agitated at this temperature until it yields
a clear solution. The solution is neutralized and carefully evaporated
to dryness to obtain the succinate as an amorphous solid, or if an
water
aqueous solution
is
desired, the reaction mixture as such
is
adjusted
to the desired concentration.
References
Brit, patent 446,568 (1936).
Jaeger, A. 0., U.S. patent 2,028,091 (1936).
776,495 (1935). Cf.:
Backer, H. J., and van der Zanden, J. M., Rec. trav. Mm. 46, 480 (1927).
Caryl, C. R., Ind. Eng. Chem. 33, 731 (1941).
Caryl, C. R., and Ericks, W. P., Ind. Eng. Chem. 31, 44 (1939).
Climenko, D. R., J. Contraception 3, 149 (1938).
Fr. patent
Credner, B., Bull. soc. chim. France 13, 522 (1870).
Damerell, V. R., and Mattson, R., J. Phys. Chem. 48, 134 (1944).
Hagglund, E., and Ringbom, A., Z. anorg. u. allgem. Chem. 150, 231 (1926).
Lorenz, E., Shimkin, M. B., and Stewart, H. L., /. Natl. Cancer Inst. 1, 355 (1940).
Lozinski, E., and Gottlieb, R., J. Biol. Chem. 133, 635 (1940).
Messel, R., Ann. 157, 15 (1871).
Ordal, E. J., and Borg, A. F., Proc. Soc. Exptl Biol. Med. 50, 332 (1942).
U.S.
2,265,944; 2,325,411; 2,372,829; 2,373,305; 2,373,863; 2,405,737; 2,414,015;
2,415,255; 2,416,254; 2,437,504; 2,441,341. Ger. 694,062; appl. 169833 IV d/120
(USDC-OTS Rept. PBL20545). Fr. 833,282.
227
H
H0 S9&>0
SULFOACID ANHYDRIDES
Sulfomaleic Anhydride
Sulfur trioxide, unlike other sulfur compounds, adds to maleic
anhydride by displacing one of the hydrogens to give sulfomaleic
anhydride, as shown. When maleic acid or fumaric acid is used in
place of the anhydride, these acids are first converted to the anhydride
by the sulfur trioxide. Neither the sulfomaleic anhydride nor its
acids have been isolated as such but only as the salts as given in the
preparation. Some conversion of sulfomaleic acid to sulfofumaric acid
appears to take place during this preparation.
Alkali salts of sulfomaleic acid are produced in small amounts when
those of acetylenedicarboxylic acid are allowed to react with bisul-
The
The major product, however, is the salt of disulfosuccinic acid.
disulfosuccinates are also formed when alkali sulfomaleates react
with
bisulfites.
fites.
The
latter reactions take place
more rapidly than the
This would indicate that in the reactions with acetylenedicarboxylates, the sulfomaleates are converted to the disulfosuccinates
former.
almost as rapidly as they are formed.
The barium
salt of sulfomaleic acid crystallizes
of water.
228
with seven moles
SULFUR TRIOXIDE
so,
Sulfur Trioxidc
OBa
Ba(OH) 2
'
o-
0=S
it
C COBa
it
C COBa
J
Sulfur trioxide
Barium sulfomaleate
Maleic anhydride
Procedure. Forty-nine grams of maleic anhydride is cooled in a
ice, and 43.4 g. of sulfur trioxide is carefully distilled into it.
The mixture is then slowly warmed to 35 and held at this temperature until it becomes homogeneous. Then it is held at 50 for 5 hours,
care being taken not to permit the exothermic reaction to exceed 68
When the reaction is comin order to avoid excessive sulfonation.
red-brown
solid mass is dissolved
and
the
mixture
is
the
cooled,
plete,
bath of
The aqueous solution is extracted with 25 ml.
remove the 20 g. of the unreacted maleic acid and then
treated with barium chloride to eliminate the sulfuric acid. After
being filtered the mother liquor is concentrated and carefully neuThe voluminous
tralized with a cold solution of barium hydroxide.
is
and
washed
twice
collected
so
obtained
by suspending
precipitate
in
200 ml. of water.
of ether to
it
in a liter of water.
When
finally collected,
it is
dried in
air.
Reference
Backer, H.
J.,
and van der Zanden,
J.
M., Rec.
229
trav.
Mm.
49,
735 (1930); 50,
(145 (1931)
SULFONYLSUCCINIC ACIDS
i9R(OH) 2
4
Phenylsulfonylsuccinic Acid
Maleyl compounds add sulfinic acids in the same manner as they
do thioacetic acid and bisulfites (q.v.). The reaction is a general one.
Maleic anhydride, maleic acid, fumaric acid, or their salts may be
caused to react with the sulfinic acid in either an aqueous solution or
in an organic solvent.
Mineral acid is added if the salts are used.
The temperature may be varied from 45 to 100. The sulfonyl compounds that have been prepared in this way include such sulfonylsuccinic acids as the benzyl-
p-methylphenyl-
p-acetamidophenyl-
4-methyl-3-nitrophenyl4-methyl-3-aminophenyland benzoxazolone derivatives.
nitrophenyl,
4-chloro-3-
Phenylsulfonylsuccinic acid occurs as crystals that melt at 100 in
the water of their own crystallization, becoming solid at 105 to 106
and again melting at 135
to a clear
homogeneous
liquid.
It
may
be
oxidized with permanganate to the sulfonic acid.
Uses. These compounds are used as intermediates in the manufacture of dyes, synthetic tanning agents, and textile assistants.
230
SULFINIC ACIDS
Ar(H)S02
Benzenesulfinic Acid
CCOH
H C i-C COH
i
CCOH
*i
HC
H
+
Benzenesulfinic acid
To
Procedure.
75 ml. of water
is
then held at 45
lized
is
^
g.
of
At the end
of water.
upon a
of water.
When
||
Phenylsulfonylsuccinie acid
benzenesulfinic acid in
2.9 g. of maleic anhydride.
for 5 days.
COH
|l
a solution of 3.6
collected
from 25 ml.
Maleic acid
added
and diluted with 20 ml.
the product
00
This mixture
of this time,
it
crystallization
is
is
is
cooled
complete,
sucked dry, and then recrystalyield of crude acid is practically
filter,
The
equivalent to the theoretical amount, 5.6
is obtained of the pure product.
g.,
whereas 3.3
References
Schjanberg, E., Ber. 76B, 287 (1943). C/.:
Ger. 676,013 (1939); and U.S. Dept. Com.
OTS
231
Rept.
PBL58768.
g.
or
60%
SULFOTHIO ACIDS
HS
\9R(OH) 2
H0 S
3
a-Sulfo-jS-thiosuccinic Acid
Thiosulfuric acid readily adds to maleic acid to produce a,/?-substituted succinates, as shown by the preparation on the opposite page.
In this reaction, a cleavage takes place between the sulfur atoms of
this acid, enabling
ethylene bond
behaves as
if it
them
to
add to both carbons of the unsaturated
maleyl compound. The thiosulfuric acid thus
were a mixture of free radicals from hydrosulfuric and
of the
sulfurous acids.
a yellow solid that decomposes at
a thick yellow oil with a pear-like odor.
a-Sulfo-/3-thiosuccinic acid
105.
The
Use.
number
ethyl ester
is
is
This acid has an interesting structure, and
of possibilities for organic syntheses.
232
it
should offer a
HS
2
THIOSULFATES
Sodium Thiosulfate
S_>
HOS->
Thiosulfuric acid
-f
II
HS O-COH
II
CCOH
CCOH
~*
Maleic aoid
>
II
HOS
CCOH
a-Sulfo/3-thiosuccinio aoid
Procedure. An aqueous solution of 158 g. of sodium thiosulfate is
added with constant stirring to one containing 116 g. of maleic acid
and 98 g. of sulfuric acid. No sulfur is formed under these conditions.
When the reaction is complete, the fumaric acid is removed by filtraThe mixture of prodtion, and the filtrate is carefully evaporated.
ucts is then extracted with alcohol and purified by converting the
acids to their ethyl esters, extracting with ether and saponifying with
hydrochloric acid. a-Hydroxy-/3-sulfosuccinic acid is formed as a
by-product.
Reference
Tanatar,
S.
and Volyanskii,
I.,
/. Russ. Phys.
(1913).
233
Chem. Soc. 44, 1320 (1913); C. A.
7,
984
OH
PSEUDOTHIOHYDANTOIN ACIDS
S/
NH
2-Imino-4-oxo-5-thiazolidineacetic Acid
Thioureas, unlike urea (q.v.), react in their enol form with both
maleic and fumaric acids to produce derivatives of iminothiazolidone,
instead of thiohydantoin. Thus thiourea, like other compounds containing sulfur, adds at the sulfur atom. The preferential reaction,
like that of the other reactants, is a union of the sulfur atom with
one of the carbons of the ethylene group of the maleyl bond. The
fact that 2-imino-4-oxo-5-thiazolidineacetic acid has also been pre-
pared from mercaptosuccinic acid and cyanamide, and from thiourea
and bromosuccinic acid, leaves no doubt that the pseudothiohydantoin
acid
is
the one formed here.
diaryl
derivatives
acetic acid
such
The preparation
as
is
a general one, since
2-phenylimino-3-phenylthiazolidone-5-
have also been prepared by the same procedure from sub-
stituted thioureas.
2-Imino-4-oxo-5-thiazolidineacetic acid,
when
pure, occurs as fine
which decompose without melting at 210 to 212.
When heated rapidly they decompose at 218. The compound dissolves easily in hot water but is practically insoluble in cold water
and in alcohol. With acids, it decomposes to form mercaptosuccinic
acid and cyanamide. It gives sulfosuccinic acid and urea when
oxidized.
Since the compound contains an asymmetric carbon atom,
colorless needles,
it
should be possible to resolve
it
into
two
optically active isomers.
These compounds from their structure should find use as
intermediates in the synthesis of Pharmaceuticals and fungicides.
Uses.
234
THIOAMINES
K^
H NGNH
2
Thiourea
O
II
COH
COH
HC
HCH
HC
II
O
Maleic acid
-1-
Thiourea
-H
;C=NH
2-1 mino-4-oxo-5-
thiazolidineacetic acid
Procedure. A powdered mixture of 5 g. of maleic or fumaric acid
and 3.3 g. of thiourea, with 3 to 4 ml. of water, is heated in a pressure
tube for 2 hours at 105. When the tube is cooled, fine needles form
that readily settle to the bottom of the liquid. These crystals are removed when crystallization is complete, and are then recrystallized
from hot water in which the product has limited solubility. Only one
recrystallization
is
necessary to obtain a highly purified product.
Reference
Andreasch, R. Monatah. 18, 56 (1897).
f
235
HETEROCYCLIC ACIDS
3,4-Dihydro-3-oxo-l,4,2ff-benzothiazine-2-acetic Acid
(2,3-Dihydro-3-oxo-l,4-benzothiazine-2-acetic Acid )
This reaction with o-aminobenzenethiol clearly demonstrates
how
the mercapto group adds preferentially to the C:C bond of maleyl
compounds, whereas the amino group generally adds to the carbonyl.
Since the yield is practically a theoretical one, there is no addition
This might
of the amino group to the ethylene bond in this reaction.
be expected from what has been seen of the reactivity of these groups
compounds that contain only one of them. The method is con-
in
venient for preparing certain heterocyclic acids of this type. Fumaric
acid or monobromosuccinic acid may be substituted for maleic acid
in this preparation.
3,4-Dihydro-3-oxo-l,4,2#-benzothiazine-2-acetic acid occurs as
The compound is soluble
colorless needles that melt at 195 to 196.
in alcohol, sparingly soluble in ether,
and insoluble
in benzene, chloro-
form, and ligroin.
Uses, These acids should be interesting reactants for various syntheses.
236
o-H2N
AMINOTHIOPHENOLS
CH< SH
o-Arninobenzenethiol
(o- Amino thiophenol )
H H
-C-COH
2
||
=0
o-Aminobenzenethiol
Maleic acid
3,4-Dihydro~3-oxo-l,4,2#-
Procedure.
Three grams
benzothiazine-2-acetic acid
of
o-aminobenzenethiol
is
mixed with
evolved during the mixing,
which causes the mixture to set to a hard mass. To insure completion
3.5 g. of maleic acid.
Considerable heat
is
mass is heated for a few minutes at 100
broken up, and recrystallized from dilute alcohol.
of the reaction, the resulting
to
110, then
The
yield
Mills,
W.
is
cooled,
g.,
or
93.5%
of the theoretical
amount.
Reference
H., and Whitworth,
J. B., J.
Chem. Soc. 1927, 2751.
237
OH
THIAZOLEDIONEACETIC ACIDS
9ft
S/
C=N
N=CRR'
2-Acetoneazine-2,4-dioxo-5-thiazolidineacetic Acid
(2,4-Diketotetrahydrothiazole-2-isopropylidenehydrazone-5-acetic Acid)
Thiosemicarbazones, like thiourea and o-aminobenzenethiol
(g.f.),
react with maleic anhydride by the sulfur group attaching itself to
the ethylene bond of the maleyl compound and the amino to one of
the carbonyls.
is a shift in the double bond of the
S to the C
linkage. This takes
to an azine, as shown in the equation
In this case there
thiosemicarbazone from the
place simultaneously, giving rise
on the opposite page.
This preparation is a general one. It has been used in preparing
the acetophenone, 3-methylcyclohexone and benzaldehyde analogs,
and similar compounds of 3-methyl- and 3-phenylthiocarbazones.
No definite compounds have been isolated from hydrolysis of the
products with dilute hydrochloric acid, but with concentrated acid,
the acetophenone and acetophenone-3-methyl derivatives yield acetophenone, hydrazine dihydrochloride, and the dioxothiazolidineacetic
acid.
2-Acetoneazine-2,4-dioxo-5-thiazolidineacetic
when
recrystallized
which
Use.
it is
acid
melts
at
223
from an acetone-light petroleum mixture, from
obtained as a microcrystalline powder.
is a suitable one for preparing derivatives for
The procedure
the identification of thiosemicarbazones.
238
RC=NNHC NHR"
THIOSEMICARBAZONES
Acetonethioscmicarbazone
N=C(CH
S
Acetonethioscmicarbazone
Procedure.
-f
Maleic anhydride
mixture of 14.5
9.8 g. of maleic anhydride
is
g.
'>
3)2
H H2
2-Acetoneasjine-2,4-dioxo5-thiazolidineacetio acid
of acetonethiosemicarbazone
and
dissolved in a mixture of benzene and
acetone, and the solution is refluxed for 15 minutes. The product separates as crystals when the reaction mixture is cooled. These crystals
are then collected, washed, and recrystallized from acetone by adding
a light petroleum solvent.
Reference
McLean,
J.,
and Wilson, F.
J.,
/. Chem. Soc. 1939, 1048.
239
DI(1,8-NAPHTHALENE)PHTHALIC ANHYDRIDE
Benzo[l,2-a,3,4-a']diacenaphthalenedi-7,8-carboxylic Anhydride
/
,2 g] -7,9-isobenzofurandione
or 3,4,5,6-Di(l,8-naphthalene)phthalic Anhydride)
(Diacenaph tho[l ,2-e,l
Thiophene, like benzene, does not undergo a Diels-Alder reaction
with maleic anhydride or other dienophiles. The same is probably
true for the methyl and dimethyl derivatives, thiotolene and thioxene.
Isobenzofuranes add maleic anhydride, but isobenzothiophene and 1,3diphenylisothiophene do not. However, the highly phenylated 1,3,5,6tetraphenylisobenzothiophene forms an adduct that dissociates into
its
melting point, and diacenaphtho[l,2-6,l',2'-d]maleic
adds
thiophene
anhydride at elevated temperatures, with a
loss of hydrogen sulfide, as shown on the opposite page.
Other deconstituents
at
its
rivatives containing groups that might activate the conjugated double
bond might be expected to behave similarly.
The diacenaphtho[l,2-b,r,2'-d]thiophene adduct with the sulfur
bridge has not as yet been isolated, nor has it been shown to be
present in the mixture of reaction products. A good yield of benzo[l,2-a,3,4-a']diacenaphthalene-7,8-dicarboxylic anhydride
after the treatment with potassium hydroxide.
thiophene adduct
may
is
obtained
The diacenaphtho-
be formed at least as an intermediate during
the reaction.
Benzo [l,2-a,3,4-a'j diacenaphthalene-7,8-dicarboxylic anhydride ocdecompose at about
curs as yellow needles that do not melt but
385. The compound is practically insoluble in
vents and in aqueous alkalies.
It
alkalies.
240
is
common
organic solsoluble
in
alcoholic
slightly
THIOPHENES
Diacenaphtho[l,2-&,l ,2'-cf|thiophene
(2,3,4,5-Dinaphthalenethiophene)
Maleic
anhydride
Diacenaphtho[1,2-6, l'.2-enthio-
Benzo[l,2-o,3,4-a']diace-
naphthalene-7,8-dicarDoxylio anhydride
phene
Procedure. Diacenaphtho[l,2-6,l',2'-d]thiophene is prepared first
from acenaphthalene and sulfur. [See Ber. 36, 966, 1586 (1903).]
Then 0.12 g. of it is thoroughly mixed with 0.4 g. of maleic anhydride,
and the mixture is heated for 15 minutes at 225 in a heavy-walled
tube.
Upon cooling, the reaction mixture is removed and broken up.
It is next extracted with hot water and then with 10 cc. of a 5%
solution of potassium hydroxide. The product that remains is collected upon a filter, dried, and recrystallized twice from phenyl ether.
The
yield
is
0.08
g.,
or
60%
of the theoretical amount.
References
Clapp, D.
B., J.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 61,
2733 (1939).
Norton,
J. A.,
C/.:
and Gates, J. W., Jr., /. Am. Chem.
Chem. Revs. 31, 319 (1942).
Allen, C. F. H.,
241
Soc. 65, 1283 (1943).
RS C
CH
THIOETHERS OF CYCLOHEXENEDICARBOYLIC ANHYDRIDES
\
9Jl>0
R'C
CH
4-tcrt-Butylmercapto-5-methyl-4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic
Anhydride
Heterocyclic sulfones obtained from butadienes readily lose sulfur
dioxide when allowed to react with maleic anhydride. Substituted
may thus be prepared in this manapparently a very general one. It has
cyclohexenedicarboxylic anhydrides
ner.
The procedure given
is
been used for the synthesis of several alkylmercaptomethylcyclohexenedicarboxylic anhydrides. It is likely that the substituted
butadienes are formed as an intermediate during the reactions, since
the reactions can be carried out in two steps: by (1) heating the sulfone to produce the butadiene thioether and (2) then allowing the
latter
tained
compound to react with maleic anhydride.
by the two procedures are identical.
The products ob-
4-^ri-Butylmercapto-5-methyl-4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic
hydride melts at 128.5 to 129.5.
Uses.
These compounds
offer interesting possibilities for
synthesis.
242
an-
chemical
HETEROCYCLIC SULFONES
RS C CH 2
S0 2
R C-CH
/
3-tert-Butylmercapto-2,5-dihydro-4-methylthiophene
1-Dioxide
(H 3 C) 3 C-S-C
/~i
Hfi
ow""""^
H,
C
/v
r\ ""
v>
v>
9
C
N
C
'
4"
3-<ert-Butylmercapto-2,5-
dihydro-4-methylthiophene
1-
f^
(^
v>
C*i*
How
v/
TJ
/"v
V-/
\ /H
C
ii
Maleip
anhydride
C^
4-<erf-Butylmercapto-5-methyl4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic
dioxide
Procedure.
AHC
(H 8 C) 3 C-S-C
anhydride
mixture of 22.0
3-er-butylmercapto-2 5and 9.8 g. of maleic anhydride is
dihydro-4-methylthiophene
heated in a hood at 160 to 165 for half an hour. During this time
sulfur dioxide is evolved. The reaction mixture is cooled and disg.
of
1 -dioxide
solved in benzene.
From
this solution the product is obtained as
colorless crystals.
The
sulfone used in this preparation may be synthesized from 2chloro-3-methyl-l,3-butadiene, as described in the following reference.
Reference
Backer, H.
J.,
and Blass, T. A. H., Rec.
trav.
chim. 61, 785 (1942).
243
CHAPTER
8
Energy and
Both
Catalysts
and heat may have two
different types of effect upon
decarboxylation, such as occurs when
a dilute solution of maleic acid is exposed to ultraviolet light, or when
inaleyl
its
is
light
The
compounds.
first is
aromatic esters are heated at their boiling points. The other effect
the isomerization of the cis-acid and its esters to their trans-forms,
such as occurs when maleic acid
145 to 260
for half
is
heated in an inert atmosphere at
an hour, or when the
solid acid or its solutions
are exposed to strong sunlight.
Numerous types
zation to
of substances can act as catalysts to cause isomeri-
occur at various temperatures.
widely in their effectiveness.
These substances vary
Such catalysts include a variety of
sulfur
compounds, as, for example, thiourea, thiazoles, thiazolines,
thiuram disulfide, dithiocarbamates, mercaptans, alkyl disulfides, salts
of thio acids, thiosulfates, thiocyanates, sulfur, and mixtures of sulfur
dioxide and hydrogen sulfide. Other catalysts include the acids:
nitric, sulfuric, perchloric, hydrochloric, hydrobromic, and hydroiodic;
the heavy metal salts of lead, copper, and silver; bromine; and
aqueous suspensions of platinum black.
Finely dispersed sulfur catalyzes the transformation only at elevated temperatures. No isomerization with sulfur takes place at ordinary temperatures. For
example, no fumaric acid
thiosulfate
posing
maleates.
is
formed when sulfur
solutions
is produced by decommineral
in the presence of
acids
by
Such suband
and
ammonia, pyridine,
primary
secondary amines.
maleic acid is heated with water in the preparation of malic
Various amines can also cause this cis-trans conversion.
stances include
When
acid, fumaric acid is also formed.
244
An
equilibrium mixture of the
three acids exists for each set of conditions.
It
is
direct isomerization of maleic acid to fumaric acid
reaction.
believed that the
is
Equilibrium in the case of the three acids
an
irreversible
is
assumed to
from the independent reversible reactions of maleic
and fumaric acids with water to form malic acid.
There is no indication that deuterium is added to the ethylene bond
result, therefore,
when deuterium
chloride is employed as the catalyst in
Since the rate of the catalyzed reaction is a function of the concentration of the catalyst, some investigators have postulated that the catalyst
may add to the maleyl bond of the maleic
of maleic acid
this isomerization.
XY
acid in the 1,4-positions during the reaction to form
general type
HO C=C CH C
I
YO H X
OH.
compounds
of the
Molecules of such addi-
II
tion products having a single bond between the carbons in the 3- and
4-positions would thus be free to rotate about this position to form
the frans-isomers
when
splitting off the catalyst.
245
H C=HC0 H
UNSATURATED ACID
Acrylic Acid
be prepared by the decarboxylation of maleic or
The method shown on the opposite page is of interest
showing how the decarboxylation can be induced by the action of
Acrylic acid
may
fumaric acid.
in
upon solutions of maleic acid. Acrylic acid may also be
maleic anhydride by vaporizing the anhydride in an
from
prepared
atmosphere of nitrogen that is saturated with water and passing the
actinic rays
mixture over activated
Acrylic acid
is
silica gel
heated to 400.
a colorless liquid that freezes at 12.3
and
boils at
water and alcohol.
Use. Acrylic acid is used in the manufacture of synthetic rubbers
and plastics, and in the synthesis of vitamin B and other materials.
141.9.
It is soluble in
246
ENERGY
Light
CH
II
C-COH
H
Maleio acid
Acrylic acid
Light
Procedure. A 0.0066
solution of maleic acid is exposed for 15
minutes to the radiation of a mercury vapor-quartz, Westinghouse
lamp (110 volts, 3.5 amp,). Under these conditions a gas is evolved
exclusively carbon dioxide. That the resulting solution contains acrylic acid is demonstrated by preparing the acid chloride from
that
it
is
in the usual
manner.
References
Volmar, Compt. rend. 181, 468 (1925).
Cf.:
Ogata, Y., Tsunemitsu, K. and Oda, R., Bull Inat. Phya. Chem. Research (Tokyo),
Chem. Ed. 23, 281 (1944); C. A. 42, 6746h.
f
247
ArCH=CHAr
AROMATIC HYDROCARBONS
Stilbene
Aromatic esters of fumaric acid when heated at their boiling points
one and then a second molecule of carbon dioxide, as shown
The procedure is a general one.
in the equation on the opposite page.
It has also been used to prepare such substituted stilbenes as the
p,p'-dichlorostilbene, p,p'-dinitrostilbene, and the o,o'-dimethylstillose first
equally applicable to the intermediate products, the aromatic esters of cinnamic acid.
bene.
It
is
Pure stilbene fuses at 124. With bromine, it reacts to yield a,a'dibromobibenzyl, which melts at 235.
Use. Stilbene derivatives are of interest as intermediates in the
preparation of dyes.
248
ENERGY
AH
Heat
Heat
0=COC H
6
>
Diphenyl fumarate
Ten grams
Procedure.
of diphenyl
gas for 25 hours at 290 to
When
Phenyl cinnamate
>
Stilbene
fumarate are heated in an inert
300, during which time carbon
dioxide
is
complete, the mixture is cooled and
then fractionally distilled under approximately 11 mm. pressure. A
small amount of phenol distills over when the temperature reaches
evolved.
the reaction
is
86 to 90, and then the crude stilbene is obtained. The latter is
recrystallized from alcohol to obtain a pure product.
Some phenyl cinnamate may be recovered during the distillation
if
the reaction
is
stopped
when only
half the carbon dioxide has been
Even under
these circumstances, stilbene is the major prodevolved.
uct.
Considerable amounts of a resinous residue is left in both cases.
References
Anschiitz, R., Ber. 60B, 1320 (1927)
and Skraup,
S.,
and Beng,
E., Ber. 60B,
942 (1927).
Cf.:
Anschtitz, R. /. Chem. Soc. 47, 898 (1885); Ber. 18, 1945 (1885).
Anschtitz, R., and Wirtz, Q., J. Chem. Soc. 47, 899 (1885)
f
Funaro, A., Gazz. Mm. ttal. 11, 274 (1881).
Ogata, Y., Tsunemitsu, K., Kawamura, A., and Oda, R., Bull. Inst. Phy$. Chem. Research (Tokyo}, Chem. Ed. 24, 11 (1947); C. A. 42, 6753c (1948).
249
trans-ISOMERS
*rans-9R(OH) 2
Fumaric Acid
This method can be used equally well with the esters of maleic acid
98% conversion to the fumarates. Quantitative
of
fumaric
acid are also obtained by simply heating maleic
yields
pure
to obtain as high as
acid, as described in the introduction to this chapter.
Fumaric acid occurs as monoclinic prisms that melt at 287.
This
acid is almost insoluble in cold water, but it is quite soluble in boiling
water, having a solubility of 0.7 g. and 9.8 g. per 100 cc., respectively,
at 25 and 100. It is soluble in ethyl alcohol but relatively insoluble
in diethyl ether.
Maleic acid melts at 130.5.
cold water
and
in alcohol,
It is
very soluble in both hot and
and quite soluble even
in ether.
It also
occurs as monoclinic prisms.
Uses. Fumaric acid is a suitable starting material for most of the
reactions described in this book. Uses for the reaction products have
Fumaric acid has become an important
amount of material is used
By
and
plastics.
esters, resins,
Among the interest-
already been mentioned.
product technically.
in the preparation of
far the greatest
ing but less important uses that might be mentioned is its use in producing birefringent optical films, the use of certain of its salts as
chrome tanning,
and cotton print discharging.
cathartics, in treating chronic alcohol intoxication, in
wool printing,
silk dyeing,
250
AH
HEAT OR CATALYST
or Catalyst
Isomerization
HC COH
Heat or
HC COH
Catalyst
HOC CH
HC COH
II
II
Maleic acid
solution
is
temperature for
upon cooling
4 hours.
22
g.
or catalyst
One hundred grams
Procedure.
a solution of 2.5
The
^at
is
Most
Fumario
ftcid
of maleic anhydride
is
added to
g. of 2-mercapto-4-methylthiazole in 85 ml. of water.
then heated to boiling and stirred constantly at this
2% hours. The 90 g. of fumaric acid that separates
removed, and the filtrate is heated for an additional
water is then distilled off, yielding an additional
of the
of fumaric acid to give a total yield of
95%
of theory.
References
Scott, W., U.S. 2,414,066 (1947).
C/.:
Carpenter, J. H., /. Ind. Eng. Chem. 13, 410 (1921).
Ciamician, G., and Silber, P., Ber. 36, 4267 (1903).
Clemo, G. R., and Graham,
Green, S. R., Iverson,
W.
P.,
Chem.
and Waksman,
S. B., J.
Soc. 1930, 213.
S. A., Proc. Soc. Exptl. Biol.
Med.
67, 285
(1948).
Gregory, T. C., Uses and Applications of Chemicals and Related Materials, Reinhold
Publishing Corp., N. Y., 2 vols. (1939-1944).
Horrex, C., Trans. Faraday Soc. 33, 570 (1937).
Mayo, F. R M and Walling, C., Chem. Revs. 27, 403 (1940).
Mollerstrom, J., Archiv. Kemi, Mineral Geol. 19A, No. 10, 26 pp. (1945).
Ne'ogi, P., and Mondal, K. L., /. Indian Chem. Soc. 16, 239 (1939).
Nozaki, K., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 63, 2681 (1941).
Nozaki, K., and Ogg, R., Jr., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 63, 2583 (1941).
Pelouze, J., Ann. 11, 266 (1834).
Petri, C., Ann. 195, 61 (1879).
Schmidt, J., Ber. 33, 3242 (1900).
Smyth, J., Brundage, R M Orten, J. M., and Smith A. H., Proc. Soc. ExptL BioL Med.
60, 301 (1945).
Tanatar, S., Ber. 27, 1367 (1894); Ann. 273, 33 (1893); /. Russ. Phy$. Chem. Soc. 43,
1742 (1911); 44, 1320 (1912).
Terry, E. M. and Eichelberger, L., /. Am. Chem. Soc. 47, 1402 (1925).
Wislicenus, J. Ber. 29, 1080 (1896).
t
U.S.
2,208,519; 2,363,108; 2,371,143; 2,393,352; 2,404,103;
2,447,831; 2,470,505; 2,548,687. Brit. 563,019.
251
2,422,411;
2,441,238;
INDEX
Abietic acid,
190
Acrylic acid, o-chloro--iodo-, 30
esters, 171, 190, 191
Absorption spectra,
/3-(2,
20, 108, 180
4-dimenthoxybenzoyl)-, 92, 93
202
esters,
Acyl peroxides, 202
Acenaphthalene, 10
Acetal; dipropyl-, 70
Addition;
1,2-, 54, 59, 76, 78, 80,
84
Acetaldehyde azine, 136
1,3-,
Acetal dimer, 170, 171
Acetamidine, 214
1,4-, 54, 59, 74, 76, 78, 80, 82, 84, 86,
Acetic acid, effect of strength, 128
failure to add to the C:C group, 108
1,6-, 54, 59,
glacial,
ozonization
13Q
164, 245
in,
82
asymmetric, 86
212
crisscross, 136
Adduct of a-terpinene,
refluxing with, 14
Acetoacetic acid; sodium derivative,
ethyl ester, 68, 69
8,
18
Adducts, aromatic, 16
chlorinated, Diels-Alder, 32
Acetone, 132, 160
Diels-Alder, 4, 5, 8, 12, 13, 18, 170,
azine, 136
186, 192
thiosemicarbazone, 138, 139
Acetonediacetic anhydride, 56
diene type, 10
heterocyclic, 186
Acetonitriles; phenyl-, 72
poly-, 192, 193, 196-201
Acetophenone, 238
sulfonated, 12
azine, 136
terpene, 18
unstable, 171
desyl-, 78
thiosemicarbazone, 238
Acetyl chloride, 47, 106, 108
Acetylene;
(1-cyclohexen-l-yl)
clopenten-1-yl)-, 20, 21
Adhesives,
18, 26, 32, 110, 154, 172,
202
plasticizer for, 56
for pressure-sensitive tape, 176
(1-cy-
dibenzoyl-, 94
Acetylenedicarboxylic acid, 28, 30, 228
Acetylene group, 20, 180
Acetylenes; dialkenyl-, 21
Acid chlorides, 29, 44, 47-60
for safety glass, 110
Adipenic acid, 214
Adrenalin, manufacture, 178
on polymerization, 24
Alanine, esters, 214
Alcohols, 58, 64-67, 170, 175
Air, effect
Acids, heterocyclic, 236
aliphatic, 64, 65
saturated, 56
amino, 167
unsaturated, 246
Acidulent, 172, 178
polyhydric, 18, 68, 176, 177
unsaturated, 66, 67
Aconitic acid, acetyl-, triethyl ester, 32
Acrylic acid, 120, 246, 247
Aldehyde dicarboxylic
acid, esters, 214
0-aryloyl-, 74, 88
Aldol condensation, 55
Alkanes; diketo-, 79, 84
0-benzoyl-, 59, 74-76, 88-91, 168
Alkanetetracarboxylic acids, 206
253
Anethole, 171, 194, 196
Alkenediols, 80, 82
tetraaralkyl-, 80
Anhydroacetonebenzils bimolecular,
tetraaryl-, 80
170, 200, 201
Aniline, 32, 106, 107, 214
Alkenepolycarboxylic acids, 190
Alkenoic acids hydroxy-, 86
N-alkadienyl-, 96, 146
N-benzylidene-, 140, 141
N-cinnamylidene-, 140
Alkoxides, 32, 34, 65, 69, 71-73, 162
Alkyl chlorides, 28, 40, 41
Alkyl disulfides, 244
p-chloro-, 161
Alkylenyl group, 65-12, 40
Alkylmagnesium bromides, 86
Alkyl reagent, 78
N-(2,6-dihydro-2-oxo-5-furylidene)p-methoxy-, 108
2-ethyl-2-hexylidene-, 146, 147
Allylmagnesium chloride, 205
Aluminum, cleaning
oxidation
of,
Aluminum
agent, 178
172
chloride, anhydrous, 33, 50,
88-95
58,
N-hexenylidene-, 140
Anils, 46, 107, 109
Anisaldehyde azine, 136
Anisole; methyl-, 92
Anthracene,
Amides, 102, 104, 110, 166, 222
Amination, complete, 116
Amine
32
;
9,10-dihydro-, 16, 17
9-phenylmethyl-, 10
diols, 166
Amines,
16, 17,
9,10-endo-a,/3-succinic anhydride
Anthranil, 152
94, 107, 112, 113, 117, 119, 121,
124, 214, 244
N-alkylfurfurylidene-, 105
C-phenyl-, 152
Anthranilic acid; N-benzylidene-, 140
Anthrone; 9-methylene-, 16
aryl-, 107, 112
Antidote for poisons, 220
alkyl-, 112
dimenthylolalkyl-, 120
heterocyclic, 118, 119
Anti-gelling agent, 172
Antioxidants, 182
Antipyrine, 120
hydroxy-, 143
hydroxyalkyl-, 110
Apple oil, manufacture, 178
Argentometry, absorption indicator
hydroxyaryl-, 112
methylolalkylaryl-, 120
Arsenicals, 56
tertiary, 120, 121
Amino
Amino
Amino
for,
180
acids, 72, 98, 144, 168
Aryl vinyl compounds,
alcohols, 168
Asparagine, 114, 115
5, 14,
26
group, 112, 126, 132, 144, 166,
236
N/3-methylene derivative, 114
Aspartamic acids; N,N'-dimethyl-, 116
affinity for carbonyl, 98, 101, 105, 107,
Aspartamic acids, 114
dl-N,N',N"-trimethylAspartamide
111, 112, 115,
117,
123, 125, 127,
129, 131, 133, 135, 139, 146, 222
116, 117
of amides, 144
Aspartamides, 112, 114, 116, 117
in hydrazine, 126
Aspartanil; N-hydroxy-, 142
phenyl-, 44
secondary, 104, 112
Aminothiol acids, 222
Ammonia,
32, 34, 38, 96,
98-105, 110,
111, 114, 115, 244
Ammonium
Amyl
salts,
Aspartic acid, 98, 99, 114, 138
N-alkyl-, 104
a -anilino-, bis ( 1-phenylhydrazide) ,
124, 125
quaternary
intramolecular, 120
mercaptan, 221
carbamyl-, 98, 138
esters of, 118
Analysis, chemical reagent for, 56
fumarylbis-, 48, 98
254
Aspartic acid, 0-hydroxy-, 38
N-(methoxybenzoyl)-, 144
Benzene, p-dimethoxy-, 92
l,2-dimethoxy-4-propenyl~, 196
ethyl-, 10
N-methyl-, 112, 113
isopropyl-, 10
diethyl ester, 117
methylamide, 116
l-methoxy-4-propenyl-, 196
propenyl-, substituted, 32
purification of, 12
j8-monoethyl ester, 114
N-substituted, 112
Benzenediazonium chloride; p-chloro-,
N-toIyl-, 144
161
Aspartic anhydride; N-acyl-, 144
N-benzoyl-, 96, 144, 145
Benzenesulfinic acid, 231
Benzene thiol; o-amino-, 236-238
Aspartimide N-a-dianilino-, 128
Aspartyl lactams, 100
;
boxylic acid; 2,4-diethyl-7-oxo-6phenyl-, 146, 147
2,4-dimethyl-7-oxo-, 146
Azetodiindole-6-a-butenoic acid; 5a,10b,
10c,ll-tetrahydro-7-oxo-, 150
Benzo [ 1 ,2-a,3,4-a' ] -diacenaphthalene7,8-dicarboxylic
diethyl
acid ;
ester,
1-carb97,
154,
155
Azobenzene, 158
Bacteriocide, 56, 114, 138, 152, 220
Baking powder, ingredients, 178
Barium
chloride, 32, 33
Benzofuran; 1,2-diphenyl-, 186
anhydride
Benzofurans; dihydro-, 94
Benzoic acid, formation of, 208
phenyl ester, 82
Benzoic anhydride, as a dehydrochloronating agent, 32
Benzoin, 202
Benzophene, 34
4-Benzopyrancarboxylic
30
acid ;
Batteries, ingredient for dry, 178
Benzopyrrole ; a-methyl-, 150
3-Benzothiamorpholine-2-acetic
236, 237
Beer, clarifying agent, 178
Benzaldehyde, azine,
96,
phenylhydrazone,
135, 149
1,2-Benzanthracene, 16
Benzoyl chloride, 214
Benzoyloxy compounds, 208
Benzoyl peroxide, 5, 24, 25,
allyl-,
Benzyl alcohol; 3-er-butyl-6-hydroxy5-methyl-, 170, 184, 185
7a,8,9,l 0,1 1,11 a-hexahydro-
Benzyl amine, 214
7-oxo-, 204
Benzene,
16, 50, 88-91,
27, 52, 53,
as dehydrochlorinating agent, 32
56
7/f-Benz [de] anthracene-8-carboxylic
acid ;
acid,
171, 208, 209
Benz[ a] anthracene; methyl-, 55
8,9,1 1-trimethyl-,
4-oxo-,
l,4,2#-Benzothiazine-2-acetic acid; 3,4dihydro-3-oxo-, 216, 236, 237
136, 137, 148,
149
oxime, 144, 145
95
Benzyl azide,
156, 157
Benzylmagnesium
chloride,
80,
86
tert-butyl-, 4, 10
Biallyl, 6
chloro, 52
200
Bicyclo[2.2.1]-2,5-heptadienes, 94
o-dibenzoyl-, 94
Bicyclo[2.2.1]-5-heptene-2,3-dicarboxylic anhydride, 12
cleavage
of,
w-dimethoxy-, 92
186
Beckmann rearrangement,
144
240,
4,5-Benzofuraudicarboxylic
3a,4,5,6-tetrahydro-,
Azincs, 96, 137, 148, 149
amyl-,
anhydride,
241
Azides, 155, 157
2,3-Aziridinedicarboxylic
tri-
1,3,5-Benzenetricarboxylic acid,
methyl ester, 198
6-AzabicycIo [3 ,2 .1 ] -3-oetene-8-car-
255
84,
1,2,3-Butanetricarboxylic acid;
Bicyclo[2.2.2]-5-oetene-3,4,7,8-tetracar-
boxylic dianhydride
ethoxy-, 188
3-Butanoic acid; 4-(p-methoxyphenyl)-, 56
Bicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octcne-2,3-dicarboxylic
anhydride
1-Butene; 1,4-diphenyl, 26
2-Butene-l ,4-diol
1 ,1 ,4,4-tetrapheny 1-,
7-isopropyl-7-
methyl-, 18, 19
82, 83
Bicyclo[2.2.2]-7-octene-2,3,5,6-tctra-
3-Butene-2-one; 4-phenyl-, 202
3-Buten-l-ol; l-(l-naphthyl)-, 205
cis-Butenoid configuration, 42
Butylmagnesium bromide, 86
carboxylic dianhydride; 7-car-
bomethoxy-, 198
l-methyl-7,8-diphenyl-, 200, 201
Bicyclol2.2.2]-7-octenc-2,3,5,6,7-penta-
Butyric acid; 7-hydroxy-/3,7,7triphenyl-, 82
carboxylic 2,3,5,6-dianhydride
methyl ester, 171, 198, 199
pentamethyl
/3,7,7-triphenyl-, lactone, 82, 83
ester, 198
polyanhydrides,
Bicyclopolycarboxylic
198
Carbamides, 139
Carbamyl
acids,
Bicyclopyrrolidonecarboxylic
146
azide, 97, 154, 155
"Garble Anhydride/' 12
Bicyclotetracarboxylic acids; alkyldi-
Carbinol; a-naphthyl
phenyl-, 200
Biphenyl, 78
Carbinols; a-allylaryl-, 170
arylalkenyl-, 204, 205
Biphenyl compounds, 12
Carbon
allyl-,
dioxide, 144, 163, 171, 198, 244,
Carbon monoxide,
Bispyrrolidine compounds, 136
50, 144, 170, 171,
200, 201, 215
Bisulfite ion, 226
Carbon
230
tetrachloride, 29, 52, 53
Bitumen products, 56
Carbonyl bridge, cleavage
Bleach, for food products, 56
liberant, 178
Carboxyl groups,
Blueprint paper, ingredient
Bromine,
170,
for, 178
170
236
cyclic, 42
160,
176,
178, 202, 203, 206, 207,
215, 220, 244, 245, 251
Cathartics, 250
42
Cellulose acetate, hydrolyzing aid, 172
Butadienes; 1-acyloxy-, 202
1-aryl-, 204
Cellulose polymaleates, 176
Cements, 32
chloro-, 110
Ceramics, marking of, 178
Chemicals, petroleum, 26
photographic, 26
2,2-Butanedicarboxylic acid; 4,4-dibenzoyl-1-phenyl-, 94
1,4-Butanediol ; 2-amino-l, 1,4,4- tetra-
Chlorine, 30, 31-33, 39
phenyl-, 98
l,4-diphenyl-2-piperino-, 94
2,3-Chromandicarboxylic acid, 170
1,2,4-triphenyl-,
6-ter-butyl-8-methyl-, 184, 185
74,
Cinchomeronic acid; 5-hydroxy-6-
1,2,3,4-Butanetetracarboxylic
acid-,
methyl-, 56
12
1-phenyl-, esters, 208
1 ,2,3,4-Tetrahydro-3-hydroxy-6-
methyl-2-oxo-, 32
acid, aromatic esters, 248, 249
1,1,4-Butanetricarboxylic acid; 2-dicar-
boxymethyl-,
of,
68, 72, 86, 96, 98, 164,
Catalysts, 24, 25, 27, 53, 65, 67, 72, 106,
substitution, 56, 180
1,3-Butadiene, 13, 32
l-chloro-3-methyl-,
222,
Carboxylic acids,
108, 190, 198, 220, 244
1,4-Butanedione;
78, 79
205
246-249
Bis-adducts, 14, 42, 196-201
Bisulfites, 216, 228,
4-cy-
ano-, trimethyl ester, 162, 163
1,5-di-
ester,
214
Cinnamic
256
Claisen condensation, 59, 68, 69
Coatings, 18, 24, 26, 176, 202
hydride, 12, 13
waterproof, 12
4-Cyclohexene-l ,2-dicarboxy lie anhy-
Collidine, 120
drides ;
Color stable coatings, 24
242
Complex compounds,
70,
72,
88,
90,
92
for, 172,
impregnant for, radio, 172
Condiment, 172
Conjugated bond, activation
Conjugation, test
Copolymers,
Cyclohexenes, 94
178
hexachloro-, 42
octachloro-5-ethylidene-, 42
240
Cyclopentadienones, 200
for, 12
14, 18, 26, 27, 66, 106, 174,
192,
1,2-anhydride; 6-hydroxy-, 8-lactone methyl ester, 198
Cyclopentadiene
of,
194, 202
Cyclopentanecarboxylic acid
ethyl ester, 34, 207
Cyclopentanesuccinic acid
2-oxo-, ester, 34, 206
of chloromaleic esters, 32
hetero, 202
2-oxo-,
1-carboxy-
3-carboxy-2-oxo, triethyl ester, 206
with methacrylate, 26
resinous, 9
1,2,3-Cyclopentanetricarboxylic acid; 4-
sulfonated vinyl, 26
with vinyls, 26
Cottonseed, preservation
Coumalic
alkylmercapto-4-methyl-,
4-Cyclohexene-l,2,3,5-tctracarboxylic
Condenser, electrolyte
176,
an-
cis-4-Cyclohexene-l ,2-dicarboxy lie
cyano-5-oxo-, trimethyl ester,
162, 164, 165
of,
106
acid, 172
esters, 198 199
Cyclopentanone 2-cyano-2,3,5-tricarbomethoxy-, 164
;
Coumalins, 198
Cyclopentanonecarboxylic acid,
207
Coumarin, 172
4//-Cyclopentata]phenanthrene-15,17-
6-methyl-, 170, 182, 183
Cresols, 170, 180, 182, 183
Cross-linking, 166
dione-,14
15-Cyclopenta [a ] phenanthrene-6,7,1 1
12-tetracarboxylic acid, 20
Crotonaldehyde acetate, 12
dro-, 20, 21
2-Cyclopenten-l-ono
7-hydroxy-, 59
2,5-dimethyl-4hydroxy-3,4-diphenyl-, 200
Cyclopropane, 94
;
7-hydroxy-7,7-diphenyl-, 50
Crysene, 16
Cyclopropanedicarboxylic acids, 158
Cumene, 10
Cyanamide, 234
Cymene,
1,2,3-Cyclopropanetricarboxylic acid, 30
10
Cyclic oxymethylene, derivative, 214
Cyclization, 50, 162, 164, 182, 208
Cystene, 222
2,4-Cyclohexadiene-l,4-dicarboxylic
1,2,5,7,9-Decapentaene
anhydride
1,2,3,4,5,6,7,11,12,13,15,16-dodecahy-
Crotonic acid; 7,7-diethyl-7-hydroxy-,
78, 86, 87
esters,
3,5-diethoxy-, 188, 189
Cyclohexaneacetic acid; 3,6-dicarboxy2-oxo-, triethyl ester, 206
Decarboxylation,
12
3,4-dimethoxyphenyl-,
204
12, 97,
150, 154, 160,
249
Decyl chlorides, 40, 41
Deemulsifying agents, 18, 176
Dehydration, 80, 86, 87, 110,
cis-3-a-naphthyl-, 204, 205
3-piperonyl-, 204
1,10-diphenyl-,
162, 164, 182, 196, 198, 244, 246-
Cyclohexanesuccinic acid, 76
cw-4-Cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic acid,
26
182, 198,
204
Dehydrochlorination, 32, 33, 160
257
Diolefms, non-conjugated, 170
Diol synthesis, 84
Dehydrogenation, in presence of
nitrobenzene, 12
with sulfur, 196
Dioxane, 29, 52
Dentifrice, ingredient in, 172
Detergents, synthetic,
Dispersing
172
10, 26, 40, 56,
6,
chloride, 245
6-Dodecen-5-one
Diacenaphtho [ 1 ,2-fr ,r>2'-on thiophene,
186, 217, 240, 241
retardents,
8-butyl-8-hydroxy-,
84,86
Diamines, 112
Drugs,
1,5-Diazabicyclo [3.3.0] octane-2 ,3,6,7-
Drying
dianhydride
tetracarboxylic
fire
Disuccinic acids, 186
Dithocarbamates, 244
64, 72, 112, 154, 178
Deuterium
for
agent,
168
56, 68, 104,
oils, 32,
192
substitutes, 24, 66
4,8-diphenyl-, 136
Diazo compounds, 97, 158
Dye-fixing agent, 202
Dyeing aid, 56, 178, 250
Diazonium
Dyes,
chlorides, 97, 160, 161
Dibenzanthracene, tumors from, 76
Dibenzyl; 10 a,a'-dibromo-, 248
10, 12, 56, 112, 230, 236,
248
for color photography, 26
oil-soluble, 56
Dichlorophosphates, 44
Dicobalt octacarbonyl, 215
Effervescent
3,3'-Dicoumarin, 56
Elastomers, ester type, 56
Dieckmann condensation, 206
Diels-Alder reactions, 5, 12-21, 26, 32,
42, 94, 106, 136, 146, 152, 170, 186-
Emulsifying agent,
240
salts,
acidulent for, 172
40,
112, 172,
Dienecarboxylic acids, polycyclic, 191
3,6-Epoxy-4-cyclohexene-l,2-dicarboxylic acid, 186
Dienes, conjugated,
192
Ester gums, 190
195, 198, 217,
Equilein, 56
13, 19, 32, 94, 190,
conjugated heterocyclic, 186, 187
fatty, 4, 192
Etching solution, ingredient, 178
formation of conjugated, 192
non-conjugated,
9,
Ethane
192
removal from benzene, 12
5,
l,2-bis(benzylideneamino)-,
136
1 ,2-bis (4-methyl-2-thiazoly 1 ) -, 110
hexachloro-, 52
hexaphenyl-, 5, 23, 52, 62
20, 21
Diethylene glycol, monomaleate,
ferrous salt of, 176
nitro-, 169
Diethylzinc, 74
Diindolemaleic acid, 150
Diisobutylene, 26
9,10-Ethanoanthracene-ll,12-dicar-
boxylic anhydride; 9,10-dihy-
Diketones, 59, 84, 85
dro-, 16, 17
1,4-Dike tones, uasaturated, 94
3,6-Ethano-4-hexene-l,2-dicarboxylic
anhydride; 7-isopropyl-, 18
Dilead; hexaphenyl-, 22, 58, 63
Dilevulinic acid, 150
Dimerization,
200
174-177, 250
Esters,
cyclic, 5, 190
Dienynes,
226
Enamels, alkyd, 172
Energy, 244-251
55,
88,
97,
162,
188,
Ethanol, 72, 101, 115, 175, 189
dibenzoyl-, 94
l,2-dibenzoyl-2-chloro-, 94
Dimorphism, 50
l,4-Ethanonaphthalene-5 ,6,9,10-
Di(l,8-naphthalene)phthalic anhydride,
240
tetracarboxylic dianhydride ;
Dinaphthalenethiophene, 241
dimethoxy-8-phenyl-, 196, 197
1 ,4,4a,5,6,7-hexahydro-2,3-
258
Fatty
3,10a(3)-Ethanophenanthrene-8,ll,12tricarboxylic anhydride;
4,4a,4b,
non-conjugated, 192, 193
esters,
Ferric chloride, 126
5,6,7,8,8a,9,10-decahydro-2-iso-
Fibers, synthetic, 24, 176, 202
propyl-4b,8~dimethyl-, methyl
Films, 202
birefringent, 250
ester, 190, 191
Ether; bis-7-(butyrolactone)-, 214
methyl vinyl, 202
Fire extinguisher, fluids for, 178
Fire retardent, dispersing agent for,
172
propenylphenyl, 26, 171, 194, 195
Flavanthrene, manufacture
Ethers, arylsuccinic anhydride, 92
Ethyl acetate, 14
Ethylene,
5, 26,
of,
178
Flavoring agent, 172
27
Flour, bleaching
Fluorene, 10
bis(4-phenoxybenzoyl)-, 48
2-bromo-l,l-diphenyI-, 43
178
of,
Jrans-dibcnzoyl-, 94
9-anisylidene-, 26
9-benzylidene-, 26
Fluoresceins, 180
l-(3,4-dimethoxyphenyl)-l-phenyl-,
Fly sprays, 194
derivatives, 27
2-furyl-, 186
Foaming agent, 110
Food wrappers, 18
l-phenyl-l-(3,4-dimethoxyphenyl)-,
14, 42
Formaldehyde, 110, 162, 176
Formulas, type, explanation of symbols,
197
Ethyleno glycol, 176
Ethylene group, activation
4
of,
Free radicals,
98
5, 10, 22,
192
Friedel-Craft reaction, 74, 78, 88-95
Fruit preservative, 178
addition to, 54, 216
substituted, 26
Fuel, gelating agent for solid, 178
Fulgides, 56
Ethylene oxide; dibenzoyl-, 94
Ethylene oxide group, 36
Fulvenes, 94
6-Fulvenol ; 1 ,4-dibenzoyl-2,6-diphenyl-,
Ethylenes, diaryl, 14, 196
l,l-diaryl-2,2-dihalo-,42
94
diaryloyl-, 55, 94
Fumaramic
dibenzoyl-, substituted, 48
dimethoxyaryl-, 170
acids, 104
110, 111, 116
Fumaramide,
hetero-substituted, 202
32
a-anilino-,
Fumaric
p-methoxyaryl-, 171, 196, 197
2,3-Ethyleneiminedicarboxylic acid
1-carbamyl-, diethyl ester, 154
64,
acid, 24, 30, 31, 35, 48, 49, 60,
99,
103,
173,
175,
182,
183,
210, 228, 230, 234, 235, 236, 245,
250, 251
Ethylenesulfide-a,/3-dicarboxylic acid,
aromatic
diethyl ester, 218
Ethyleneureadicarboxylic acids, esters,
154
Ethylmagnesium bromide, 85-87
esters,
biscyanomethyl
248
ester, 162
chloro-; diethyl ester, 32
diethyl ester, 25, 69, 71, 83, 101, 119,
Ethylzinc iodide, 74
155, 156, 174, 175, 179, 203, 210,
Explosives, binder for, 24
215, 219
dihydrazide, 132, 133
Fabrics,
imparting
crease
resistance,
ester, 111, 133, 156, 157, 161,
diphenylacyl-, lactone, 88
Fatty acids, preparation of branched
chain, 86
separation
dimethyl
162, 163, 165, 212
154
diphenyl
of, 12
ester,
249
esters, 132, 160, 164, 174,
259
250
Hat
Fumaric
acid, glycol ester, 176
ozonide, diethyl ester, 210
salts,
l,5-Hexadiene-3-yne; 2,5-dimethyl-, 20
1,2,3,6-Hexanetetracarboxylic acid, 206
230
silver salt, 22
Fumaric
178
sizes, ingredient,
Heat, 244, 248-250
acids, halo-,
tetraethyl ester, 206, 207
30
aryl-, 160
Hexaphenyldilead,
Fumaronitrile, 110
Fumaryl azide, 132
1,3,5-Hexatriene
Fumaryl bisaspartic acid, 48
Fumaryl carbamide, 132
Fumaryl chloride, 29, 48, 49, 94,
Fumaryl dihydrazide, 132
Fumaryl peroxide, 48
63
phenyl-, 86
2-Hexenal; 2-ethyl-, 146
3-Hexcne-2,6-diol
Hormones,
methyl
ester, 138, 139
ureide, 138
Hydrazide,
3-acetyl-2,5-dimethyl-, 56
2,3-dihydro-2,2,3,5-tetraphenyl-,
sex, 14
5-Hydantoinacetic acid, 98, 138
Furan, 170, 186, 187
5,5-dichloro-2,5-dihydro-2-oxo-,
2,5-dibenzy 1-1,6-
diphenyl-, 86
95, 162
Fungicides, 30, 72, 106, 172, 178, 224,
234
50
82
2,5-dihydro-2,2,5,5-tetraphenyl-, 80-82
5-hydroxy-2,2,3,5-tetraphenyl-,
2-isopropyl-5-methyl-, 186
62,
2,5-dibenzyl-l,6-di-
cyclic, 130
Hydrazine; phenyl-, 32, 124-129
Hydrazine dichloride, 238
128, 131, 133
Hydrazine hydrate,
Hydrazines, 124-133
82
cyclic,
130
125,
Hydrazonrs, 132, 134, 135
aeyl-,
tetrahydro-5-hydroxy-2,2,3,5-tetra-
134,
148
Hydrindenotclracarboxylic acid
1-methyl-, 208
phenyl-, 82
2-vinyl-, 186
3-Furanol; 1,4-diphenyl-, acetate, 94
Furanones, 94
Hydrobromi(j acid,
34, 196, 244
Hydrocarbons, 4-27, 32, 40
Furans; 2,5-dihydroimidooxo-, 108
alkylaromatic,
4, 10, 11
aromatic, 5, 14-17, 20, 32, 89, 91, 95,
248, 249
substituted, 94, 97, 186
2,3,4-Furantricarboxylic acid; 2,3-dihy-
conjugated, unsaturuted, 12-15
dro-5-phenyl-, 30
isomoric, 40
non-conjugated monocyclic, 8
Gelatin, desserts, 172
polynuclear, 16, 17, 20
substituted aromatic, 10
powders, 172
substitute, 26
Germicide,
56, 114, 138, 152,
underchlorinated, 40
220
Glycerol, 32
vinylaromatic,
Glycol, 176, 177
Glycol maleate polyester, 246
Glyoxylic acid, 212, 213
a-hydroxy-, 179
Grignard reagents, 54, 58, 59, 74-88
Glyoxylonitrile
Growth substance,
98, 114,
220
14,
15
Hydrochloric acid, 35, 244
Hydrogen, 54-57, 215
Hydrogenation, dimeric, 94
Hydrogen bromide, cleavage
of, 29, 42,
50
Hydrogen
chloride, cleavage of, 41, 42,
44-46, 49, 50
Halo
Hydrogen cyanide, 97, 162-165
Hydrogen fluoride, anhydrous, 204
Hydrogen peroxide, 94, 170, 179, 220
Hydrogen sulfide, 244
acids, 28, 35
oxy-, 37, 39
Halogen compounds, 28-51
Halogens, 28-33, 39
260
Hydrogen
sulfide,
cleavage
Isomers, 28, 30, 36, 38, 50, 92, 94, 108,
114, 115, 144, 145, 154, 158, 172
240,
of,
241
Hydroiodic acid,
196,
190, 204, 234, 244, 250, 251
244
Isopropenyl acetate, 202
Hydrophillic groups, 100
Hydrosulfuric acid, 232
Hydroxamic
Isopropylcadmium bromide, 77
Isopropylmagnesium bromide, 76
acid; hydrazinomaleyl-,
Isoquinolines, 120, 121
30
Hydroxylamine,
94,
N-alkyltetrahydro-, 120
214
Isosafrole, 26, 194-196
phenyl-, 106, 142, 143
p-vinyl-, 14
Isoprene, 12
Itaconic acid; 7-anilino-, esters, 214
Itaconic acids, 55, 56
Hydroxylamines, substituted, 142
Hydroxyl groups, 112, 166, 170
Hypobromite oxidation, 114
Hypobromous
acid, 6, 186
Hypochlorous
acid, 28, 38, 39
Jellies,
acidulent for, 172
Ice cream, 172
Ketene, diethylacetal,
Ices, 172
4,5-Imidazolidenedicarboxylic
acid
2-
Keto
188, 189
acids, 78, 88, 90, 206
unsaturated, 88
oxo-, diethyl ester, 154, 155
Imides, products from, 140
Imino group, 134
Keto esters, 32,
Keto group, 68
Iminotetracarboxylic acid, ester, 102
Ketone,
58, 68, 69,
206
aryl-, 88
206
Indan, 10
cyclic,
Indene, 14
3-hydroxy-2,3 ,3-tripheny Ipropy
phenyl, 82
3-Indenecarboxylic acid;
diphenyl-, 50
2-bromo-l,l~
Ketoolefinic acids, 74
Ketotricarboxylic esters, 68
144, 145
Indole, 150
N-a-dimcthyl-, 150
Ketoximes,
a-methyl-, 150
3-Indolebutyric acid; a-3-indyl-7-oxo-,
150
Lachrymator, 104
Indoles, 150, 186
Lactam, 100
3-Indolesuccinic acid, 150
Lactones,
Ink, 12, 18
Latex, coagulant, 178
Lathering agent, 110
Insecticide, 72, 106, 110, 138, 152, 168,
174,
178, 224,
226
Lacquer, 26, 56, 202
Laundry
Intoxication, treatment of chronic, 250
6,
50
sour,
178
Laxative, 172
lodo group, 34
Leather-processing agent, 6
Isobenzofuranes, 240
Isobenzothiophene, 240
Levopimaric acid, 190
methyl ester, 191
1,3-diphenyl-, 240
Levulinic acid, 56
1,3,5,6-tetraphenyl-, 240
Light, effect of, 202, 220, 244, 246, 247
Isobutylene, 26
Isocrotinic
Lightening arrestor, electrolyte
7,7-dichloro-7-hydroxy-, lactone, 29, 48, 50, 51
acid;
Linoleic acid; methyl ester, 192, 193
mono- and polyadducts
Isodehydroacetic acid, 198
Isomerization, 18, 54, 192, 238, 244, 250,
251
261
for, 172,
178
Linoleum, 18
Lubricant, stabilizers, 150
of,
192, 193
Maleic acid, mixed sebasic and
Lutidine, 120
1,3*
propanediol ester, 176
Malamic acids,
Maleamic acid,
N-alkyl-,
34, 45
monoisoquinolinium
104, 105
monomethyl
104
monooctyl
salt, 121
ester, 174
ester,
227
/3-amino-, 114
derivatives, 134
1,9-nonanediol bis(acid ester), 176
pentaerythritol polyester, 176
N-dodecyl-, 104
preparation
salts, 230
N,N',N"-(2-hydroxy-s-phcnenyl)tris-,
sodium
122
N-phenyl-, 108
151
of,
223
salt, 57,
sulfo-, salts, 228,
229
triphenyllead acid salt, 62
Maleic acid ozonide, diethyl ester, 210,
211
N-substituted, 105
Malcanil, 106, 107
substituted, 106
Maleanilic acid, 45, 47, 104, 140, 141,
146, 147
Maleic acids; halo-, 30
esters,
32
Maleic anhydride,
N-alkoxy-, 109
7,
9-17, 19-23, 27, 33,
p-methoxy-, 108, 109
41_43, 48, 50, 58, 62, 63, 74, 75,
substituted, 106, 108, 114
79, 80, 84, 86-90, 93, 94, 107,
p-(2-thiazolyl)sulfamyl-, 104
Maleanilide, 44, 104
Maleanilium dichlorophosphate,
44, 45,
113-
141,
144-150, 152,
167,
174,
176-177, 179,
188,
189,
192-202, 204,
115,
129,
135,
153,
166,
180,
181,
205, 210, 216, 224, 228-230, 238-243
104
Maleate ion, 226
Maleic acid, 24, 48,
chloro-, 32, 33
derivatives of, 74
50, 51, 60, 61, 68, 127,
p-chlorophenyl-, 160
sulfo-, 216, 228
131, 151, 182, 183, 187, 194, 202,
212, 213, 222, 224, 225, 230-237,
Maleic anhydrides;
halo-, 32
244-247, 250, 251
ammonium
salt,
105
aryl-, 160
benzylidenehydrazide, 148, 149
Maleic anhydride ozonide, 210
l-benzylidine-2-phenylhydrazide, 134,
135
Maleirnide,
110
105,
N-anilino-, 128, 129
active diamyl ester, 174
a-anilino-N-phenyl-, 32, 142, 143
a-bromo-N-(p-tolyl)-, 30
a,/3-dichloro-, 56
derivatives, preparation of, 32
N,N',N"-(2-hydroxy-s-phenenyl)-
bis(triphenyllead) acid ester, 62
chloro-, esters, 32
dibutyl ester, 221
tris-,
ftsym-N-Cp-hydroxyphenyl)-, 112
asyra-N-Cp-methoxyphenyl)-, 108, 128
diethyl ester, 52, 53, 72, 77, 117, 139,
174, 179, 185, 207
dimethyl-, sodium
dimethyl
salt,
122
N-methyl-, 104
54
N-phenyl-, 44, 106, 142,
Maleimides, 106
ester, 52, 65, 72, 73, 81, 85,
169, 208, 209-212
143, 146
N-amino-, 128
esters, 84, 86, 156, 160, 171, 174, 202,
N-aryl-, 106
250
N-arylamino-, 128
glycol polyester, 176, 177
N-substituted, 104, 106
2-maleamyl-2-methyl-l,3-propylene-,
polymer, 166, 168
Malein chloride, 50
Maleinhydrazide benzal-, 148
mannitol-sorbitol polyesters, 176
262
Maleinized
oils, 4,
Mirror, manufacture, 178
192
Maleins, 180
Mouth
Maleonitrile, 110
Muconic
Maleyl chloride, 48
Musk,
wash, ingredient
in,
dimethyl
acid,
synthetic,
172
ester,
12
56
a-bromo, 50
Naphthacene, 16
a-Naphthaldehyde, 205
asym-a, /3-dibromo-, 50
unsymmetrical, 50
Naphthalene, 16
Maleyl group, 1
N,N'-Maleyl hydrazide, 130
Malic acid, 170, 172, 173, 244
a- or
2-methyl-, 10
61
tetrahydro-, 10
acetothio, 224
aurothio-, 34
1,2,3,4-tetramethyl-, 10, 16
-chloro-, 28, 38, 39
1,2,4,-triphenyl-,
j9-chloromercuri-, disodium
salt,
60
1-vinyl-, 5,
14,
82
15,
16,
26,
acid, diethyl ester, 55, 214
esters, 32, 59, 70-72, 94,
3,4-Naphthalenedicarboxylic acid
1-phenyl-, 42
214
ethyl-, diethyl ester, 71
anhydride
Mercaptans, 216, 220-222, 244
acyl-, 222
methylenedioxy-, 194
esters,
as catalysts, 220
3-metbyl-,6,7-
194
Naphthalenetetracarboxylic
anhydrides; hexahydro-, 20
202
Methane; chlorotriphenyl-, 22
1-Naphthalenemethanol
diazo-, 158-160
2-Naphthol, 180
diazodiphenyl-, 158
diphenyl-, 10
Nitric acid, 179, 244
a-allyl-,
205
Nitriles, 59
tetranitro-, 190
tetrahydro-2,7-dimethyl-3,3a,5,6tetraphenyl-, 201
Nitrobenzene, 12
Nitrogen, cleavage
anhydride;
compounds
1,2,3,4-
tetrahydro-, 14
of, 97, 156, 158, 160,
161
1 ,4-Methanonaphthalene-2,3-
Methoxy
Neovitamin, 12
4,7-Methanoindene-l,8-dione ; 3a,4,7,7a-
dicarboxylic
1-phenyl-, 42
polish ingredient for 178
esters,
Naphthalenedicarboxylic anhydrides
dihydro-, substituted, 32
Metallic compounds, 58-95
Metals, coloring of, 178
Methacrylic acid,
l,2,3,4-tetrahydro-3-methyl-6,7methylenedioxy-, 194, 195
Mercaptotricarboxylic acids, 222
Mercuric acetate, 58, 60, 61
salts,
196,
1,2-Naphthalenedicarboxylic
Mannitol, 179
Mercury
194,
204
172
Malonic
derivatives,
l-methoxy-4-propenyl-, 196
j9-acetomercuri-, mercuric salt, 60,
salts,
-cyclopentenyl-, 14, 196
1,2,3,5,6,7-hexahydro-,
containing, 96-169
Nitrogen atom, alpha
Nitrous acid, 132
toC~N-,
134
1,9-Nonanediol, bis (acid maleate), 176
substituents, 196
Methylamine, 117
3,6-Octanediol; 3,5,6-triethyl-, 84
3,6-Octanedione; 5-ethyl-, 84, 85
N-benzylidene-, 140
N-cinnamylidene-, 140
a-Methylene group,
4,
6,
55,
192
Michael condensation,
68,
72,
3-Octanone; 5,6-diethyl-6-hydroxy-, 86
1,3,5,7-Octatetraene;
59, 71-73
Oil additives, 56
263
1,8-diphenyl-,
56
18, 19
Oil emulsions, 6
a-Phellandrene,
Oils, maleinized, 4, 192
Phenanthrene, 16
Olefins, 4, 7, 12, 40
9-vinyl-,
14
Oleic acid; methyl ester, adducts, 192
Opium extracts, 178
1,2-Phenanthrenedicarboxylic acid, 14
vinyltetrahydro-, 204
Ore, flotation, 178
Osazones, 136
cis-l ,2-Phenanthrenedicarboxylic
dride ;
2,3-Phenazinedicarboxylic anhydride ;
1,2,3,4,5,10-hoxahydro-, 152, 153
boxylic acid; 5-bromo-6-hydroxy-, lactone, 186
7-Oxabicyclo[2.2.1]-5-heptene-2,3-dicarboxylic acid, 186, 187
Phenol, 82, 170, 181
oamino-, 112, 180
p-amino-, 112
Oxalacetic acid, 172
Oxalic acid, 212, 213
2,4,6-triamino-, 123
acid, benzyl ester,
benzylammonium
salt,
2,4,6-trimaleimido-,
156
Phenolmalein,
appar-
Phenyllithium, 80, 83
ent, 55
Phenylmagncsium bromide,
Oximes, 96, 144, 145
Oxygen, compounds containing, 170-215
inhibition by, 220
Ozone,
171,
Phenylzinc chloride,
test, 186
dichloro-, salts, 44, 45
Paraconic acid, 55, 56
7,7-diphenyl-, ethyl ester, 34
Paraffins; nitro-, 97, 168, 169
dye, 88
Pectin, peptizing agent, 178
Penetrating agent, 110
Penicillin manufacture, 98
1,3-Pentadiene;
l-ehloro-3-methyl-,
hexachloro-, 42
42
Phthaleins, 180
Phthalic acid; 3-a-naphthyl-, dimethyl
ester, 204
1,2,3,3-Pentanetetracarboxylic acid,
cis-a-naphthyl-l,2,3,6-cis-tetrahydro-,
204
tetraethyl ester, 70
1-Pentanethiol, 221
Phthalic acids; aryltetrahydro-, 204
Phthalic anhydride, 166
1,2,3-Pentanetricarboxylic acid, 70
as dehydrochlorinating agent, 32
Peracids, 179
Perchloric acid, 244
3,5-diethoxy-l,6-dihydro-, 188
dihydro-, ethers of, 188
Perfumes, 150, 182
"Petrex" acid, 8
Phthalic anhydrides; pyrazinotetrahydro-, 152
"Petrex" resins, 8
distillate,
74, 79
74-76
Phosphorous chlorides, 51
Phosphorous oxychlorides, 45, 104
Phosphorous pentachloride, 29, 48, 51
Phosphorous pentoxide, 106, 108, 110
Phosphorous trichloride, 106
Phosphoryl chloride, 44, 45
Photographic chemicals, 56
Photography, color, 26, 126, 158, 176
Photopaper, ingredient for, 178
Paints, emulsion, 12
Petroleum
59,
Phosphinc; triphenyl-,
Phosphoric acid, 44
210-213
Paint remover, ingredient, 178
Peckmann
123
Phcnyl group, angular, 200
Oxidation, 171, 182, 212, 220, 222
potential,
122,
180, 181
Phenolphthalcin, 170
Oxamide, dibenzyl-, 156
Oxidation-reduction
14,
15
7-Oxabicyclo[2.2.1]-5-heptene-2,3-di-
Oxamic
anhy-
l,2,3,10a-tetrahydro-,
40
tctrahydro-,
12,
Phthalyl chloride,
Pharmaceuticals, 12, 56, 152, 158, 172,
178, 220, 234
a-Picoline,
264
120
146
48,
49
Propargylic acid, 30
Propene, 7
Picramine; 2,4,6-trimaleyl-, 122
Pigment, dispersant, 172
Pimelic acid; 7-nitro-, ester, 168
3,6-Piperazinediacetamide ;
Propionic acid
2,5-dioxo-,
Piperazinedisuccinic acid, 118
(2,4-dimethoxybenzoyl)-/3-(2,4-dimethoxyphenyl)-, 92
0-formyl-, 214
220
a-3-indyl-/3-indylcarbonyl-, 150
7-0x0-, 59
Propionic acids; aroyl-, 56
Platinum black, 244
Polyamines, 32, 110
Propylene, 26
162
1,3-Propylene maleato; poly-2-malo-
amyl-2-methyl-, 167
Protein hardener, 26
Pseudohydantoin acids, 234
Polyenes, conjugated, 5
Polyester amides, 166
Polyesters, 176
Pynunidone, 120
air-drying, 24
Polyethylenesuccinic acid
Pyrazinc; 2,3-dimethyl-, 153
thiolace-
toxy-, polyethyl ester, 202, 203
Polyethylenesuccinic anhydride, 26, 27
Polymalates, 172
Polymerization, 24, 66, 166, 176, 226
emulsion, 24, 203
Polymers,
34
j3-(2,4-dimethoxybcnzoyl)-a-(2,4-dimethoxylphenyl)-, 92, 93
Plastics, 24, 26, 56, 176, 246, 250
nitrites,
88,
79,
78,
0-cyano-, esters, 214
Plasticizers, 6, 12, 18, 26, 56, 66, 70, 168,
Polycarboxylic
cyclic, 164
74,
/3-bromo-/3-ethylsulfonyl-,
220
N-alkyl-, 120
Piperidinesuccinic acid, 118
diethyl ester, 119
174, 178,
a-amino-, esters, 214
/3-benzoyl-a-phenyl-,
90, 91
98, 100, 101, 114
Piperidine, 119, 206,
6, 8,
9,
24, 72, 192, 194,
208
Polymethacrylic acid, 203
2,3-diphcnyl-5,6-dihydro-, 136
Pyrazoles, 94
3-Pyrazolidenecarboxylic acids; 5-oxo-,
124
5-oxo3-phenyl-, 126, 127
Pyrazolinecarboxylic acids, 158
2-Pyrazoline-4,5-dicarboxylic acid, 158,
159
Polyolefins, 4
Pyrazolinos, 94, 158
Polyphenylethylenesuccinates, 26
Polysuccinate allyl, 24
dienol esters, 24
acids;
Pyrazolonecarboxylic
phenyl-,
172
diethylene glycol esters, 24
Pyrazololl,2]pyrazole-l,2,5,6-tetracar-
ethyl, esters 24, 25
boxylic
glycol esters, 24
hexahydro-3,7-diphenyl-, 136, 137
nitroalkyl esters, 24
3,6-Pyridazinedione,
130,
94
1,2-dihydro-,
128,
131
Pyridine, 120, 214, 244
acid; 4-hydroxy-2methyl-, ethyl ester, 214
5-Pyrimidineacetic
Printing assistant, 110
Printing of textiles, 178, 250
1-Propanol
3,6-diphenyl-,
Pyridazine;
Potassium cyanide, 97, 163-165
Potassium ethoxide, 206, 207
1,2,3,5,6,7-
Pyrethrum, 194
Polyvinyl alcohol, 176
Potash, alcoholic, 160
Potassium cyanate, 138
1,3-Propanediol
166, 167
dianhydridc
4-Pyrimidinecarboxylic acid; 5-bromo6-oxo- 114
2-amino-2-methyl-,
Pyrocatechol, 180
Pyrocinchonic anhydride, 56
Z-2-amino-l-w-hydroxy-
phenyl-, 178
Pyrogallol, 180
265
1,2-Pyrone; 2,4-dimethyl-, 198
Resins, for textiles, 110
4-Pyrone, 30
Resonance,
Pyrone compounds,
Pyrrole; a-methyl-, 150, 151
N-methyl-, 150
Pyrrole adducts, 150
2,5-Pyroledipropionic acid; N-methyl-,
150
2,5-Pyrroledisuccinic anhydride, 150
Rooting agents, 150
190
modified, 190
Pyrroles, 12, 97, 150-152, 186
5-pyrrolesuccinic anhydride
150, 151
2-methyl-,
acid
Rubber, maleinized, 26
modifying agent, 106
plasticizer, 55,
synthetic, 24, 32, 110, 178, 226, 246
2,5-dioxo-,
220
substitutes, 18
Pyrrolidine ; 2,5-dioxo-l-phcnyl-3phenylhydroxylamino-, 142
methyl
204
dimethyl ether, 93
Rhodamines, 180
Ring closure, reductive, 168
Roelen reaction, 171, 214, 215
Rosin,
Pyrrole reaction, 84
1-Pyrrolidineacetic
4,
Resorcinol, 180
171, 198, 199
ester, 56
tack-imparting agent, 224
vulcanizing agent, 8
Pyrrolidones; substituted, 168
Rust-inhibiting agents, 6
3-Pyrroline ; 3-anilino-2,5-dioxo-lphenyl-, 142
Salts,
5-Pyrrolinone ;
214
l-benzyl-3-carbethoxy-,
heavy metal, 244
SchhTs base, 96, 140, 141, 146
Sebacic acid, 176
7,-dioxo-, 150
Quinoline; 2-styryl-, 120
Selectivity in copolymerization, 26
Quinone, test, 186
Quinones, 186
Shellac substitutes, 172
Semicarbazide, 84
2,3-dimethyl-, 146, 153
2,3-diphenyl-, 152
Siccatives, 24, 66
Silvering aid, 178
Silver oxide, 179
2-methyl-, 152
Sizes, 176, 178
Quinoxaline, 152
Soap stabilizer, 98
Sodium bisulfite, 149, 226, 227
Sodium chloride; cleavage, 32
Sodium ethoxide, 34, 64, 69, 70,
2-methyl-3-phenyl-, 152
Quinoxalines, 152
Rapogens
for dyeing, 112
Reduction, 20, 82, 168
Resin acids, 190
206,
Resins, 6-10, 12, 24, 26, 32, 56, 66, 68,
70,
104,
127,
136,
140,
166, 172, 190, 202, 220,
148,
158,
138, 139,
221
Sodium maleate, 37, 39, 223
Sodium methoxide, 65, 169
Sodium thiosulfate, 233
Soft drinks, 172
250
Softening agents, 12
Sorbic acid; 7-ethyl-, phenacyl ester,
86, 87
alkyd, 24, 26, 56, 172
alkyd-phenolic, 184
base-exchange, 26
maleic, 176
Steric hindrance, 60
molding, 110
Sterols, elucidation of structure, 20, 190
oil-reactive, 12
Stilbene, 26, 248, 249
derivatives, 248
phenolic, reagent for, 172
salt-like, 136, 140
Stimulant, epithial, 220
Stobbe condensation, 55
soluble infusible, 32
266
Stone,
artificial,
178
Succinic acid,
diazo-, 98
Styrene, 14
w-bromo-, 42
,j8-diarono-,
121, 179, 180
o,-dibromo-, 28,
Succeins, 180
30
dialkyl esters, 70
Succinamic acids; a,/3-diha!o-, 30
Succinamide dithio-, 110
a,/3-dichloro-, 28, 30, 31
Succinanil; a-chloro-, 46
o,j3-dihalo-,
Succinic acid, 55-59, 226
dioxanyl-, dimethyl ester, 52
esters,
30
30
a,jS-diphenoxy-, 30
p-acetamidophenylsulfonyl-, 230
allyloxy-; diallyl ester, 66
disulfo-, 228
2-amino-2-carboxyethylmercapto-,
222
N-dodecyltetrahydroisoquinolinium
dithiocarbethoxy-, 172
amylmercapto dibutyl ester, 220, 221
benzoxazolonesulfonyl-, 230
a-benzoyl-jS-formyl-, diethyl ester,
betaine, 120
epoxy-, 36, 37
ethyl-, ester, 74
ethylmercapto-, 34
214
a-(benzylaminomethylene)-, diethyl
ester, 214
a-formyl-, ethyl ester, 56,
benzylsulfonyl-, 230
a-hydroxyethoxy-, 7-lactone, 172
iminobis-, tetraethyl ester, 102
a,j9-bis(dichloromethylene)-, 52
bis(tetrahydrofurfuryl) amylmer-
a,/3-(iminocarbonylimino)-, diethyl
ester, 154
capto-, esters, 220
iodo-, ethyl ester, 34
a,/3-bis(trichloromethyl)-, diethyl
isopropyl-, esters, 59, 76, 77
ester, 29, 52, 53
isopropylidene-, diethyl ester, 76
isoquinolinium betaine, 120, 121
a,/3-bis(triphenylmethyl), 22
bromo-,
34, 99, 180, 226, 234,
236
mercapto-, 34, 172, 220, 234
acetate, 224, 225
diethyl ester, 34
a-( 1-carbethoxyethylaminomethy-
lene)-, esters, 214
esters, 34,
226
methallyloxy-, dimethallyl
methoxy-, 64, 65
carbododecyloxymethylmercapto-,
esters,
214,
171,
215
222
ester,
162-164
carbomethylmercapto-, 222, 223
carbooctyloxymethylmercapto-,
ters, 222
os-
methyl-, 76
l-carboxy-2-oxo-l-cyclo-pentyl-,
34,
4-methyl-3-aminophenylsulfonyl-,
230
dimethyl
206
4-methyl-3-nitrophenylsulfonyl-,
p-methylphenylsulfonyl-, 230
chloro-, 34, 35
230
1-nitroethyl-, dimethyl ester, 168, 169
esters of, 68
o-chloro-/3-(p-chlorophenyl-, dimethyl
ester, 160, 161
a-phenylaminomethylene-,
4-chIoro-3-nitrophenylsulfonyl-, 230
dimethyl
phenyl-, dimethyl ester, 208, 209
ester,
ester,
214
phenylsulfonyl-, 230, 231
piperidine-, 118
o-chloro-jS-hydroxy-, 38
o-cyanobenzyl- ;
73
ester,
66
72,
sulfo-, 226, 234
octyl ester disodium salt, 226, 227
a-sulfo-0-thio-, 232, 233
cyclohexyl-, 76
decenyl-, 40, 41
a,a,j3-trichloro, 32
Succinic acids; alkenoxy-, esters, 66
alkoxy-, 64, 72
decyloxy-, 64
a,/3-diamino-, 30, 154
267
Succinyl group, 26, 142
Succinyl peroxide, 56
Succinic acids; alkyl-, 76
alkylenyl-, 40
alkylsulfonyl-, esters, 220
Sudsing agent, 18
aralkyl-, 10
Sulfinic acids, 217, 230, 231
a-aryl-jS-chloro-, 97, 160
a-bromo-/3-alkylsulfonyl-,
220
esters,
Sulfoacid anhydrides, 228
Sulfonal, manufacture, 178
carboxyalkysulfo, 222
Sulfone
carboxyalkylsulfonyl-, 222
ino)diphenyl-, 104
Sulfones, 217, 242, 243
a,0-dihalo-, 30
4,4'-bis()3-carboxyacrylylam-
Sulfothio acids, 232
dihydroxy-, 178
halo-, 34
Sulfur, 216, 218, 219, 244
containing, 216-243
halohydroxy-, 38
compounds
heterocycloamino-, 118
dehydrogenation with, 196
Sulfur dioxide, 244
hydroxy-, 172
mercapto-, esters, 220
cleavage
nitroalkyl-, 168
manufacture, 178
suifino,
5,
243
Sulfuric acid, 170, 175, 181-183, 233
quaternary ammonium, 120
substituted,
of, 217, 242,
Sulfurous acid, 232
Sulfur trioxide, 216, 226, 228, 229
Surface active agent, 12, 100, 110,
186
226
sulfonyl-, 230
222
Succinic anhydride, 55, 56, 166, 180
allyl-, 6, 7
Symbols, explanation
of,
benzyl-, 10, 11
a,/3-bis(triphenyllead)-, 62, 63
Tanning agent,
bromohydroxypropyl-, lactone, 6
Tartaric acid, 36, 170, 178, 179
diethyl ester, 179
(2,4-dimethoxyphenyl)-, 92, 93
18,
112,
230,
Tautomerism,
mercapto-, 220
acetate, 224
Teeth, cleaner for
artificial,
178
Terpenes, conjugated, 19
monocyclic, 18
3-phenylallyl-, 6
8,
non-conjugated,
8, 9,
18
Terpenesuccinic anhydrides, 8
Succinic anhydrides; alkenyl-, 6
alkyl-, 6
a-Terpinene,
8,
18
cycloalkenyl-, 6
Terpinolene,
8,
cycloalkyl-, 6
polyenyl-, 6
3-Terpinolenesuccinic anhydride,
Tetracarboxylic acids, 70, 71
Tetraenes, conjugated, 20, 196
Succinimide;
250
108, 140, 146
2,5-hexadiene-l-yl, 6
3-terpinolene-,
26,
a-anilino-N-phenyl-,
106
N-chloro, 56
ramethyl
a-chloro-N-phenyl-, 46, 47, 106, 108
a,/3-dichloro~N-phenyl-, 30
N-p-phenetyl-, 56
phenylhydrazono-, 32
o,a,)3,j3-tetrachloro-N-phenyl-, 30
Succinosuccinic esters, 56
ester,
208
Textiles, agent for, 26, 154, 226, 230
finishes for, 110
lubricants for, 6
a-(N-hydroxyanilino)-, 142
143
1,2,3,4-Tetralintetracarboxylic acid, tet-
N-bromo-, 56
a- ( N-hydroxy ani lino ) -N-pheny 1-,
8,
1 42
Therapeutic agent,
Thiachromanones
98, 110
carboxyhalo-, 220
Thiazole; 2-mercapto-4-methyl-, 251
Thiazole-5-acetic acid; 2,4-diketotetra;
hydro-, 2-isopropylidenehydrazone, 238
Thiazoles, 244
a-Tolunitrile, 72, 73, 97
acid
5-Thiazolidineacetic
2-acetonea-
zine-2,4-dioxo-, 238, 239
2-imino-4-oxo-, 217, 234, 235
5-Thiazolidineacetic acids; azine-2,4-di-
Triazoledicarboxylic acids, dihydro-,
esters, 156
A 2 -l ,2,3-Triazoline-4,5-dicarboxylic
dimethyl
ester,
97, 156
Thiazoledioncacetic acids, 238
Thiazolidone
1 -benzyl-,
acid;
oxo-, 238
Tricarballylic
imino, derivatives, 234
acid;
ester, 68,
Thiazolidone-5-acetic acid ;2-phenyl-imino-3-phenyl-, 234
a-acoto-,
triethyl
69
a-cyano-, 72
Trimesic acid, trimethyl
ester, 198
Thiazolines, 244
Thickeners, 202
Urea, 138, 139, 234
2,3-Thiiranedicarboxylic acid, esters,
218, 219
Ureides, cyclic, 138
5-hydantoinacetyl-, 138, 139
Thioacetic acid, 216, 225, 230
Thio acid, salts, 244
Varnishes, over-print, 12
oils, 192
Thioamines, 235
Thiocyanates, 244
Thiohydantoin, 234
Vegetable
Vehicles; synthetic for paint and varnish, 24, 66
Thiolacetic acid, sodium
vinyl ester, 203
salt,
Veratrole, 92
223
p-vinyl-,
Thiol acids, 216, 222, 223
Thiomalic acid-, 224
16, 26, 27, 42, 43,
aryl-, 15
diaryl-, halides, 42, 43
2-(alkylmercapto)-, 56
Thiophene 1-dioxide 3-^eri-hutylmcrcapto-2,5-dihydro-4-me1 hy 1-, 243
;
2,3,4,5-Thiophenetetracarboxylic acid,
30
Thiophcnol, o-amino-, 216, 237
Thiosemicarbazon.es, 217, 238,
identification of, 238
170,
173
Wetting agent, 18,
non-foaming, 112
40, 112, 216, 226
Xantho group, 34
p-Xylene, 10
Thiotolene, 240
Thioureas, 217, 234, 235, 238, 244
Thioxene, 240
for,
Vitamin A, separation, 12
Vitamin B, synthesis, 246
Vitamin C, stabilizer, 98
Water-repellents, 56
Thiosulfates, 211, 217, 233, 244
Thiosulfuric acid, 232, 233
Thiuram disulfide, 244
Tin plating, ingredient
heterosubstituted, 202, 203
Water,
239
Thiosulfate, solution, 244
Toluene,
5,
171
106, 107
Thionyl chloride, 48,
Thiophene, 12, 240
14
Vinyl compounds,
Yeast, growth substance for, 98, 114
treatment of, 178
178
Zerewitinoff reaction, micro-, 190
4, 10, 11
Zinc chloride, 48, 110
Toluidines, separation of, 104
269